Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Owner's
Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with
your vehicle. For your own safety and a longer
vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning notices in this manual. Disregarding them
may lead to damage to the vehicle or personal
injury.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry
variant
Ravailability
The illustrations in this manual show a lefthand-drive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the layout of components and controls
differs accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
Therefore, descriptions may vary from those
of your own vehicle.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
ROwner's
Manual
Booklet
Requipment-dependent supplements
Keep printed copies of the documents in the
vehicle at all times. If you sell the vehicle,
always pass the documents on to the new
owner.
RService
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
2185841181Z102 É2185841181Z1027ËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 27
Introduction ......................................... 21
Safety ................................................... 39
Opening and closing ........................... 75
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 95
Lights and windscreen wipers ......... 109
Climate control ................................. 123
Driving and parking .......................... 139
On-board computer and displays .... 207
Stowing and features ....................... 271
Maintenance and care ...................... 295
Breakdown assistance ..................... 309
Wheels and tyres .............................. 327
Technical data ................................... 355
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
12 V socket
see Socket
4ETS
see ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
4MATIC (permanent four-wheel
drive) .................................................. 184
4MATIC off-road system ................... 184
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 232
Function/notes ................................ 63
Important safety notes .................... 63
Warning lamp ................................. 261
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 131
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 127
Active Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 220
Display message ............................ 246
Function/notes ............................. 201
Active Driving Assistance package . 201
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 220
Display message ............................ 246
Function/notes ............................. 204
Active light function ......................... 115
Active multicontour seat .................. 100
Active Park Assist
Display message ............................ 247
Active Parking Assist
Important safety notes .................. 187
Active Service System
see ASSYST PLUS
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 68
Adaptive brake lamps ......................... 65
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Display message ............................ 240
Function/notes ............................. 116
Adaptive Main-beam Assist
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 223
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 364
Airbags
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 44
Important safety guidelines ............. 42
Kneebag ........................................... 44
Pelvis airbag .................................... 45
Sidebag ............................................ 45
Triggering ......................................... 41
Windowbag ...................................... 46
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Air filter (white display message) .... 243
AIR FLOW ........................................... 128
AIRMATIC
Display message ............................ 243
Function/notes ............................. 181
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Glove compartment ....................... 137
Important safety notes .................. 136
Rear ............................................... 137
Setting ........................................... 136
Setting the centre air vents ........... 137
Setting the side air vents ............... 137
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Ambient lighting
Setting the brightness (on-board
computer) ...................................... 223
Setting the colour (on-board computer) ............................................. 223
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension ............................................... 183
Anti-glare film .................................... 293
Anti-lock Braking System
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Aquaplaning ....................................... 164
Ashtray ............................................... 282
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 218
Index
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 300
Hiding a service message .............. 300
Notes ............................................. 300
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 300
Service message ............................ 300
Special service requirements ......... 301
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 71
Function ........................................... 71
Interior motion sensor ..................... 72
Switching off the alarm .................... 71
Tow-away protection ........................ 71
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 220
Display message ............................ 243
Function/notes ............................. 192
Authorised workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................ 239
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .................................... 146
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) .......................... 145
Automatic headlamp mode .............. 111
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position ............. 151
Automatic drive program ............... 152
Changing gear ............................... 151
DIRECT SELECT lever ..................... 149
Display message ............................ 254
Drive position (ECO start/stop
function) ........................................ 150
Drive program display .................... 149
Driving tips .................................... 151
Emergency running mode .............. 156
Engaging drive position .................. 150
Engaging neutral ............................ 150
Engaging reverse gear ................... 150
Engaging the park position ............ 149
Kickdown ....................................... 151
Manual drive program .................... 154
Neutral (ECO start/stop function) . 150
Overview ........................................ 148
Problem (fault) ............................... 156
Program selector button ................
Pulling away ...................................
Selector lever ................................
Shift ranges ...................................
Starting the engine ........................
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ...
Transmission position display ........
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ...................
Transmission positions ..................
Automatic transmission emergency running mode .........................
Auxiliary heating
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
Problem (display message) ............
Remote control ..............................
Setting ...........................................
Setting the departure time .............
Auxiliary ventilation
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Problem (display message) ............
Remote control ..............................
151
143
148
153
143
152
149
149
150
156
133
133
255
132
136
133
225
135
133
133
136
133
B
Bag hook ............................................ 277
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 63
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) .................................................... 64
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 79
Important safety notes .................... 79
Replacing ......................................... 79
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 318
Display message ............................ 242
Important safety notes .................. 316
Jump starting ................................. 319
Belt
see Seat belt
Belt force limiters (activation) ........... 41
5
6
Index
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 41
Function ........................................... 51
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating ................. 220
Display message ............................ 246
Notes/function .............................. 197
see Active Blind Spot Assist
Bluetooth® SAP V3 telephone module
see Separate operating instructions
Bonnet
Closing ........................................... 297
Display message ............................ 255
Opening ......................................... 296
Boot
Emergency release .......................... 87
Important safety notes .................... 85
Opening/closing (automatically
from inside) ...................................... 87
Opening/closing (automatically
from outside) ................................... 86
Opening/closing (manually from
outside) ............................................ 85
Boot lid
Display message ............................ 254
Opening/closing .............................. 85
Opening dimensions ...................... 366
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 366
Bottle holders .................................... 281
Box (boot) ........................................... 277
Brake Assist System
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 234
Notes ............................................. 365
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 65
Display message ............................ 238
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 63
BAS .................................................. 63
BAS PLUS ........................................ 64
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 365
Display message ............................ 232
Driving tips .................................... 162
High-performance brake system .... 163
Important safety notes .................. 162
Parking brake ................................ 160
Warning lamp ................................. 260
Breakdown
see Flat tyre
see Towing away
Bulbs
see Changing bulbs
C
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Car
see Vehicle
Care
Automatic car wash ....................... 301
Carpets .......................................... 307
Display ........................................... 305
Exterior lighting ............................. 304
Gear or selector lever .................... 306
High-pressure cleaner .................... 302
Interior ........................................... 305
Matt paintwork .............................. 303
Night View Assist Plus ................... 305
Notes ............................................. 301
Paint .............................................. 303
Plastic trim .................................... 306
Reversing camera .......................... 305
Roof lining ...................................... 307
Seat belt ........................................ 307
Seat cover ..................................... 306
Sensors ......................................... 304
Steering wheel ............................... 306
Tail pipes ....................................... 305
Trim pieces .................................... 306
Washing by hand ........................... 302
Wheels ........................................... 303
Windows ........................................ 304
Wiper blades .................................. 304
Wooden trim .................................. 306
Car wash (care) ................................. 301
CD player/CD changer(on-board
computer) .......................................... 216
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 225
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 77
Index
Centre console
Lower section .................................. 35
Lower section (AMG vehicles) .......... 36
Upper section .................................. 34
Changing bulbs
Important safety notes .................. 119
Overview of bulb types .................. 120
Reversing lamps ............................ 120
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes .................... 61
Rear doors ....................................... 62
Children
In the vehicle ................................... 52
Restraint systems ............................ 52
Child seat
Automatic recognition ..................... 54
ISOFIX .............................................. 56
On the front-passenger seat ............ 54
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 58
Recommendations ........................... 60
Suitable positions ............................ 58
Top Tether ....................................... 57
Cigarette lighter ................................ 283
Cleaning
Mirror turn signal ........................... 304
Climate control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 132
Controlling automatically ............... 128
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) ................. 131
Cooling with air dehumidification . . 127
Demisting the windows .................. 130
Demisting the windscreen ............. 130
Important safety notes .................. 124
Indicator lamp ................................ 128
Information on using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control .................................. 127
Notes on using THERMATIC automatic climate control ..................... 125
Overview of systems ...................... 124
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 128
Problem with the rear window
heating .......................................... 131
Rear control panel ......................... 126
Setting the air distribution ............. 129
Setting the airflow ......................... 129
Setting the air vents ...................... 136
Setting the climate mode (AIR
FLOW) ............................................ 128
Setting the temperature ................ 128
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 131
Switching on/off ........................... 127
Switching residual heat on/off ...... 132
Switching the rear window heating on/off ...................................... 131
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 130
THERMATIC automatic climate
control (2-zone) ............................. 125
THERMOTRONIC (3-zone) automatic climate control ..................... 126
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 28
see Instrument cluster
Collapsible emergency spare
wheel
see Emergency spare wheel
COMAND display
Cleaning ......................................... 305
COMAND Online
see separate operating instructions
Combination switch .......................... 113
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 213
Convenience box ............................... 277
Convenience closing feature .............. 89
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ........................... 131
Convenience opening feature ............ 89
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 299
Display message ............................ 240
Important safety notes .................. 365
Temperature (on-board computer) . 228
Temperature gauge ........................ 210
Warning lamp ................................. 267
Cooling
see Climate control
Cornering light function
Display message ............................ 237
Function/notes ............................. 115
Crash-responsive emergency lighting ....................................................... 119
7
8
Index
Cruise control
Activation conditions .....................
Cruise control lever .......................
Deactivating ...................................
Display message ............................
Driving system ...............................
Important safety notes ..................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Selecting ........................................
Setting a speed ..............................
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
Cup holder
Centre console ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Rear centre console .......................
Rear compartment .........................
166
165
167
249
165
165
165
166
167
166
279
279
280
280
D
Dashboard
see Instrument cluster
Dashboard lighting
see Instrument cluster lighting
Data
see Technical data
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................ 239
Function/notes ............................. 111
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 222
Dealership
see Qualified specialist workshop
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (on-board computer) ............................................. 223
Interior lighting .............................. 224
Diagnostics connection ...................... 23
Diesel particle filter .......................... 162
Digital speedometer ......................... 213
Dipped-beam headlamps
Display message ............................ 237
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................ 110
Setting for driving on the right/
left ................................................. 223
Switching on/off ........................... 111
DIRECT SELECT lever
see Automatic transmission
Display message
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 300
General information ....................... 231
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 231
KEYLESS-GO .................................. 257
Display messages
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 231
Driving systems ............................. 243
Engine ............................................ 240
Key ................................................ 256
Lights ............................................. 237
Safety systems .............................. 232
Tyres .............................................. 250
Vehicle ........................................... 254
Distance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 219
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 269
DISTRONIC PLUS
Deactivating ................................... 177
Display message ............................ 248
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 176
Function/notes ............................. 170
Important safety notes .................. 170
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 176
Warning lamp ................................. 269
Door
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 225
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 84
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 77
Control panel ................................... 38
Display message ............................ 255
Emergency locking ........................... 84
Emergency unlocking ....................... 84
Important safety notes .................... 82
Opening (from the inside) ................ 82
Drive program
Automatic ...................................... 152
Display ........................................... 149
Display (DIRECT SELECT lever) ...... 149
Manual ........................................... 154
Drive program selector ..................... 152
Index
Driver's door
see Door
Drive system
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 201
Driving abroad
Service24h .................................... 301
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 110
Driving on flooded roads .................. 164
Driving safety system
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) ............................................... 64
Electronic Brake-force Distribution .................................................. 68
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 65
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction
System) ........................................... 66
Important safety guidelines ............. 62
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 63
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 68
Adaptive brake lamps ...................... 65
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 63
Overview .......................................... 62
PRE-SAFE® Brake ............................. 68
Driving system
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 204
Active Parking Assist ..................... 187
Driving systems
Active Driving Assistance package ................................................. 201
AIRMATIC ...................................... 181
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension .......................................... 183
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 192
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 197
Cruise control ................................ 165
Display message ............................ 243
Distronic Plus ................................ 170
HOLD function ............................... 179
Lane Keeping Assist ...................... 199
Lane package ................................ 197
Night View Assist Plus ................... 194
PARKTRONIC ................................. 185
RACE START (AMG vehicles) .......... 180
Reversing camera .......................... 190
Speed Limit Assist .........................
SPEEDTRONIC ...............................
Driving tips
AMG ceramic brakes .....................
Aquaplaning ...................................
Automatic transmission .................
Brakes ...........................................
Downhill gradient ...........................
Driving abroad ...............................
Driving in winter .............................
Driving on flooded roads ................
Driving on wet roads ......................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
Wet road surface ...........................
DVD audio
Operating (on-board computer) .....
DVD video
Operating (on-board computer) .....
193
168
163
164
151
162
162
110
164
164
164
161
165
163
163
140
331
110
163
216
216
E
EASY-ENTRY feature
Activating/deactivating ................. 226
Function/notes ............................. 104
EASY-EXIT feature
Crash-responsive ........................... 104
Function/notes ............................. 104
Switching on/off ........................... 226
EASY-PACK convenience box ........... 277
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 234
Function/notes ................................ 68
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 161
On-board computer ....................... 213
ECO start/stop function
Deactivating/activating ................. 145
General information ....................... 144
Electrical fuses
see Fuses
9
10
Index
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Electronic Traction System
see ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 84
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 78
Locking vehicle ................................ 84
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 84
Fuel filler flap ................................. 157
Emergency spare wheel
Important safety notes .................. 351
Inflating the collapsible spare
wheel ............................................. 352
Points to remember ....................... 351
Removing ....................................... 351
Storage location ............................ 351
Stowing .......................................... 352
Technical data ............................... 354
Emergency unlocking
Vehicle ............................................. 84
Engine
Display message ............................ 240
ECO start/stop function ................ 144
Engine number ............................... 359
Jump-starting ................................. 319
Running irregularly ......................... 147
Starting problems .......................... 147
Starting the engine with the key .... 143
Starting with KEYLESS GO ............. 143
Stopping ........................................ 160
Tow-starting (vehicle) ..................... 323
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 266
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 357
Problem (fault) ............................... 147
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 364
Checking the oil level ..................... 297
Checking the oil level using the
dipstick .......................................... 298
Display message ............................ 242
Filling capacity ............................... 364
Notes about oil grades ................... 363
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 297
Temperature (on-board computer) . 228
Topping up ..................................... 298
Viscosity ........................................ 364
Environmental protection
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 21
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
AMG menu (on-board computer) . . . 228
Deactivating/activating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 66
Deactivating/activating (except
AMG vehicles) ................................ 219
Deactivating/activating (notes;
except AMG vehicles) ...................... 66
Display message ............................ 232
ETS/4ETS ........................................ 66
Function/notes ................................ 65
Important safety guidelines ............. 65
Warning lamp ................................. 263
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ...................................................... 66
Exhaust tail pipe (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 305
Exterior lighting
Settings options ............................. 110
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 105
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 106
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 106
Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 105
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 227
Out of position (troubleshooting) ... 106
Parking position ............................. 106
Resetting ....................................... 106
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 107
F
Fault message
see Display messages
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ............................... 311
Index
First-aid kit ......................................... 310
Fitting a wheel
Removing a wheel .......................... 339
Fitting wheels
Fitting a wheel ............................... 340
Lowering the vehicle ...................... 340
Raising the vehicle ......................... 338
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................ 337
Flat tyre
MOExtended tyres ......................... 313
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 312
TIREFIT kit ...................................... 313
Floormat ............................................. 292
Foglamps (extended range) .............. 116
Frequencies
Garage door opener ....................... 289
Mobile phone ................................. 357
Two-way radio ................................ 357
Fuel
Additives ........................................ 361
Consumption information .............. 363
Consumption statistics .................. 213
Displaying the current consumption ................................................ 213
Displaying the range ...................... 213
Fuel gauge ............................... 30, 209
Grade (petrol) ................................ 360
Important safety notes .................. 360
Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 361
Problem (malfunction) ................... 158
Quality (diesel) ............................... 362
Refuelling ....................................... 156
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 360
Fuel filler flap
Emergency release ........................ 157
Opening/closing ............................ 157
Fuel filter (white display message) . 243
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 213
Gauge ...................................... 30, 209
Fuel reserve
see Fuel
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................ 360
Problem (malfunction) ................... 158
Fuse allocation chart (vehicle tool
kit) ......................................................
Fuses
Allocation chart .............................
Before changing .............................
Fuse box in the boot ......................
Fuse box in the engine compartment ..............................................
Important safety notes ..................
311
324
324
325
324
324
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory .....................
Frequencies ...................................
Important safety notes ..................
Opening/closing the garage door ..
Programming (button in the rearview mirror) ...................................
Gear indicator (on-board computer) ..................................................
Gearshift program
SETUP (on-board computer) ..........
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Glove compartment ..........................
289
289
287
288
287
228
228
356
273
H
Handbrake
see Parking brake
Hazard warning lamps ...................... 114
Headbag
Display message ............................ 237
Headlamp
Cleaning system (function) ............ 114
Cleaning system (notes) ................ 366
Headlamps
Misting up ...................................... 117
Topping up the cleaning system .... 299
see Automatic headlamp mode
Head restraints
Adjusting ......................................... 98
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 99
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 98
Adjusting (rear) ................................ 99
Fitting/removing (rear) .................... 99
Luxury .............................................. 99
11
12
Index
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners ....................
Hill start assist ..................................
HOLD function
Display message ............................
Function/notes .............................
302
144
245
179
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 70
In-car hotspot
see Separate operating instructions
Indicator and warning lamps
Coolant .......................................... 267
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 269
Engine diagnostics ......................... 266
Fuel tank ........................................ 267
SPORT handling mode ................... 264
Indicator lamps
Display message ............................ 238
see Warning and indicator lamps
Insect protection on the radiator .... 297
Inspection
see ASSYST PLUS
Instrument cluster
Overview .................................. 30, 209
Settings ......................................... 221
Warning and indicator
lamps ....................................... 32, 258
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 222
Intelligent Light System
Activating/deactivating ................. 222
Display message ............................ 239
Overview ........................................ 115
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left . 223
Interior lighting ................................. 118
Automatic control system .............. 118
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer) ...................................... 224
Emergency lighting ........................ 119
Manual control ............................... 119
Overview ........................................ 118
Reading lamp ................................. 118
Setting brightness for display/
switches (on-board computer) ....... 222
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 223
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................ 223
Interior motion sensor ........................ 72
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 56
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 311
Using ............................................. 338
Jump start (engine)
see Jump starting (engine)
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 319
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 79
Checking the battery ....................... 79
Convenience closing feature ............ 89
Convenience opening feature .......... 89
Display message ............................ 256
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 77
Emergency key element ................... 78
Important safety notes .................... 76
Loss ................................................. 81
Modifying the programming ............. 78
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 141
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 81
Starting the engine ........................ 143
KEYLESS-GO
Convenience closing ........................ 89
Display message ............................ 257
Locking ............................................ 77
Start/Stop button .......................... 141
Starting the engine ........................ 143
Unlocking ......................................... 77
Key positions
Key ................................................ 141
KEYLESS GO .................................. 141
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 151
Manual drive program .................... 154
Kneebag ............................................... 44
Index
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane detection (automatic)
see Lane Keeping Assist
Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating .................
Display message ............................
Function/information ....................
Lane package .....................................
Lap time (RACETIMER) ......................
Lashing eyelets .................................
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent Light System ........................
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off .......
Active light function .......................
Automatic headlamp mode ............
Cornering light function .................
Dipped-beam headlamps ...............
Driving abroad ...............................
Foglamps (extended range) ...........
Hazard warning lamps ...................
Headlamp flasher ...........................
Light switch ...................................
Main-beam headlamps ...................
Motorway mode .............................
Parking lamps ................................
Rear foglamp .................................
Setting brightness for display/
switches (on-board computer) .......
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) ....
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................
Side lamps .....................................
Switching Adaptive Highbeam
Assist on/off .................................
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (on-board computer) .
Switching the exterior lighting
delayed switch-off on/off (onboard computer) ............................
220
246
199
197
228
276
222
224
115
111
115
111
110
116
114
114
110
113
115
113
112
222
223
223
112
223
222
223
Switching the surround lighting
on/off (on-board computer) .......... 223
Turn signals ................................... 113
see Changing bulbs
see Interior lighting
Light sensor (display message) ....... 239
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................ 165
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 172
Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 168
Limiting the speed
see SPEEDTRONIC
Loading guidelines ............................ 272
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 84
Emergency locking ........................... 84
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 83
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 225
Lumbar support
Adjusting ....................................... 101
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 101
Luxury head restraint ......................... 99
M
M+S tyres ...........................................
Main-beam headlamps
Display message ............................
Switching Adaptive Highbeam
Assist on/off .................................
Switching on/off ...........................
Massage function (PULSE) ...............
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) . .
Memory card (audio) .........................
Memory function ...............................
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory (on-board computer) ..................................................
Messages
see Display messages
330
238
117
113
101
303
216
107
231
13
14
Index
Mirror
see Vanity mirror (in sun visor)
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
Mobile phone
Frequencies ................................... 357
Installation ..................................... 357
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 217
Notes/placing in the bracket ......... 284
Sliding adapter ............................... 286
Transmission output (maximum) .... 357
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 78
MOExtended tyres ............................. 313
Motorway mode ................................ 115
MP3
Operating ....................................... 216
see Separate operating instructions
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 211
Permanent display ......................... 221
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer . 210
Overview .......................................... 33
N
Navigation
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 214
NECK-PRO head restraints
Operation ......................................... 46
Resetting after being triggered ........ 47
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
Operation ......................................... 46
Resetting after being triggered ........ 47
Night View Assist Plus
Activating/deactivating ................. 195
Cleaning ......................................... 305
Function/notes ............................. 194
Problem (fault) ............................... 197
Notes on running in a new vehicle . . 140
O
Occupant safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 52
Important safety notes .................... 40
Odometer
see Total distance recorder
see Trip meter
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 228
Assistance menu ........................... 218
Audio menu ................................... 215
Convenience submenu .................. 226
Displaying a service message ........ 300
Display messages .......................... 231
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 176
Factory setting submenu ............... 227
Heating submenu ........................... 225
Important safety notes .................. 208
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 221
Light submenu ............................... 222
Menu overview .............................. 212
Message memory .......................... 231
Navigation menu ............................ 214
Operating the TV ............................ 216
Operating video DVD ..................... 216
Operation ....................................... 210
RACETIMER ................................... 228
Service menu ................................. 220
Settings menu ............................... 221
Standard display ............................ 212
Telephone menu ............................ 217
Trip menu ...................................... 212
Vehicle submenu ........................... 224
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature display ........... 210
Overhead control panel ...................... 37
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 62
P
Paint code .......................................... 359
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) . . . 303
Panic alarm .......................................... 40
Index
Parking ............................................... 159
Important safety notes .................. 159
Parking brake ................................ 160
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ............................... 106
Reversing camera .......................... 190
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 187
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Display message ............................ 234
Notes/function .............................. 160
Warning lamp ................................. 266
Parking lamps
Display message ............................ 239
Switching on/off ........................... 113
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 186
Driving system ............................... 185
Function/notes ............................. 185
Important safety notes .................. 185
Problem (fault) ............................... 187
Sensor range ................................. 185
Warning display ............................. 186
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp ...................................................... 54
Petrol .................................................. 360
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) . 306
Power windows
see Side windows
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Display message ............................ 235
Operation ......................................... 48
PRE-SAFE® Brake
Activating/deactivating ................. 219
Display message ............................ 235
Function/notes ................................ 68
Warning lamp ................................. 269
Product information ............................ 21
Program selector button .................. 151
Protection of the environment
General notes .................................. 21
Pulling away (automatic transmission) .................................................... 143
Q
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 23
R
RACE START (AMG vehicles) ............. 180
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 228
Radar sensors
Overview ........................................ 368
Radar sensor system
Activating/deactivating ................. 225
Display message ............................ 245
Radiator cover ................................... 297
Radio
Selecting a station ......................... 215
see separate operating instructions
Rain closing feature (sliding sunroof) ...................................................... 92
Reading lamp ..................................... 118
Rear compartment
Setting the air vents ...................... 137
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator ........................................ 51
Rear foglamp
Display message ............................ 239
Switching on/off ........................... 112
Rear seat
Display message ............................ 255
Rear seat (folding the backrest forwards/back) ...................................... 275
Rear Seat Entertainment System
see Separate operating instructions
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 106
Dipping (manual) ........................... 105
Rear window blind ............................ 282
Rear window heating
Problem (fault) ............................... 131
Switching on/off ........................... 131
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ............................... 30, 209
Important safety notes .................. 156
Notes for AMG vehicles ................. 361
Refuelling process ......................... 157
see Fuel
15
16
Index
Remote control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation ..........
Changing the batteries (auxiliary
heating) .........................................
Garage door opener .......................
Programming (garage door
opener) ..........................................
Replacing the battery (auxiliary
heating remote control) ....................
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................
Warning lamp .................................
Residual heat (climate control) ........
Restraint system
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Rev counter ........................................
Reverse gear (selector lever) ...........
Reversing camera
Cleaning instructions .....................
Function/notes .............................
Switching on/off ...........................
Reversing lamp
Changing bulbs ..............................
Reversing lamp (display message) . .
Roller sunblind
Rear window ..................................
Roof carrier ........................................
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
instructions) ......................................
Roof load (maximum) ........................
133
135
287
287
135
242
267
132
210
148
305
190
191
120
239
282
278
307
366
S
Safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 52
Child restraint systems .................... 52
Safety system
see Driving safety system
Seat
Seat backrest display message ..... 255
Seat belt
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 50
Adjusting the height ......................... 50
Belt force limiter .............................. 51
Belt tensioner .................................. 51
Cleaning ......................................... 307
Display message ............................ 235
Fastening ......................................... 49
Important safety guidelines ............. 48
Rear seat belt status indicator ......... 51
Releasing ......................................... 50
Switching belt adjustment on/off
(on-board computer) ...................... 227
Warning lamp ................................. 259
Warning lamp (function) ................... 51
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 98
Adjusting lumbar support .............. 101
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support ................................................ 101
Adjusting the head restraint ............ 98
Cleaning the cover ......................... 306
Correct driver's seat position ........... 96
Important safety notes .................... 97
Seat heating problem .................... 102
Seat ventilation problem ................ 102
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 107
Switching seat heating on/off ....... 101
Switching the seat ventilation on/
off .................................................. 102
Selector lever
Cleaning ......................................... 306
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 304
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service menu (on-board computer) . 220
Service products
Brake fluid ..................................... 365
Coolant (engine) ............................ 365
Engine oil ....................................... 363
Fuel ................................................ 360
Important safety notes .................. 359
Washer fluid ................................... 366
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 227
On-board computer ....................... 221
Setting the air distribution ............... 129
Setting the airflow ............................ 129
SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 228
Index
Short journeys (diesel particle filter) ...................................................... 162
Sidebag ................................................ 45
Side lamps
Switching on/off ........................... 112
Side windows
Convenience closing ........................ 89
Convenience opening ...................... 89
Important safety notes .................... 87
Opening/closing .............................. 88
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 91
resetting .......................................... 90
Sliding sunroof
Important safety information ........... 91
Opening/closing .............................. 92
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 93
Rain closing feature ......................... 92
Resetting ......................................... 92
Snow chains ...................................... 331
Socket
Centre console .............................. 284
Rear compartment ......................... 284
Under the armrest ......................... 284
Sockets
General notes ................................ 283
Spare wheel
Storing ........................................... 352
Specialist workshop ............................ 23
Spectacles compartment ................. 273
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating the warning function .................................... 218
Displaying ...................................... 218
Display message ............................ 244
Display message in the multifunction display .................................... 194
Important safety notes .................. 193
Speedometer
Digital ............................................ 213
In the Instrument cluster ......... 30, 209
Segments ...................................... 210
Selecting the unit of measurement .............................................. 221
see Instrument cluster
SPEEDTRONIC
Deactivating variable ..................... 170
Display message ............................ 249
Function/notes ............................. 168
Important safety notes .................. 168
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 168
Permanent ..................................... 170
Selecting ........................................ 168
Storing the current speed .............. 169
Variable ......................................... 168
SPORT handling mode
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 66
Warning lamp ................................. 264
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Display message ............................ 236
Introduction ..................................... 41
Warning lamp ................................. 266
Warning lamp (function) ................... 41
Starting (engine) ................................ 142
Steering (display message) .............. 256
Steering wheel
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 103
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 103
Button overview ............................... 33
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 210
Cleaning ......................................... 306
Gearshift paddles ........................... 152
Important safety notes .................. 102
Steering wheel heating .................. 103
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 107
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 152
Steering wheel heating
Problem (malfunction) ................... 104
Switching on/off ........................... 103
Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 228
Stowage areas ................................... 272
Stowage compartment
Spectacles compartment ............... 273
Stowage compartments
Armrest (under) ............................. 274
Centre console .............................. 273
Centre console (rear compartment) ............................................. 275
Cup holder ..................................... 279
Glove compartment ....................... 273
17
18
Index
Important safety information ......... 272
Rear ............................................... 275
Under driver's seat/frontpassenger seat .............................. 274
Stowage net ....................................... 275
Stowage space
Stowage net ................................... 275
Stowage well beneath the boot
floor .................................................... 278
Summer tyres .................................... 330
Sun visor ............................................ 281
Supplement Restraint System
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Surround lighting (on-board computer) .................................................. 223
Suspension tuning
AIRMATIC ...................................... 182
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension .......................................... 183
SETUP (on-board computer) .......... 228
Switching off the alarm (ATA) ............ 71
T
Tail lamps
Display message ............................
Tank
see Fuel tank
Technical data
Emergency spare wheel .................
Information ....................................
Tyres/wheels .................................
Vehicle data ...................................
Telephone
Accepting a call .............................
Display message ............................
Menu (on-board computer) ............
Number from the phone book ........
Redialling .......................................
Rejecting/ending a call .................
Telephone compartment ................
Temperature
Coolant ..........................................
Coolant (on-board computer) .........
Engine oil (on-board computer) ......
Outside temperature ......................
Setting (climate control) ................
238
354
356
341
366
217
256
217
217
218
217
274
210
228
228
210
128
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 165
Theft-deterrent system
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 71
Immobiliser ...................................... 70
Through-loading feature ................... 275
Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 228
Tiredness Assist
see ATTENTION ASSIST
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 313
Top Tether ............................................ 57
Total distance recorder .................... 212
Tow-away protection .......................... 71
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 320
With the rear axle raised ................ 322
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 321
Removing the towing eye ............... 322
With both axles on the ground ....... 322
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 323
Important safety notes .................. 320
Transmission
see Automatic transmission
Transmission position display ......... 149
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ...................... 149
Transporting the vehicle .................. 323
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) . 306
Trip computer (on-board computer) .................................................. 213
Trip meter
Calling up ....................................... 212
Resetting (on-board computer) ...... 214
Turn signal
see Turn signals
Turn signals
Switching on/off ........................... 113
TV
Operating (on-board computer) ..... 216
see Separate operating instructions
Two-way radio
Frequencies ................................... 357
Installation ..................................... 357
Transmission output (maximum) .... 357
Index
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message ............................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure loss warning
Important safety notes ..................
Restarting ......................................
Tyre pressure monitor
Checking the tyre pressure electronically ........................................
Function/notes .............................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Warning message ..........................
Tyres
Changing a wheel ..........................
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
Important safety notes ..................
MOExtended tyres .........................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Storing ...........................................
Tyre size (data) ..............................
Tyre tread ......................................
see Flat tyre
334
250
315
315
331
332
333
334
334
335
270
335
336
329
336
250
328
330
336
329
337
341
329
U
Unladen weight ................................. 366
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 84
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 83
V
Vanity mirror (in sun visor) .............. 281
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
see SPEEDTRONIC
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 24
Data acquisition ............................... 24
Display message ............................ 254
Electronics ..................................... 357
Equipment ....................................... 22
Implied warranty .............................. 24
Individual settings .......................... 221
Leaving parked up ......................... 161
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 84
Locking (key) ................................... 77
Lowering ........................................ 340
Pulling away ................................... 143
Raising ........................................... 338
Registration ..................................... 24
Securing from rolling away ............ 337
Towing away .................................. 320
Transporting .................................. 323
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 84
Unlocking (key) ................................ 77
Vehicle data ................................... 366
Vehicle data ....................................... 366
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 366
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 84
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 359
Vehicle level
AIRMATIC ...................................... 181
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension .......................................... 183
Vehicle level (display message) ....... 243
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 311
Vehicle weights ................................. 366
Video
Operating the DVD ......................... 216
VIN ...................................................... 359
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 261
Brakes ........................................... 260
Distance warning signal ................. 269
ESP® .............................................. 263
ESP® OFF ....................................... 264
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 165
LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 172
LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 168
Overview .................................. 32, 258
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF ................ 54
19
20
Index
Reserve fuel ................................... 267
Seat belt ........................................ 259
SRS ................................................ 266
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 270
Warning triangle ................................ 310
Washer fluid
Display message ............................ 256
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 340
Wheel chock ...................................... 337
Wheels
Changing/replacing ....................... 336
Changing a wheel .......................... 336
Checking ........................................ 329
Cleaning ......................................... 303
Cleaning (warning) ......................... 337
Emergency spare wheel ................. 351
Fitting a new wheel ........................ 340
Fitting a wheel ............................... 337
Important safety notes .................. 328
Removing a wheel .......................... 339
Storing ........................................... 337
Tightening torque ........................... 340
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 341
Windowbag
Operation ......................................... 46
Windows
Cleaning ......................................... 304
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ...................................... 130
Windscreen washer fluid
see Windscreen washer system
Windscreen washer system
Notes ............................................. 366
Topping up ..................................... 299
Windscreen wipers
Problem (malfunction) ................... 122
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 121
Switching on/off ........................... 121
Winter operation
Important safety notes .................. 330
Radiator cover ............................... 297
Slippery road surfaces ................... 165
Snow chains .................................. 331
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) ............................................. 224
M+S tyres ...................................... 330
Wiper blades
Cleaning .........................................
Important safety notes ..................
Replacing .......................................
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
304
121
121
306
Introduction
Protection of the environment
General notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
The objectives are for the natural resources
which form the basis of our existence on this
planet to be used sparingly and in a manner
which takes the requirements of both nature
and humanity into account.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. You should
bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
Ravoid short trips as these increase fuel con-
sumption.
sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight.
Rkeep an eye on the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rremove roof racks once you no longer need
them.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Ralways have service work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rmake
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine with the vehicle
stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
Ravoid
frequent, sudden acceleration.
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
Rswitch
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Returning an end-of-life vehicle
Mercedes-Benz will take back your
Mercedes-Benz to dispose of it in an environmentally responsible manner, in accordance
the European Union (EU) End of Life Vehicles
Directive.
The End of Life Vehicles Directive applies to
vehicles with a gross vehicle weight of up to
3.5 t, in accordance with national regulations.
For several years, Mercedes-Benz has been
meeting all the legal requirements for a
design which allows for recycling and re-use.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants which can recycle your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner. The methods employed in vehicle and
parts recycling are constantly being developed and improved. This means that your
Mercedes-Benz will also continue to meet
even the increased recycling quotas in the
future in good time. You can obtain further
information from your national MercedesBenz homepage or your national hotline number.
Product information
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
genuine Mercedes-Benz parts, conversion
parts and accessories that have been
approved for the type of vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been
specifically approved for your vehicle for their
reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to assess other parts. Therefore,
Mercedes-Benz accepts no responsibility for
the use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehiZ
21
22
Introduction
cles. This is also the case, even if they have
been independently or officially approved.
The use of non-approved parts could affect
your vehicle's operating safety.
Mercedes-Benz therefore recommends that
you use genuine Mercedes-Benz parts, conversion parts and accessories that have been
approved for the type of vehicle.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts, approved conversion parts and accessories are available
from a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. Here,
you will receive advice about permissible
technical modifications, and the parts will be
professionally fitted.
Printed Owner's Manual
The printed Owner's Manual (including any
Supplements) must be observed.
There is no electronic update to the Digital
Owner's Manual. Amendments are only made
to the printed Owner's Manual.
Owner's Manual
General notes
Before you first drive off, read this Owner's
Manual carefully and familiarise yourself with
your vehicle.
For your own safety and a longer vehicle life,
follow the instructions and warning notices in
this manual. Disregarding them may lead to
damage to the vehicle or personal injury.
Vehicle equipment
This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available for your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Note that your
vehicle may not be fitted with all features
described. This is also the case for systems
and functions relevant to safety. Therefore,
the equipment on your vehicle may differ from
that in the descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase contract documentation for your vehicle contains a list of all of the
systems in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The Owner's Manual and Service Booklet are
important documents and should kept in the
vehicle.
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
All work on the vehicle and, in particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Some safety systems only function when the
engine is running. You should therefore never
switch off the engine when driving. Otherwise,
the safety systems of your vehicle may not
function correctly and as a result will no longer protect you and other persons as intended. In addition, there is a risk that you may
lose control of your vehicle and thus cause an
accident.
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly, or alterations
made to the vehicle, e.g. re-routing of cables
under coverings, could cause the safety systems of your vehicle to stop working properly.
The safety systems would thus no longer protect you and other persons as intended. In
addition, there is a risk that you may lose control of your vehicle and thus cause an accident.
All work and alterations to the vehicle, e.g.
installations or modifications, should there-
Introduction
fore be carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
If work on electronic equipment and its software is carried out incorrectly, this equipment
could stop working. The electronic systems
are networked via interfaces. Tampering with
these electronic systems could cause malfunctions in systems which have not been
modified. Malfunctions such as these can
seriously jeopardise the vehicle's operating
safety and therefore your own safety.
You should therefore have all work and modifications to electronic components carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Declarations of conformity
Wireless vehicle components
The following information applies to all components of the vehicle and the COMAND system which receive and/or transmit radio
waves:
The components of this vehicle which receive
and/or transmit radio waves are compliant
with the basic requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC. You
can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Electromagnetic compatibility
The electromagnetic compatibility of the vehicle components has been checked and certified according to the currently valid version
of Directive 72/245/EEC or the equivalent
ECE Regulation ECE-R 10.
Diagnostics connection
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection, it can affect the operation of the
vehicle systems. This could compromise the
operating safety of your vehicle while driving.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not connect any equipment to a diagnostics connection.
G WARNING
Loose equipment or cables hanging from a
device which are connected to a diagnostic
connection could impede pedal clearance.
The equipment or cables could get caught
between the pedals when driving and braking
suddenly. This could impair the function of the
pedals. There is a risk of accident.
Do not attach any equipment or cables in the
driver's footwell.
! If the engine is switched off and equipment on the diagnostics connection is
used, the starter battery may discharge.
The diagnostics connection is only intended
for the connection of diagnostic equipment at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics
connection can lead to emissions monitoring
information being reset, for example. This
may lead to the vehicle failing to meet the
requirements of the next emissions test during the main inspection.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary special skills, tools and qualifications
to correctly carry out any necessary work on
your vehicle. This particularly applies to work
relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork
relevant to safety
and maintenance work
Rrepair work
Rmodifications, installations and conversions
Rwork on electronic components
Rservice
Z
23
24
Introduction
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
vehicles. The quality or safety of the vehicle
is improved as a result of the inspection.
Mercedes-Benz can only inform you about
vehicle checks if it has your registration data.
It is possible that your vehicle has not yet
been registered in your name in the following
cases:
Rif
your vehicle was not purchased at an
authorised specialist dealer.
Rif your vehicle has not yet been examined
at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership.
Correct use
G WARNING
Various warning stickers are affixed to your
vehicle. Their purpose is to draw your attention, and the attention of others, to various
dangers. Therefore, do not remove any warning stickers unless the sticker clearly states
that you may do so.
If you remove the warning stickers, you or
others could be injured by failing to recognise
certain dangers.
Observe the following information when driving your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
Rthe Technical Data section in this manual
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
Data stored in the vehicle
Fault data
Components which are critical for vehicle
operation are equipped with fault data memories as standard. There are also data storage
devices which record how vehicle components have reacted in certain driving situations (e.g. airbag deployment or ESP® intervention).
This data is used exclusively to:
Rassist
in the rectification of faults and
defects
Rhelp Mercedes-Benz optimise and develop
vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced by MercedesBenz, this technical information can be read
out from the fault memory. This is performed
by authorised employees of the MercedesBenz service network using special diagnostic computers.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the memory. Other memory data is constantly overwritten.
Other devices that store data
Depending on the equipment level, your vehicle may feature communications and/or
entertainment systems (e.g. navigation devices, telephone systems). These allow you to
Introduction
save and edit data required for the operation
of the respective device.
Further information on operation (e.g. on
deleting data) can be found in the separate
operating instructions.
Copyright information
FreeType
Portions of this software are copyright © 2005
The FreeType Project (www.freetype.org). All
rights reserved. © 1996-2000 by David
Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg.
Gnu compiler
Copyright © 1982, 1986 Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
The Berkeley software License Agreement
specifies the terms and conditions for redistribution. Redistribution and use in source
and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following
conditions are met:
1. Redistribution of source code must retain
the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistribution in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list
of conditions and the following disclaimer
in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display
the following acknowledgement: This
product includes software developed by
the University of California, Berkeley and
its contributors.
4. Neither the name of the University nor the
names of its contributors may be used to
endorse or promote products derived
from this software without specific prior
written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND
ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY
WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.
Z
25
26
Cockpit .................................................
Instrument cluster ..............................
Multifunction steering wheel .............
Centre console ....................................
Overhead control panel ......................
Door control panel ..............................
28
30
33
34
37
38
At a glance
27
28
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
152
;
Combination switch
113
=
Instrument cluster
30
?
Horn
A
DIRECT SELECT lever
149
B
PARKTRONIC warning display
185
C
Overhead control panel
37
D
Climate control systems
124
E
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
141
141
Function
Page
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
102
G
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
Steering wheel heating
102
103
H
Cruise control lever
165
I
Parking brake
160
J
Diagnostics connection
K
Opens the bonnet
296
L
Releases the parking brake
160
M
Light switch
110
N
Night View Assist Plus
194
23
29
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
PARKTRONIC warning display
185
=
Combination switch
113
?
Instrument cluster
30
A
Horn
B
DIRECT SELECT lever
149
C
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
152
D
Light switch
110
E
Night View Assist Plus
194
F
Releases the parking brake
160
37
Function
Page
G
Opens the bonnet
H
Diagnostics connection
I
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
141
141
J
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
102
K
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
Steering wheel heating
102
103
L
Cruise control lever
165
M
Parking brake
160
N
Climate control systems
124
296
23
30
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Displays
i Instrument cluster: kilometres
Function
Function
Page
:
Speedometer with segments
210
;
Multifunction display
211
i Set the instrument cluster lighting via the
on-board computer (Y page 222).
Page
=
Rev counter
210
?
Coolant temperature
210
A
Fuel gauge
31
At a glance
Instrument cluster
i Instrument cluster: miles
Function
Function
Page
:
Speedometer with segments
210
;
Multifunction display
211
i Set the instrument cluster lighting via the
on-board computer (Y page 222).
Page
=
Rev counter
210
?
Coolant temperature
210
A
Fuel gauge
32
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
:
Page
Function
Page
G
ü Seat belt
259
H
% Diesel engine: preglow
÷ ESP® in AMG vehicles
143
I
? Coolant
267
113
J
K Main-beam headlamp
113
J Brakes (red)
260
K
J Only for certain vehicles: brakes (yellow)
L Dipped-beam headlamps
111
260
L
T Side lamps
112
C
! ABS
261
M
R Rear foglamp
112
D
6 SRS
266
N
E
; Engine diagnostics
266
N This lamp has no function
F
h Tyre pressure monitor
270
O
8 Reserve fuel
÷ ESP®
M SPORT handling
mode in AMG vehicles
263
;
· Distance warning
269
=
å ESP® OFF
263
?
#! Turn signals
A
B
264
264
267
Multifunction steering wheel
33
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio/COMAND display;
see the separate operating
instructions
=
?
Switches on LINGUATRONIC; see the separate
operating instructions
?
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits telephone book/
redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume
8
Mute
Page
211
Function
A
B
217
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects a submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms the selection
Hides display messages
%
Back
Switches off LINGUATRONIC; see the separate
operating instructions
Page
210
210
210
231
210
34
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console
Centre console, upper section
Function
:
Page
Function
B
Audio system/COMAND
Online; see the separate
operating instructions
;
c Seat heating
101
=
s Seat ventilation
102
?
c PARKTRONIC
185
A
¤ ECO start/stop function
144
C
D
E
4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp
Page
54
£ Hazard warning
lamps
114
u Rear window roller
sunblind
282
& Auxiliary heating
132
Centre console
35
At a glance
Centre console, lower section
Function
F
G
H
Page
Stowage compartment
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
Cup holders
272
282
283
283
279
e Sets the suspension
tuning
182
É Sets the vehicle level
181
Function
Page
I
Stowage compartment
272
J
Ú Selects the drive program
151
K
COMAND controller; see
the separate operating
instructions
36
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console, lower section (AMG vehicles)
Function
Page
Function
Page
F
Cup holders
279
K
Stowage compartment
272
G
Engages parking position P
160
L
H
Selector lever
148
ß Calls up/saves the
suspension tuning
183
I
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
282
283
283
à Sets the suspension
tuning
183
J
COMAND controller; see
the separate operating
instructions
M
N
å ESP®
O
Drive program selector
66
152
Overhead control panel
37
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
:
;
=
?
A
u Switches the rear
interior lighting on/off
Page
119
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
118
Rear-view mirror
71
106
Page
B
Buttons for the garage door
opener
C
3 Opens/closes the
sliding sunroof
92
ê Deactivates the interior motion sensor
72
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
118
c Switches the front
interior lighting on/off
119
119
| Switches the automatic interior lighting control on/off
ë Deactivates towaway protection
Function
D
E
F
287
38
Door control panel
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
:
;
r45=
Stores settings for the seat,
exterior mirrors and steering wheel
Page
B
107
Adjusts the seats electrically
98
%& Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
83
?
Opens the door
82
A
7Zö\
Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
=
Function
105
C
D
Page
W Opens/closes the
side windows
88
n Activates/deactivates the override feature
for the side windows in the
rear compartment
62
p Opens/closes the
boot lid
87
Useful information ..............................
Panic alarm ..........................................
Occupant safety ..................................
Children in the vehicle ........................
Driving safety systems .......................
Anti-theft systems ..............................
40
40
40
52
62
70
Safety
39
Occupant safety
40
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Safety
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 23).
Panic alarm
Occupant safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If service work is not carried out correctly, the
operating safety of your vehicle may be affected. This could cause you to lose control of
your vehicle and cause an accident. Moreover, the safety systems may no longer be
able to protect you or others as they are
designed to do.
Always have service work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Modifications to or work performed incorrectly on the following parts can result in the
restraint systems not functioning as intended:
Rthe
To activate: press ! button : for at
least one second.
An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting
flashes.
X To deactivate: press ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X Press the KEYLESS-GO Start/Stop button.
The KEYLESS-GO key must be in the vehicle.
X
i The panic alarm function is only available
in Mexico.
restraint system, consisting of seat
belts and their anchorage points, belt tensioners, belt force limiters and airbags
Rthe wiring
Rnetworked electronic systems
Airbags and belt tensioners could fail to
deploy or be triggered in an accident despite
the deceleration force being sufficient to trigger the systems, or could be triggered unintentionally. For this reason, never make any
modifications to the restraint systems.
Therefore, you must not tamper with electronic components or their software.
The seat belts, together with SRS (Supplemental Restraint System), are complementary, co-ordinated restraint systems
(Y page 41). They reduce the risk of injury
in specific, pre-defined types of accident situations and thereby increase occupant
safety. However, seat belts and airbags generally do not protect against objects penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
Occupant safety
Rthe
seat and head restraint are adjusted
properly (Y page 96).
Rthe seat belt has been fastened properly
(Y page 48).
Rthe airbags can inflate unrestricted if
deployed (Y page 42).
Rthe steering wheel is adjusted properly
(Y page 102).
Rthe restraint systems have not been modified.
An airbag increases the protection of vehicle
occupants wearing a seat belt. However, airbags are only an additional restraint system
which complements, but does not replace,
the seat belt. All vehicle occupants must wear
their seat belt correctly at all times, even if
the vehicle is equipped with airbags. The airbags are not deployed in all types of accidents. For example, if the protective capacity
of correctly fastened seat belts is not
increased by deploying the airbags, the airbags will not deploy.
Airbag deployment only provides increased
protection if the seat belt is worn correctly.
First, the seat belt helps to keep the vehicle
occupant in the best position in relation to the
airbag. Second, in a head-on collision, for
example, the seat belt prevents the vehicle
occupant from being propelled towards the
point of impact.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Introduction
SRS consists of:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp
Rairbags
Rthe
airbag control unit with crash sensors
Rbelt tensioners
Rbelt force limiters
SRS reduces the risk of occupants coming
into contact with the vehicle's interior in the
event of an accident. It can also reduce the
forces to which occupants are subjected during an accident.
Safety
To ensure that the restraint systems can
deliver their full potential protection, make
sure that:
41
SRS warning lamp
G WARNING
If SRS is malfunctioning, individual systems
may be triggered unintentionally or might not
be triggered in the event of an accident with
a high rate of vehicle deceleration.
A malfunction has occurred if:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp does not light
up when the ignition is switched on.
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp does not go out after a few
seconds.
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp lights up again.
In this case, have SRS checked immediately
at a qualified specialist workshop.
SRS functions are checked regularly when
you switch on the ignition and when the
engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions
can be detected in good time.
The 6 SRS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out no later than a few seconds
after the engine is started.
Triggering of belt tensioners, belt force
limiters and airbags
During the first stage of a collision, the airbag
control unit evaluates important physical
data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rmagnitude
Based on the evaluation of this data, the airbag control unit pre-emptively triggers the
belt tensioners in the first stage.
Z
Safety
42
Occupant safety
If there is an even higher rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration in a longitudinal direction, the front airbags are also deployed.
Your vehicle has adaptive, two-stage front airbags. The airbag control unit evaluates vehicle deceleration or acceleration in the event
of a collision. In the first deployment stage,
the front airbag is filled with enough propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries. The
front airbag is fully deployed if a second
deployment threshold is reached within a few
milliseconds.
The belt tensioner and airbag triggering
thresholds are variable and are adapted to the
rate of deceleration or acceleration of the
vehicle. This process is pre-emptive in nature.
The triggering process must take place in
good time at the start of the collision.
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Rthe
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag,
nor do they provide an indication of airbag
deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly,
e.g. the bonnet or the wing, without an airbag
being deployed. This is the case if only parts
which are relatively easily deformed are affected and the rate of deceleration is not high.
Conversely, airbags may be deployed even
though the vehicle suffers only minor deformation. This is the case if, for example, very
rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body
members are hit, and sufficient deceleration
occurs as a result.
i The front belt tensioners can only be trig-
gered if the seat belt tongues on the front
seats are correctly engaged in the seat belt
buckles.
i Not all airbags are deployed in an acci-
dent. The different airbag systems work
independently of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined by the severity of the accident detected, especially the vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rhead-on
collision
impact
Roverturn
Rside
Airbags
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Airbags provide additional protection; they
are not, however, a substitute for seat belts.
Observe the following notes to reduce the risk
of serious or even fatal injury caused by airbag
deployment:
Rall
vehicle occupants – in particular, pregnant women – must wear their seat belt
correctly at all times and lean back against
the backrest, which should be positioned
as close to the vertical as possible. The
head restraint must support the back of the
head at about eye level.
Ralways secure children less than
1.50 m tall or under 12 years of age in suitable child restraint systems.
Rall vehicle occupants must select a seat
position that is as far away from the airbag
as possible. The driver's seat position must
allow the vehicle to be driven safely. The
driver's chest should be as far away from
the centre of the driver's airbag cover as
possible.
the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. This is especially important if
you have secured a child in a child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
Rvehicle occupants – in particular, children
– must not lean their heads into the area of
the window in which the sidebag/windowbag is deployed.
Rrearward-facing child restraint systems
must not be fitted to the front-passenger
seat unless the front-passenger airbag has
been disabled. On the front-passenger
seat, the front-passenger airbag is disabled
if a child restraint system with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition
is fitted to the front-passenger seat in a
vehicle equipped with automatic child seat
recognition. The 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must be continuously
lit.
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle
does not have automatic child seat recognition, or your rearward-facing child
restraint system does not have a transponder for automatic child seat recognition, children must be secured in a child
restraint system on a suitable seat in the
rear. If you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible.
Rmake sure there are no heavy or sharpedged objects in the pockets of clothing.
Rdo not lean forwards, e.g. over the cover of
the driver's/front-passenger front airbag,
particularly when the vehicle is in motion.
Rdo not put your feet on the dashboard.
Ronly hold the steering wheel on the outside.
This allows the airbag to be fully deployed.
You could be injured if the airbag is
deployed and you are holding the inside of
the steering wheel.
Rdo not lean on the doors from inside the
vehicle.
43
sure that there are no people, animals or objects between the vehicle occupants and the area where the airbags are
deployed.
Rdo not place any objects between the seat
backrest and the door.
Rdo not hang any hard objects, e.g. coat
hangers, on the grab handles or coat hooks.
Rdo not attach accessories, e.g. cup holders,
to the doors.
It is not possible to rule out a risk of injury
being caused by an airbag, due to the high
speed at which the airbag must be deployed.
Safety
Rmove
Occupant safety
Rmake
G WARNING
Airbag functionality can only be assured if the
following parts are not covered and no badges
or stickers are attached to them:
Rpadded
steering wheel boss
cover below the steering column
Rfront-passenger airbag cover
Router side of front seat bolsters
Rside trim next to the rear seat backrest
Rroof frame cover between the front A-pillar
and the C-pillar in the rear compartment
Rkneebag
G WARNING
When an airbag deploys, a small amount of
powder is released. The powder may cause
short-term breathing difficulties to persons
suffering from asthma or other pulmonary
conditions.
In order to prevent potential breathing difficulties, you should leave the vehicle as soon
as it is safe to do so. You can also open the
window to allow fresh air to enter the vehicle
interior. The powder does not constitute a
health hazard and does not indicate that there
is a fire in the vehicle.
G WARNING
The airbag parts are hot after the airbag has
been deployed. Do not touch them as you
could burn yourself.
Z
44
Occupant safety
Safety
Have the airbags replaced at a qualified specialist workshop. Otherwise, occupants are
not protected by the airbags in the event of
another accident.
Airbag deployment slows down and restricts
the movement of the vehicle occupant.
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang, and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard. The 6 SRS warning lamp
lights up.
The airbag installation locations are identified
by the AIRBAG symbol.
Front airbags
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
passenger seat. The system may then
detect that the seat is occupied and if there
is an accident, the restraint systems on the
front-passenger side could be deployed.
Have restraint systems that have been triggered replaced.
They are deployed:
Rat
the start of an accident with a high rate
of vehicle acceleration or deceleration in a
longitudinal direction
Rif the system determines that airbag
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt
Rdepending on whether the seat belt is being
used
Rindependently of other airbags in the vehicle
If the vehicle overturns, the front airbags are
generally not deployed. The front airbags are
deployed if the system detects high vehicle
deceleration in a longitudinal direction.
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat: frontpassenger airbag is only activated if the system determines that the front-passenger seat
is occupied. The 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp on the centre console
does not light up (Y page 54).
If a child restraint system is fitted to the frontpassenger seat and the 4 PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up
on the centre console:
Ra child restraint system without transpond-
ers for automatic child seat recognition is
fitted or
Ra child restraint system with transponders
is not properly fitted.
Driver's kneebag
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger front airbag ; deploys in front of and above the glove
compartment.
The front airbags increase protection for the
driver's and front-passenger's head and
chest.
Occupant safety
Rknee
injuries
Rthigh injuries
Rlower leg injuries
i The driver's kneebag is only available in
certain countries.
Sidebags
G WARNING
If you wish to use seat covers, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that, for safety reasons, you
only use seat covers that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The seat covers must have a special tear seam
for sidebags/pelvisbags. Otherwise, the sidebag/pelvisbag cannot deploy correctly and
would fail to provide the intended protection
in the event of an accident. Appropriate seat
covers can be obtained, for example, from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
When deployed, the sidebags offer additional
protection for the thorax of the vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle on which the
impact occurs. However, they do not protect
the:
Safety
Driver's kneebag : deploys under the steering column. It is deployed together with the
front airbags. The driver's kneebag is
designed to operate together with the front
airbags in frontal impacts if certain thresholds
are exceeded. The driver's kneebag operates
best in conjunction with correctly positioned
and fastened seat belts.
The driver's kneebag increases protection of
the driver against:
45
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
The sidebags are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of the use of the seat belt
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rindependently of the belt tensioners
If the vehicle overturns, the sidebags are generally not deployed. Sidebags are deployed if
the system detects high vehicle deceleration
or acceleration in a lateral direction and
determines that sidebag deployment can
offer additional protection to that provided by
the seat belt.
Rat
Pelvisbags
G WARNING
If you wish to use seat covers, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that, for safety reasons, you
only use seat covers that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The seat covers must have a special tear seam
for sidebags/pelvisbags. Otherwise, the sidebag/pelvisbag cannot deploy correctly and
would fail to provide the intended protection
in the event of an accident. Appropriate seat
covers can be obtained, for example, from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Front sidebags : and rear sidebags;
deploy next to the outer seat cushions.
Z
Occupant safety
Windowbags : enhance the level of protection for the head, but not chest or arms, of the
vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle
on which the impact occurs.
The windowbags are integrated into the side
of the roof frame and deployed in the area
from the A-pillar to the C-pillar.
Windowbags are deployed:
Safety
46
Rat
Pelvisbag deployment enhances the level of
protection of the vehicle occupants on the
side of the vehicle on which the impact
occurs.
Pelvisbags : deploy next to and below the
outer seat cushions. They are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of the use of the seat belt
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rindependently of the belt tensioners
If the vehicle overturns, the pelvisbags are
generally not deployed. Exception: if the system detects high vehicle deceleration or
acceleration in a lateral direction and determines that deployment can offer additional
protection to that provided by the seat belt.
Rat
i Pelvisbags are only available in certain
countries.
Windowbags
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Ron the side on which an impact occurs
Ron the driver's and the front passenger's
side if the vehicle overturns and the system
determines that windowbag deployment
can offer additional protection to that provided by the seat belt
Rindependently of the use of the seat belt
Rregardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
Rindependently of the front airbags
NECK-PRO head restraints/NECKPRO luxury head restraints
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Only use head restraint covers which have
been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz
for your vehicle model.
The use of non-approved head restraint covers may prevent NECK-PRO head restraints/
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints from triggering properly. The NECK-PRO head
restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
can therefore not provide the intended protection.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
regarding availability.
NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO luxury
head restraints increase protection of the
driver's and front-passenger's head and
neck. In the event of a rear collision of a cer-
Occupant safety
Resetting a triggered NECK-PRO head
restraint/NECK-PRO luxury head
restraint
NECK-PRO head restraints
NECK-PRO head restraints
Tilt the top of the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion forwards in the direction of
arrow :.
X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion
down in the direction of arrow ; as far as
it will go.
X
Firmly push the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion back in the direction of arrow =
until the cushion engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO head restraint.
X
i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints
requires a lot of strength. If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-PRO head
restraints, have this work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
Remove resetting tool : from the vehicle
document wallet.
X Slide resetting tool : into guide ;
between the NECK-PRO luxury head
restraint and the rear cover of the head
restraint.
X Push resetting tool : downwards until you
hear the head restraint deployment mechanism engage.
X Pull out resetting tool :.
X Firmly press the NECK-PRO luxury head
restraint cushion back = until it engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO luxury head restraint.
X Put resetting tool : back into the vehicle
document wallet.
X
i If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-
PRO luxury head restraints, have this work
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Safety
tain severity, the NECK-PRO head restraints/
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints on the driver's and front-passenger seats are moved forwards and upwards. This provides better
head support.
If the NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO
luxury head restraints have been triggered in
an accident, reset the NECK-PRO head
restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
on the driver's and front-passenger seats
(Y page 47). Otherwise, the additional protection will not be available in the event of
another rear-end collision. NECK-PRO head
restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
that have been triggered are moved forwards
and can no longer be adjusted.
Mercedes-Benz recommends having the
NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO head
restraints checked at a qualified specialist
workshop after a rear-end collision.
47
48
Occupant safety
PRE-SAFE® (preventative occupant
protection)
Safety
G WARNING
When adjusting the seat, make sure that
nobody can become trapped.
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats when moving
the seat back. There is a risk that the seats
and/or the objects could be damaged.
PRE-SAFE® takes pre-emptive measures to
protect occupants in certain hazardous situations.
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
Rwhen
BAS activates, e.g. in emergency
braking situations
Rwhen BAS PLUS intervenes powerfully on
vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS
Rif, on vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS, the
radar sensor system detects an imminent
danger of collision in certain situations
Rin critical driving situations, e.g. when physical limits are exceeded and the vehicle
understeers or oversteers severely
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe
front seat belts are pre-tensioned.
with the memory function: the
front-passenger seat is adjusted if it is in an
unfavourable position.
Rvehicles with a multicontour seat or active
multicontour seat: the air pressure in the
side bolsters of the seat cushion and backrest is increased.
Rif the vehicle skids, the sliding sunroof/
panorama sliding sunroof and the side windows are closed so that only a small gap
remains.
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens
the belt pretensioning. The air pressure in the
side bolsters on the multicontour seat/active
multicontour seat is reduced again. All setRvehicles
tings made by PRE-SAFE® can then be
reversed.
If the seat belts are not released:
X
Move the backrest or seat back slightly, but
only when the vehicle is stationary.
The belt pretensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism is released.
More information about seat belt adjustment,
a convenience function integrated into PRESAFE®, can be found under "Seat belt adjustment" (Y page 50).
Seat belts
Important safety notes
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or
which has not been engaged in the seat belt
buckle correctly, cannot provide the intended
level of protection. Under certain circumstances, this could cause severe or even fatal injuries in the event of an accident.
Therefore, make sure that all occupants — in
particular, pregnant women — wear their seat
belts correctly at all times.
RThe
seat belt must fit snugly on your body
and must not be twisted.Therefore, avoid
wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter coat.
The shoulder section of the belt must be
routed across the centre of your shoulder
— on no account across your neck or under
your arm — and pulled tight against your
upper body. The lap belt must always pass
across your lap as low down as possible, i.e.
over your hip joints — not across your abdomen. If necessary, push the seat belt
slightly downwards and adjust it by pulling
it in the direction the seat belt retracts.
RDo not route the seat belt strap over sharp
or fragile objects. Please make sure that
such objects are not on or in your clothing,
e.g. spectacles, pens or keys etc. The seat
belt strap could become damaged and tear
during an accident and you or other vehicle
occupants could be injured.
ROnly one person should use each seat belt
at any one time. Children must never travel
sitting on the lap of another occupant. The
child will not be secured in the event of an
accident, heavy braking or sudden change
of direction. This may result in the child or
other occupants being seriously or fatally
injured.
RPersons under 1.50 m tall cannot wear the
seat belts correctly. For this reason secure
persons less than 1.50 m tall in specially
designed, suitable restraint systems.
RChildren under 1.50 m tall and younger
than twelve years of age cannot wear the
seat belts correctly. For this reason secure
them in special suitable child restraint systems installed on a suitable seat. Additional
information can be found in the Operating
Instructions in the chapter "Safety", "Children in the Vehicle". Observe the installation instructions of the child restraint system manufacturer.
RDo not secure an object with a seat belt if
the seat belt is also being used by one of
the vehicle's occupants.
For this reason, check regularly that the seat
belts are not damaged or dirty.
Always have damaged seat belts or seat belts
that have been subjected to a load in an accident replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use seat belts which have
been approved by Mercedes-Benz for your
vehicle.
Seat belts are the most effective means of
restraining the movement of vehicle occupants in the event of an accident. This
reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming
into contact with parts of the vehicle interior.
Fastening seat belts
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection unless the backrest is almost
vertical. Under certain circumstances, this
could cause severe or even fatal injuries in the
event of an accident.
Before starting a journey, make sure that the
seat is properly adjusted and that the backrest is almost vertical.
G WARNING
A dirty or damaged seat belt or one that has
been modified or subjected to a load in an
accident no longer offers the intended level of
protection. Under certain circumstances, this
could cause severe or even fatal injuries in the
event of an accident.
Adjust the seat and move the backrest to
an almost vertical position (Y page 96).
X Pull the seat belt smoothly through belt
sash guide :.
X Without twisting it, guide the shoulder section of the seat belt across the middle of
your shoulder and the lap section across
your pelvis.
X Engage belt tongue ; in buckle =.
Seat-belt adjustment: if necessary, the
driver's and front-passenger seat belts
X
Z
49
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
50
Occupant safety
automatically adjust to the upper body
(Y page 50).
X If necessary, adjust the seat belt to the
appropriate height (Y page 50).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
Belt height adjustment
For more information about releasing the seat
belt with release button ?, see "Releasing
seat belts" (Y page 50).
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment function adjusts the
driver's and front-passenger seat belt to the
upper body of the occupants.
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Ryou
engage the belt tongue in the belt
buckle and you then turn the key to position
2 in the ignition lock.
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
and you then engage the belt tongue in the
buckle.
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected
between the occupant and the seat belt. Do
not hold on to the seat belt tightly while it is
adjusting. You can switch the belt adjustment
on and off in the on-board computer
(Y page 227).
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. More
information about PRE-SAFE® can be found
under "PRE-SAFE® (preventative occupant
protection)" (Y page 48).
You can adjust the belt height for the front
seats. Adjust the belt to a height that allows
the upper part of the seat belt to be routed
across the centre of your shoulder.
X To raise: slide the belt sash guide upwards.
The belt sash guide engages in various positions.
X To lower: press and hold belt sash guide
release :.
X Slide the belt sash guide downwards.
X Let go of belt sash guide release : and
make sure that the belt sash guide has
engaged.
Releasing the seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfil their
protective function and must be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Occupant safety
51
Safety
Rear seat belt status indicator
Display for securely fastened occupants on left
side of rear compartment (example)
X
X
Press release button ? on belt buckle =.
Slide belt tongue ; back to belt sash
guide :.
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder for all occupants
to fasten their seat belts. It may light up continuously or flash. In addition, there may be a
warning tone.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone ceases when the driver and
the front passenger have fastened their seat
belt.
For certain countries only: regardless of
whether the driver and the front passenger
have fastened their seat belts, the 7 seat
belt warning lamp lights up for six seconds
after the engine is started. It then goes out if
the driver and the front passenger have fastened their seat belts.
i For more information on the 7 seat
belt warning lamp, see "Indicator and warning lamps in the instrument cluster, seat
belt" (Y page 259).
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator tells you if the rear passengers have
their seat belts fastened. The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator indicates the
rear seat on which the belt is fastened. The
ü symbol in the display indicates a fastened seat belt. If a seat belt is not fastened
or if a seat is not occupied, the ý symbol
is displayed.
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator appears in the multifunction display for
around 30 seconds if:
Ryou
drive off and reach a speed of approximately 10 km/h.
Rthe rear passengers fasten or unfasten
their seat belts while the vehicle is in
motion.
Rsomeone gets in or out of the vehicle and
the vehicle drives off again.
You can also cancel the rear seat belt status
indicator immediately (Y page 231).
i The status indicator for the rear-compartment seat belts is only available for certain
countries.
Belt tensioners, belt force limiters
G WARNING
If the seat belt tensioners have been triggered, they provide no additional protection
in the event of another accident. Therefore,
have belt tensioners which have been triggered replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
52
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Comply with safety regulations when disposing of belt tensioners. Any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre can provide details of these
regulations.
! If the front-passenger seat is not occu-
pied, do not engage the seat belt tongue in
the buckle on the front-passenger seat.
Otherwise, the belt tensioner could be triggered in the event of an accident.
The seat belts are fitted with belt tensioners.
The belt tensioners tighten the seat belts in
an accident, pulling them close against the
body.
Belt tensioners do not correct incorrect seat
positions or incorrectly fastened seat belts.
Belt tensioners do not pull vehicle occupants
back towards the backrest.
If the seat belt is also fitted with a belt force
limiter and this is triggered, the force exerted
by the seat belt on the vehicle occupant is
reduced.
The belt force limiters for the front seats are
synchronised with the front airbags, which
take on a part of the deceleration force. This
results in the force exerted on the occupant
being distributed over a greater area.
The belt tensioners can only be activated
when:
Rthe
ignition is switched on.
restraint systems are operational; see
"SRS warning lamp" (Y page 41).
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on
each of the three-point seat belts in front.
Rthe
R
The belt tensioners on the seats in the rear
compartment are triggered independently of
the lock status of the seat belts.
The belt tensioners are triggered depending
on the type and severity of an accident:
Rif, in the event of a head-on or rear-end col-
lision the vehicle decelerates or acceler-
ates rapidly in a longitudinal direction during the initial stages of the impact
Rif, in the event of a side impact, on the side
opposite the impact the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a lateral direction
Rin certain situations where the vehicle overturns and the system determines that it can
provide additional protection
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang, and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard. The 6 SRS warning lamp
lights up.
Children in the vehicle
Child restraint systems
Important safety notes
G WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
Rchildren
less than 1.50 m tall and under
twelve years of age must always be secured
in special child restraint systems on a suitable vehicle seat. This is necessary
because the seat belts are not designed for
children.
RDo not drive with a child secured in a rearward-facing child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat. Exception: if the vehicle is equipped with automatic child seat
recognition on the front-passenger seat
and the child is secured in a child restraint
system with transponders for automatic
child seat recognition
Rif you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible.
Rchildren must never travel sitting on the lap
of another occupant. Due to the forces
which occur in the event of a sudden
change of direction, heavy braking or an
accident, it would not be possible to
restrain the child. The child could be thrown
against parts of the vehicle interior and be
seriously or even fatally injured.
G WARNING
The child restraint system cannot perform its
protective function if it is not correctly fitted
to a suitable vehicle seat. The child cannot be
restrained in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. The
child could be seriously or even fatally injured.
For this reason, when fitting a child restraint
system, observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the correct use of the
child restraint system.
Child restraint systems should be fitted to the
rear seats. Children are generally better protected there.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion. Therefore, never place objects, e.g. a cushion,
under the child restraint system.
Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for them. Only replace
damaged covers with genuine Mercedes-Benz
covers.
We recommend the use of child restraint systems which have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
G WARNING
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. They could injure themselves on parts of the vehicle. They could also
be seriously or even fatally injured by prolonged exposure to extreme heat or cold.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. Parts of the child restraint sys-
tem could heat up and the child could burn
herself/himself on them.
If a child opens a door, the child or other persons could be injured as a result. They could
get out and injure themselves or be injured by
a passing vehicle.
Observe the general notes on the HOLD function, which can be found under the same keyword.
G WARNING
Unsecured or incorrectly positioned loads
increase the risk of injury for children and all
other occupants in the event of:
Ran
accident
braking
Ra sudden change of direction
Do not transport heavy or hard objects in the
vehicle interior unless they are secured. You
will find further information under "Loading
guidelines" in the index.
Rsudden
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, secure
the child using a child restraint system which
is recommended for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The child restraint system must be appropriate to the age, weight and size of the child.
Ideally the child restraint system should be
installed on a suitable rear seat. Make sure
that the child is secured for the trip.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
the listed child restraint systems
(Y page 60). You can obtain further information about the correct child restraint system from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products to clean child restraint systems.
You can obtain information about this at
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Z
53
Safety
Children in the vehicle
54
Children in the vehicle
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
G WARNING
Safety
If the front-passenger airbag is not disabled:
Ra
child secured in a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat could be seriously and even fatally injured by the frontpassenger airbag deploying. This is especially a risk if the child is in the immediate
vicinity of the front-passenger airbag when
it deploys.
Rnever secure a child on the front-passenger
seat in a rearward-facing child restraint system. Only secure a rearward-facing child
restraint system on a suitable rear seat.
Ralways move the front-passenger seat to
the rearmost position if you secure a child
in a forward-facing child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat.
The front-passenger airbag is not disabled:
Ron
vehicles without automatic child seat
recognition on the front-passenger seat
Rin vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat, if no
special child restraint system with transponders for automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat has been
fitted
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat, if the
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
4 is not lit.
To make you aware of this danger, a corresponding warning sticker has been affixed on
the dashboard and on both sides of the sun
visor on the front-passenger side.
Information about recommended child
restraint systems is available at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Warning notice on the front-passenger sun visor
Warning symbol for a rearward-facing child
restraint system
Do not use a rearward-facing child restraint
system on a seat that is protected by an airbag installed in front of it.
Automatic child seat recognition on the
front-passenger seat
G WARNING
If the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up when the child
restraint system is fitted, the front-passenger
airbag has not been disabled. If the frontpassenger airbag deploys, the child could be
seriously or even fatally injured.
Proceed as follows:
Rdo not use a rearward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
a rearward-facing child restraint system
on a suitable rear seat.
Rfit
or
Children in the vehicle
Ronly
G WARNING
Do not place electronic devices on the frontpassenger seat, e.g.:
Rlaptops,
when switched on
phones
Rcards with transponders, e.g. ski passes or
access cards
Signals from electronic equipment can cause
interference in the automatic child seat recognition sensor system. This can lead to a
system malfunction. This may cause the
4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp to light up without there being a child
seat with transponders for automatic child
seat recognition fitted. The front-passenger
airbag will not then deploy during an accident.
It is also possible that the 6 SRS warning
lamp lights up and/or the 4 PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up
briefly when you turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 2.
Rmobile
Safety
use a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat and
move the front-passenger seat to the rearmost position.
Rhave the automatic child seat recognition
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
To ensure that the automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat functions/communicates correctly, never place
objects, e.g. a cushion, under the child
restraint system. The entire base of the child
restraint system must always rest on the seat
cushion. An incorrectly fitted child restraint
system cannot perform its intended protective function in the event of an accident, and
could lead to injuries.
55
If your vehicle does not have automatic child
seat recognition on the front-passenger seat,
this is indicated by a special sticker. The
sticker is affixed to the side of the dashboard
on the front-passenger side. The sticker is
visible when you open the front-passenger
door.
Vehicles without automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat: when you
turn the key to position 2 in the ignition lock,
the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp lights up briefly, but does not have any
function. It does not indicate that there is
automatic child seat recognition on the frontpassenger seat.
The front-passenger seat sensor system for
child restraint systems detects whether a
special Mercedes-Benz child seat with a
transponder for automatic child seat recognition has been fitted. In this case, 4
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp :
lights up. The front-passenger front airbag is
disabled.
Z
56
Children in the vehicle
i If the front-passenger front airbag is dis-
Safety
abled by the automatic child seat recognition, the following remain enabled on the
front-passenger side:
Rthe
sidebag
pelvisbag
Rthe windowbag
Rthe belt tensioner
Rthe
ISOFIX child seat securing system for
the rear seats
G WARNING
A child restraint system secured by the ISOFIX
child seat securing system does not provide
sufficient protection for children weighing
more than 22 kg. For this reason, do not
secure children weighing more than 22 kg in
a child restraint system secured by the ISOFIX
child seat securing system. If the child weighs
more than 22 kg, secure the child restraint
system with the vehicle seat belt as well. In
addition, when fitting a child restraint system,
be sure to observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the instructions for
correct use of the child restraint system.
G WARNING
Please note that if child restraint systems, or
their retaining systems, are damaged or subjected to a load in an accident, they may not
be able to provide their protective function.
This could result in serious or even fatal injuries to the secured child in the event of an
accident, heavy braking or a sudden change
in direction.
For this reason, have child restraint systems
and their anchorages which have been damaged or subjected to a load in an accident
checked immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
When installing the ISOFIX child restraint system, fold protective caps ; of securing
rings : inwards.
X
Install the ISOFIX child restraint system.
Comply with the manufacturer's instructions when installing the ISOFIX child
restraint system.
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. Securing rings for two ISOFIX
child restraint systems are fitted on the left
and right of the rear seats.
Children in the vehicle
Top Tether anchorages
Slide down head restraint : until it
engages (Y page 99).
Make sure that you do not interfere with the
correct routing of Top Tether belt A.
X Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with
Top Tether. Comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
Make sure that Top Tether belt A is tight.
X
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured
with ISOFIX and the rear seat. It helps reduce
the risk of injury even further.
The Top Tether anchorage points are located
in the rear compartment behind the head
restraints.
X Move head restraint : upwards.
X Fold up cover ; of Top Tether anchorage
=.
X Route Top Tether belt A under head
restraint : between the two head restraint
bars.
X Hook Top Tether hook ? into Top Tether
anchorage =.
X Make sure that Top Tether belt A is not
twisted.
X Fold down cover ; of Top Tether anchorage =.
Z
Safety
Top Tether
57
Children in the vehicle
58
Safety
Problems with child seat recognition
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The 4 PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp on the centre console is lit.
A special Mercedes-Benz child seat with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition has been fitted to the front-passenger
seat. The front-passenger front airbag has therefore been disabled
as desired.
The 4 PASSENGER
G Risk of injury
AIRBAG OFF indicator
There is no child seat fitted to the front-passenger seat. Automatic
lamp on the centre conchild seat recognition is malfunctioning.
sole is lit.
X Remove electronic equipment from the front-passenger seat,
or
e.g.:
The 6 warning lamp
Rlaptop
lights up and/or the
Rmobile phone
4 PASSENGER AIRRcards with transponders, such as ski passes or access cards
BAG OFF indicator
lamp does not light up If the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp is still lit:
briefly when you switch
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
the ignition on.
Suitable positioning of the child
restraint systems
X
To install a child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat: move the frontpassenger seat to the rearmost position
and the belt outlet height to the lowest
position.
Key to the letters used in the following table:
X
Seat which is unsuitable for children in
this weight category.
U Suitable for child restraint systems in the
"Universal" category that are approved
for use in this weight category.
UF Suitable for forward-facing child restraint
systems that belong to the "Universal"
category and are approved for use in this
weight category.
L Suitable for child restraint systems as
recommended, see the following table of
"Recommended child restraint systems"
(Y page 60).
Front-passenger seat
Weight categories
Frontpassenger
airbag is
not disabled:
Frontpassenger
front airbag is disabled.
Category 0:
up to 10 kg
X
U, L
Category
0+: up to
13 kg
X
U, L
Category I:
9 to 18 kg
UF, L
U, L
Group II: 15
to 25 kg
UF, L
U, L
Group III:
UF, L
22 to 36 kg
U, L
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat: a "Universal" category child restraint system with a
transponder for automatic child seat recognition must be fitted when the frontpassenger airbag is disabled. The 4
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
must be lit.
Rear seats
Weight categories
Left, right
Group 0: up to
10 kg
U, L
Category 0+: up to
13 kg
U, L
Category I: 9 to
18 kg
U, L
Category II: 15 to
25 kg
U, L
Group III: 22 to
36 kg
U, L
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be recognised by their orange approval
label.
Example: approval label on the child restraint system
Suitability of the rear seats for attaching
ISOFIX child restraint systems
Key to the letters used in the following table:
X
ISOFIX position that is not suitable for
ISOFIX child restraint systems in this
weight category and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child
restraint systems that belong to the
IL
"Universal" category which are approved
for use in this weight category.
Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the following table of "Recommended child
restraint systems" (Y page 60).
Carry-cot weight category
Size category
Equipment Rear seat,
left and
right
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
Weight category 0: up to 10 kg, up to
approximately 6 months
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
E
ISO/R1
IL
Weight category 0+: up to 13 kg, up to
approximately 15 months
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
E
ISO/R1
IL
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL
Weight category I: 9 to 18 kg, approximately 9 months to 4 years
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL
B
ISO/F2
IUF
Z
59
Safety
Children in the vehicle
Children in the vehicle
Safety
60
Weight category I: 9 to 18 kg, approximately 9 months to 4 years
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat,
left and
right
ISO/F2X
IUF
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
B1
A
ISO/F3
IUF
Type
DUO PLUS
DUO PLUS
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301133
04 301133
03 301133
04 301133
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 11 00
970 16 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Recommended child restraint systems
When installing a child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat:
X
Move the front-passenger seat to its lowest
and rearmost position.
Weight category 0: up to 10 kg, up to
approximately 6 months
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
BABY SAFE PLUS
Approval number
(E1 ...)
03 301146
04 301146
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 10 00
Automatic child
seat recognition
Yes
Weight category 0+: up to 13 kg, up to
approximately 15 months
Weight category II/III: 15 to 36 kg,
approximately 4 to 12 years
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Type
KID
KID
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
03 301148
04 301148
03 301148
04 301148
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 12 00
970 17 00
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
BABY SAFE PLUS
Approval number
(E1 ...)
03 301146
04 301146
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 10 00
Manufacturer
Britax Römer Britax Römer
Automatic child
seat recognition
Yes
Type
KIDFIX
KIDFIX
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
04 301198
04 301198
Order number
(A 000 ...)
970 18 00
970 19 00
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
04 301146
–
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Yes
No
Order number
B6 6 86
8224
–
Automatic
child seat
recognition
No
–
Suggested "Universal" category ISOFIX
child restraint systems:
Carry-cot weight category
Category I: 9 to 18 kg
Size categories
F, G
Size categories
D, C, B, A
Manufacturer
–
Manufacturer
–
Type
–
Type
–
Approval number
(E1 ...)
–
Approval number
(E1 ...)
–
Order number
–
Order number
–
Automatic child
seat recognition
–
Automatic child
seat recognition
–
Size category
B1
Manufacturer
Britax Römer
Type
DUO PLUS
Approval number
(E1 ...)
03 301133
04 301133
Order number
A000 970 11 00
Automatic child
seat recognition
Yes
Category 0: up to 10 kg
Size category
E
Manufacturer
–
Type
–
Approval number
(E1 ...)
–
Order number
–
Automatic child
seat recognition
–
Category 0+: up to 13 kg
Size catego- E
ries
Child-proof locks
D, C
Manufacturer
Britax Römer –
Type
BABY SAFE –
ISOFIX PLUS
61
Safety
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Activate the child-proof locks for the rear
doors and the override switch for the rear
windows when children are travelling in the
vehicle. Otherwise, the children could open
Z
62
Driving safety systems
doors or side windows while the vehicle is in
motion and injure themselves or others.
Override feature for the rear side windows
Safety
G WARNING
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. They could injure themselves on parts of the vehicle. They could also
be seriously or even fatally injured by prolonged exposure to extreme heat or cold.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. Parts of the child restraint system could heat up and the child could burn
herself/himself on them.
If a child opens a door, the child or other persons could be injured as a result. They could
get out and injure themselves or be injured by
a passing vehicle.
Also observe the notes on HOLD. Relevant
information can be found in the index.
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
X
To activate/deactivate: press button ;.
If indicator lamp : is lit, operation of the
rear side windows is disabled. Operation is
only possible using the switches in the driver's door. If indicator lamp : is off, operation is possible using the switches in the
rear compartment.
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS
You secure each door individually with the
child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the
vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened
from the outside.
X To activate: press the child-proof lock
lever up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
(Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 63)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 63)
RBAS PLUS(Brake Assist System PLUS)
(Y page 64)
RAdaptive brake lamps (Y page 65)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 65)
REBD (electronic brake force distribution)
(Y page 68)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 68)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 68)
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style or if you
are inattentive, the driving safety systems can
neither reduce the risk of accident nor override the laws of physics. Driving safety systems are merely aids designed to assist driving. You are responsible for the distance to
the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed and for
braking in good time. Always adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and
weather conditions and maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive carefully.
i The driving safety systems described only
work as effectively as possible when there
is adequate contact between the tyres and
the road surface. Please pay special attention to the notes on tyres, recommended
minimum tyre tread depths, etc.
(Y page 328).
In wintry driving conditions, always use
winter tyres (M+S tyres) and, if necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section
work as effectively as possible.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 62).
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
When ABS is malfunctioning, other systems,
including driving safety systems, will also
become inoperative. Observe the information
on the ABS warning lamp (Y page 261) and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster (Y page 232).
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
ABS works from a speed of about 8 km/h
upwards, regardless of road-surface conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces, even
when you only brake gently.
The yellow ! ABS warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up when the ignition
is switched on. It goes out when the engine is
running.
Brakes
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
X
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel
a pulsing in the brake pedal.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions and functions as a reminder to take extra care while
driving.
BAS (Brake Assist System)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 62).
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
Z
63
Safety
Driving safety systems
64
Driving safety systems
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System Plus)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
Safety
tion (Y page 62).
BAS PLUS is only available on vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS.
BAS PLUS provides braking assistance in hazardous situations at speeds greater than
7 km/h and uses radar sensor technology to
assess the traffic situation.
With the help of the radar sensor system, BAS
PLUS can detect obstacles that are in the
path of your vehicle for an extended period of
time.
At speeds up to approximately 70 km/h, BAS
PLUS may also detect stationary obstacles,
for example, stopped or parked vehicles.
To prevent a front-end collision, BAS PLUS
calculates the brake force necessary if:
Ryou
approach an obstacle, and
PLUS has detected a risk of collision
If you are driving at a speed over
30 km/h: if you depress the brake sharply,
BAS PLUS automatically raises the brake
pressure to a value adapted to the traffic situation.
If you are driving at a speed under
30 km/h: if you depress the brake, BAS PLUS
is activated. Braking will be carried out at the
last possible moment.
If BAS PLUS demands particularly high braking force, preventative passenger protection
measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated simultaneously.
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
RBAS
BAS PLUS is deactivated and the brakes function as usual, if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal.
is no longer any danger of a rear-end
collision.
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle.
Rthere
The radar sensor system is switched off automatically in the vicinity of radio telescope
facilities in the following vehicles:
Rvehicles
with COMAND Online and navigation
Rvehicles with Audio 20 and Becker® MAP
PILOT
Becker® MAP PILOT must be connected;
see the separate operating instructions.
The radar sensor system must be switched off
using the on-board computer in the vicinity of
radio telescope facilities in the following vehicles:
Rvehicles
without COMAND Online and navigation
Rvehicles without Audio 20 and Becker®
MAP PILOT
Rvehicles for Australia
For information on switching off the radar
sensor system using the on-board computer,
see (Y page 225).
For BAS PLUS to assist you when driving, the
radar sensor system must:
Rbe
switched on (Y page 225)
operational (Y page 245)
If the radar sensor system is malfunctioning,
BAS PLUS will not be available. The brake
system is still available with complete brake
boosting effect and BAS.
Rbe
G WARNING
BAS PLUS cannot always clearly identify
objects and complex traffic situations. BAS
PLUS cannot intervene in these cases. There
is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if there is:
Rdirt
on the sensors or anything else covering the sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Driving safety systems
possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example, in multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
G WARNING
BAS PLUS does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, BAS PLUS may not intervene in all
critical situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensors checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Adaptive brake lamps
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS
or BAS PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly.
In this way, traffic travelling behind you is
warned in an even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning button (Y page 114).
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 62).
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle. In addition, other driving
safety systems are switched off. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have ESP® checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! Vehicles with 4MATIC: switch off the igni-
tion when the parking brake is being tested
using a dynamometer.
Application of the brakes by ESP® may otherwise destroy the brake system.
Vehicles without 4MATIC: observe the notes
on ESP® if the vehicle is being towed with the
rear axle raised (Y page 322).
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ warning lamp and the å warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 263) and display messages which
may be shown in the instrument cluster
(Y page 232).
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilise the
vehicle. The engine output is also modified to
keep the vehicle on the desired course within
physical limits. ESP® assists the driver when
pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP®
can also stabilise the vehicle during braking.
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
Z
Safety
Rthe
65
Driving safety systems
66
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
Safety
X
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tyre sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
Traction control is part of ESP®.
Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull
away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for
example if the road surface is slippery on one
side. On vehicles with 4MATIC, more drive
torque is also transferred to the wheel or
wheels with traction.
Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP®.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
AMG vehicles)
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
X
To deactivate: (Y page 219).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X
To activate: (Y page 219).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP® was
deactivated before the engine was switched
off, ESP® remains deactivated when the
engine is switched on again.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
If you deactivate ESP®:
Rin
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
Rengine torque is not limited and the drive
wheels are able to spin. The spinning of the
wheels results in a cutting action for better
traction.
Rtraction
Deactivating/activating ESP® (AMG
vehicles)
Activating/deactivating SPORT handling
mode
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is activated,
there is a greater risk of skidding and accidents.
Only activate SPORT handling mode in the situations described in the following.
Driving safety systems
67
To activate: briefly press button :.
The M SPORT handling mode warning
lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
The SPORT handling mode message
appears in the multifunction display.
handling mode is designed for driving on
designated roads when the vehicle's own
oversteering and understeering characteristics are desired. Driving in SPORT handling mode requires an extremely qualified
and experienced driver who is able to cope
with these critical driving conditions.
X To deactivate: briefly press button :.
The M handling mode warning lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out.
X
still provides support when you
brake.
Rengine torque is restricted to a limited
degree and the drive wheels are able to
spin. The spinning of the wheels results in
a cutting action for better traction.
Vehicles with the ECO start/stop function:
the ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically when the vehicle
comes to a stop. When pulling away again, the
engine starts automatically. ESP® remains in
its previously selected status. Example: if
ESP® was deactivated before the engine was
switched off, ESP® remains deactivated when
the engine is switched on again.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
It may be best to activate SPORT handling
mode in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one
or more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP®
warning lamp in the instrument cluster
flashes. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle to a
limited degree.
If SPORT handling mode is activated:
Rin
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a
limited degree.
Rtraction control is still activated.
X
To deactivate: press button : until the
å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
The ÷OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
Deactivate ESP® when driving on designated roads when the vehicle's own oversteering and understeering characteristics
are desired. Driving without ESP® requires
an extremely qualified and experienced
Z
Safety
RESP®
Driving safety systems
68
Safety
X
driver who is able to cope with these critical
driving conditions.
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
To activate: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷ ON
message appears in the multifunction display.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
If you deactivate ESP®:
Rin
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
control is still activated.
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available; nor is it
activated if you brake firmly and ESP® intervenes.
RPRE-SAFE® Brake is no longer available; it
is also not activated if you brake firmly and
ESP® intervenes.
RABS still provides support when you brake.
Rengine torque is no longer limited and the
drive wheels are able to spin. The spinning
of the wheels results in a cutting action for
better traction.
Vehicles with ECO start/stop function: the
ECO start/stop function switches the engine
off automatically when the vehicle comes to
a stop. When pulling away again, the engine
starts automatically. ESP® remains in its previously selected status. Example: if ESP® was
deactivated before the engine was switched
off, ESP® remains deactivated when the
engine is switched on again.
Rtraction
tion (Y page 62).
G WARNING
If EBD has malfunctioned, the rear wheels can
still lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 261) as well as display messages (Y page 234).
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 179) and
hill start assist (Y page 144).
PRE-SAFE® Brake
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 62).
PRE-SAFE® Brake is only available in vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
PRE-SAFE® Brake can help you to minimise
the risk of a collision with a vehicle ahead or
reduce the effects of such a collision. If PRESAFE® Brake detects a risk of collision, you
will be warned visually and acoustically as
well as by automatic braking. PRE-SAFE®
Brake cannot prevent a collision without your
intervention.
This function will issue a warning if:
Rat speeds of around 30 km/h or more, over
several seconds, the distance maintained
to the vehicle travelling in front is insufficient.
The · distance warning lamp then lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Rat a speed of approximately 7 km/h or
higher, you very quickly approach a vehicle
in front.
An intermittent warning tone will then
sound and the · distance warning lamp
will light up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately in order to increase the
distance from the vehicle in front.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
From a speed of approximately 7 km/h, if the
driver and passengers have fastened their
seat belts, PRE-SAFE® Brake can brake the
vehicle automatically at speeds up to approximately 200 km/h.
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated driving conditions may cause
unnecessary warnings or the unnecessary
intervention of PRE-SAFE® Brake.
You can prevent the intervention of the PRESAFE® Brake at any time by:
Rdepressing
the accelerator pedal further
Ractivating kickdown
Rreleasing the brake pedal.
The braking action of PRE-SAFE® Brake is
ended automatically if:
Ryou
manoeuvre to avoid the obstacle.
is no longer any danger of a rear-end
collision.
Rthere is no longer an obstacle detected in
front of your vehicle.
With the help of the radar sensor system,
PRE-SAFE® Brake can detect obstacles that
are in front of your vehicle for an extended
period of time.
Rthere
At speeds up to approximately 70 km/h,PRESAFE® Brake can also detect stationary
obstacles such as stopped or parked vehicles.
If you approach an obstacle and PRE-SAFE®
Brake detects a risk of a collision, the system
will alert you both visually and acoustically. If
you do not brake or take evasive action, the
system will warn you by automatically braking
the vehicle gently. If there is an increased risk
of collision, preventative passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated
(Y page 48). If, at speeds over 30 km/h, a risk
of collision remains and you do not brake,
take evasive action or significantly accelerate, automatic braking may be performed up
to a level of automatic emergency braking.
Automatic emergency braking is not performed until immediately prior to an accident
that can no longer be avoided.
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake will initially brake your vehicle by a partial application of the brakes if a
danger of collision is detected. There may be
a collision unless you also brake. Automatic
emergency braking cannot prevent a collision. There is a risk of an accident.
Always apply the brakes yourself and try to
take evasive action.
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake cannot always clearly identify objects and complex traffic conditions.
In these cases, PRE-SAFE® Brake may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rneither give a warning nor intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay particular attention to the traffic
situation and be ready to brake, especially if
PRE-SAFE® Brake warns you. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Z
69
Safety
Driving safety systems
70
Anti-theft systems
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if there is:
Safety
Rdirt
on the sensors or anything else covering the sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example, in multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorcycle
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Rto
As a result, PRE-SAFE® Brake may neither
give warnings nor intervene in all critical situations. There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
In order to maintain the appropriate distance
to the vehicle in front and thus prevent a collision, you must apply the brakes yourself.
X To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate PRE-SAFE® Brake in the on-board
computer (Y page 219).
When PRE-SAFE® Brake is activated, the
Ä symbol appears in multifunction display, as long as the HOLD function is deactivated (Y page 179). On vehicles with the
Active Parking Assist driving system, the
Ä symbol is displayed when position P
is engaged or you are driving faster than
35 km/h.
For PRE-SAFE® Brake to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system must be
switched on (Y page 225) and be operational.
The radar sensor system is switched off automatically in the vicinity of radio telescope
facilities in the following vehicles:
Rvehicles
with COMAND Online and navigation
Rvehicles with Audio 20 and Becker® MAP
PILOT
Becker® MAP PILOT must be connected;
see the separate operating instructions.
The radar sensor system must be switched off
using the on-board computer in the vicinity of
radio telescope facilities in the following vehicles:
Rvehicles
without COMAND Online and navigation
Rvehicles without Audio 20 and Becker®
MAP PILOT
Rvehicles for Australia
For information on switching off the radar
sensor system using the on-board computer,
see (Y page 225).
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensors checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Anti-theft systems
Immobiliser
To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO: switch the
ignition off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
X
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Anyone can
start the engine if a valid key has been left
inside the vehicle.
Anti-theft systems
when you start the engine.
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
Tow-away protection
Function
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This can occur
if the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for
example.
Activating
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately
15 seconds.
X To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
X
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Make sure that:
Rthe doors are closed.
Rthe boot lid is closed.
Only then is the tow-away protection
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X
Ra
To deactivate
Rthe
X
door
vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe boot lid
Rthe bonnet
X To turn the alarm off with the key: press
the % or & button on the key.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
X
To switch off: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is switched off automatically.
Deactivating
To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key
must be outside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
Z
Safety
i The immobiliser is always deactivated
71
Anti-theft systems
72
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated.
Safety
X
Tow-away protection remains deactivated
until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again and
door is opened and closed again and
Rthe vehicle is locked again
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the towaway protection if you lock your vehicle and
it:
Ra
being transported
being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter, for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a
split-level garage
Rthe
doors are closed.
sliding sunroof is closed.
Rthe boot lid is closed.
Only then is the interior motion sensor
primed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
Rthe
To deactivate
X
Ris
Ris
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is switched off
automatically.
Deactivating
Interior motion sensor
Function
When the interior motion sensor is primed, a
visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior. This
can occur if someone reaches into the vehicle
interior, for example.
Activating
Make sure that:
Rthe side windows are closed.
Rthe sliding sunroof is closed.
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging on the rear-view mirror or on the grab
handles on the roof trim.
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that:
X
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated.
X
X
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again and
door is opened and closed again and
Rthe vehicle is locked again
Ra
Anti-theft systems
73
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior motion sensor if you lock your vehicle
and:
Rpeople
or animals remain in the vehicle.
side windows remain open.
Rthe sliding sunroof remains open.
Safety
Rthe
i UK only: your vehicle is equipped with a
double lock function. The doors cannot be
opened from the inside if the vehicle was
locked with the key or with KEYLESS-GO
(Y page 82). Deactivate the interior
motion sensor before you lock the vehicle.
The doors can then be opened from the
inside after the vehicle has been locked
from the outside. Observe the "Important
safety notes" (Y page 82).
Z
74
75
76
76
82
85
87
91
Opening and closing
Useful information ..............................
Key .......................................................
Doors ....................................................
Boot ......................................................
Side windows ......................................
Sliding sunroof ....................................
76
Key
Useful information
Opening and closing
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 23).
Key
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key or with KEYLESS-GO, the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open
the doors from inside the vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people requiring special assistance. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. They
could be seriously or even fatally injured by
prolonged exposure to extremely high or low
temperatures, for example. In this case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle. The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside.
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen
a door from inside the vehicle at any
time, even if it has been locked
Rstart the vehicle using a key which has been
left in the vehicle
Rrelease the parking brake
They could thereby endanger themselves and
others. Never leave children unsupervised in
the vehicle. Always take the key with you
when leaving the vehicle, even if you are only
leaving it for a short time.
G WARNING
If a key ring is too heavy or too large, the
weight acting on the key could cause it to turn
in the ignition lock or catch on the steering
wheel. This could cause the engine to be
switched off suddenly. You may lose control
of the vehicle and cause an accident. Do not
attach any heavy or large key rings to the key
that is inserted in the ignition.
RDo
not keep the key:
with electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another key
- with metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
foil
- inside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
This can affect the key's functionality.
Keep the key away from strong magnetic
fields. Otherwise, the remote control function
could be affected.
-
Key
: & To lock the vehicle
; F To unlock the boot lid
= % To unlock the vehicle
X
To unlock centrally: press the % button.
If you do not open the vehicle within
approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe
Rthe
X
Locking and unlocking centrally
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you only need carry
the key with you. When you touch the surface
of the sensors on the vehicle's outside door
handles, KEYLESS-GO establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key.
When the engine is started and whilst you are
driving, KEYLESS-GO also checks whether a
valid key is in the vehicle by periodically
establishing radio contact.
You can combine the KEYLESS-GO functions
with those of a conventional key, e.g. using
KEYLESS-GO to unlock and pressing the
& button to lock.
When locking or unlocking with KEYLESS-GO,
the distance between the key and the corresponding door handle must not be greater
than 1 m.
vehicle is locked again.
anti-theft system is primed again.
To lock centrally: press the & button.
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe
doors
boot lid
Rthe fuel filler flap
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked. The audible
signal can be activated and deactivated using
the on-board computer (Y page 225).
When it is dark, the surround lighting also
comes on if it is activated in the on-board
computer (Y page 223).
Rthe
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface :.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
recessed sensor surface ; for an extended period.
X To unlock the boot lid: pull the handle on
the boot lid.
X
Further information on the convenience closing feature (Y page 89).
Bear in mind that the engine can be started
by any of the vehicle occupants if there is a
KEYLESS-GO key in the vehicle.
Z
Opening and closing
Key functions
77
Key
78
Opening and closing
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking
system. This means that only the driver's door
and the fuel filler flap are unlocked when the
vehicle is unlocked. This is useful if you frequently travel on your own.
X To change the setting: press and hold
down the % and & buttons on the
key simultaneously for approximately six
seconds until the battery check lamp
flashes twice (Y page 79).
i If the setting of the locking system is
changed within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
Rlocks
or
Runlocks the vehicle
The key now functions as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
X
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: touch the
inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface of the door handle on the frontpassenger door or the rear door.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
X
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key, use the emergency
key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door or the boot
lid, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered (Y page 71).
There are several ways to turn off the alarm:
X
To turn the alarm off with the key: press
the % or & button on the key.
or
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X
To deactivate the alarm with KEYLESSGO: press the Start/Stop button in the ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle.
or
X
Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The key must be outside the vehicle.
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X
To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key into the ignition lock.
Removing the emergency key element
To restore the factory settings: press
and hold down the % and & buttons
simultaneously for approximately six seconds until the battery check lamp flashes
twice (Y page 79).
: Release catch
; Emergency key element
Key
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time, remove
emergency key element ; from the key.
79
Checking the battery
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries are toxic and contain caustic substances. For this reason, keep batteries out of
the reach of children.
If a battery has been swallowed, visit a doctor
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the batteries replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Press the & or % button.
The battery is working properly if battery
check lamp : lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Change the battery (Y page 79).
i If the key battery is checked within the
signal reception range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
X
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
i You can get a battery in any qualified specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 78).
: Battery compartment cover
; Emergency key element
Z
Opening and closing
Battery of the key
Key
80
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the
arrow until battery compartment cover :
opens. When doing so, do not hold battery
compartment cover : shut.
X Remove battery compartment cover :.
Opening and closing
X
= Battery
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm
until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth
to do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free from lint, grease and all other forms of
contamination.
X
Insert the front tabs of battery compartment cover : into the housing and then
press to close it.
X Insert emergency key element ; into the
key (Y page 78).
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Key
81
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot lock or
unlock the vehicle
using the key.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control
function of the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle from close range and press the % or & button.
If this does not work:
X Check the key battery (Y page 79) and replace it if necessary
(Y page 79).
X Lock (Y page 84) or unlock (Y page 84) the vehicle using
the emergency key element.
The key is faulty.
X Lock (Y page 84) or unlock (Y page 84) the vehicle using
the emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can no longer lock There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
or unlock the vehicle
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
using KEYLESS-GO.
the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle from
close range and press the % or & button.
There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle from
close range and press the % or & button.
X Have KEYLESS-GO checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
If this does not work:
X Check the key battery (Y page 79) and replace it if necessary
(Y page 79).
X Lock (Y page 84) or unlock (Y page 84) the vehicle using
the emergency key element.
You have lost a key.
Have the key deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
X
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Z
Opening and closing
Problems with the key
Opening and closing
82
Doors
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
the on-board voltage is too low.
X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 318).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 319).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine cannot be
A door is open. Therefore, the key cannot be detected as easily.
started using KEYLESS- X Close the door and try to start the vehicle again.
GO. The key is in the
vehicle.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
Doors
G WARNING
Important safety notes
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen a door from inside the vehicle at any
time, even if it has been locked
Rstart the vehicle using a key which has been
left in the vehicle
Rrelease the parking brake
They could thereby endanger themselves and
others. Never leave children unsupervised in
the vehicle. Always take the key with you
when leaving the vehicle, even if you are only
leaving it for a short time.
G WARNING
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key or with KEYLESS-GO, the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open
the doors from inside the vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people requiring special assistance. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. They
could be seriously or even fatally injured by
prolonged exposure to extremely high or low
temperatures, for example. In this case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle. The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside.
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
For all countries except the United Kingdom: you can open a door from inside the
vehicle even if it has been locked. If the vehicle has previously been locked with the key
or with KEYLESS-GO, opening a door from the
inside will trigger the anti-theft alarm system.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 71).
United Kingdom only: if the vehicle has
been locked with the key or with KEYLESSGO, the double lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. Deactivate the
interior motion sensor (Y page 72) before you
lock the vehicle. The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside. The anti-theft
alarm system is triggered if the door is
opened from the inside. Switch off the alarm
(Y page 71).
You can only open the rear doors from inside
the vehicle if they are not secured by the
child-proof locks (Y page 62).
X
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and can be
opened.
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside.
X
X
To unlock: press button :.
To lock: press button ;.
If all the doors are closed, the vehicle locks.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from
the inside if the vehicle has been locked with
the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The central locking/unlocking button does
not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
For all countries except the United Kingdom: you can open a front door from inside
the vehicle even if it has been locked.
United Kingdom only: if the vehicle has
been locked with the key or with KEYLESSGO, the double lock function is activated as
standard. It is then not possible to open the
doors from inside the vehicle. Deactivate the
interior motion sensor (Y page 72) before you
lock the vehicle. The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside.
If the vehicle has been locked using the locking button for the central locking, or has been
locked automatically, and a door is opened
from the inside:
Rthe
vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had
previously been fully unlocked.
Ronly the door which has been opened from
the inside is unlocked if only the driver's
door had been previously unlocked.
Z
83
Opening and closing
Doors
Doors
84
Opening and closing
Automatic locking feature
1 To unlock
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X
i If you press one of the two buttons and
do not hear a tone, the relevant setting has
already been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning.
You could therefore be locked out if:
Rthe
vehicle is being pushed.
vehicle is being towed.
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer.
You can also switch the automatic locking
function on and off using the on-board computer (Y page 225).
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise to position 1.
The door is unlocked.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element clockwise.
X
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 71).
Rthe
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the key, use the emergency key element.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 78).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
key, use the emergency key element.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door, the rear
doors and the boot lid.
X Press the locking button (Y page 83).
X Check whether the locking knobs on the
front-passenger door and the rear doors
are still visible. Press down the locking
knobs manually, if necessary (Y page 82).
X Close the driver's door.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 78).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Boot
85
Vehicles without the boot lid remote closing feature: the boot lid can be:
Ropened
and closed manually from outside
automatically from outside
Ropened automatically from inside
Runlocked with the emergency key element
Vehicles with the boot lid remote closing
feature: the boot lid can be:
Ropened
1 Locking
X
Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element anti-clockwise.
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Make sure that the doors and the boot lid
are locked.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
and closed manually from outside
Ropened and closed automatically from out-
side
Ropened
and closed automatically from
inside
Runlocked with the emergency key element
X
Opening/closing from the outside
To open
Boot
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Exhaust fumes could enter the vehicle interior
if the engine is running and the boot lid is
open. This could poison you. Therefore, you
should make sure that the boot lid is always
closed when the engine is running.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
i Opening dimensions of the boot lid
(Y page 366).
X
X
Press the % button on the key.
Pull handle :.
To close
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when closing the boot lid.
Do not leave the key in the boot. You could
otherwise lock yourself out.
Z
Opening and closing
Ropened
Boot
86
G WARNING
Opening and closing
Monitor the boot lid opening and closing procedures to make sure that nobody can
become trapped. To stop the opening or closing procedure, press the closing button on the
boot lid again or pull the handle on the outside
of the boot lid.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
X
X
Pull the boot lid down using recess :.
If necessary, lock the vehicle with
the & button on the key (Y page 77) or
with KEYLESS-GO (Y page 77).
i If a KEYLESS-GO key is detected in the
boot, the boot lid cannot be locked. It then
opens again.
Opening/closing automatically from
the outside
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key or with KEYLESS-GO, the double lock function is activated as standard. It is then not possible to open
the doors from inside the vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people requiring special assistance. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. They
could be seriously or even fatally injured by
prolonged exposure to extremely high or low
temperatures, for example. In this case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle. The doors can then be
opened from the inside after the vehicle has
been locked from the outside.
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
i Opening dimensions of the boot lid
(Y page 366).
To open
You can open the boot lid automatically using
the key or the handle in the boot lid.
X Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid opens.
or
X If the boot is unlocked, pull the boot lid
handle and release it again immediately
(Y page 85).
To close
Example: closing and locking button (vehicle with
the boot lid remote closing feature and KEYLESSGO)
: Closing button
; Locking button
X
To close: press closing button : on the
boot lid.
Side windows
X
Press locking button ; on the boot lid.
i If you leave a KEYLESS-GO key in the
boot, the boot lid will not lock.
Opening/closing automatically from
the inside
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Monitor the boot lid closing procedure to
make sure that nobody can become trapped.
Release the boot lid remote operating button
to stop the closing procedure.
Unlocking the boot (emergency key
element)
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
If the boot cannot be unlocked with the key
or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the boot lid, the anti-theft
alarm system will be triggered (Y page 71).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 78).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
i Opening dimensions of the boot lid
(Y page 366).
Opening and closing
1 Neutral position
2 To unlock
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise from position 1 as far as it will
go to position 2.
The boot is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back to
position 1 and remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
To open: pull remote operating switch for
boot lid : until the boot lid opens.
X To close: press remote operating switch
for boot lid : until the boot lid is closed.
X
You can open the boot lid from the driver's
seat when the vehicle is stationary and
unlocked.
Side windows
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
between the side window and the door frame
Z
Opening and closing
Vehicles with the boot lid remote closing
feature and KEYLESS-GO: you can simultaneously close and lock the boot lid.
87
Opening and closing
88
Side windows
when a side window is opened. Do not touch
or lean against the side window during the
opening procedure. You could become trapped between the side window and the door
frame as the side window moves down. If
there is a risk of becoming trapped, release
the switch or pull the switch upwards to close
the side window again.
Opening and closing the side windows
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as you close a side window. If there is a risk
of becoming trapped, release the switch or
press it again to open the side window again.
G WARNING
Children may injure themselves if they open
or close the side windows.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. Always take the key with you when leaving
the vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for
a short time.
G WARNING
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. The children could:
Rbe seriously or even fatally injured on parts
of the vehicle
seriously or even fatally injured by prolonged exposure to extremely high or
extremely low temperatures
If children open a door, they could:
Rbe
Rseriously or even fatally injure other people
Rget
out of the vehicle and injure themselves, or be seriously or even fatally
injured by a passing vehicle
Activate the child-proof locks/override feature if children are travelling in the vehicle.
They could otherwise open doors or side windows while the vehicle is in motion and
thereby injure themselves or others.
: Front left
; Front right
= Rear right
? Rear left
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open: press the corresponding switch.
X To close: pull the corresponding switch.
i If you press the switch beyond the point
of resistance, an automatic opening/closing process is started in the corresponding
direction. You can stop automatic operation by pressing again.
X
i You can continue to operate the side windows after switching off the engine or
removing the key. This function remains
active for five minutes or until the driver's
or front-passenger door is opened.
i The side windows cannot be operated
from the rear when the override feature for
the side windows is activated (Y page 62).
Side windows
General notes
You can ventilate the vehicle before you start
driving. To do this, the key is used to carry out
the following functions simultaneously:
the vehicle
the side windows
Ropen the sliding sunroof
Rswitch on the seat ventilation for the driver's seat
With KEYLESS-GO:
Rrelease the sensor surface on the door han-
dle.
Rpull
the door handle immediately and hold
it.
The side windows and the sliding sunroof
open.
Runlock
Ropen
i The convenience opening feature can
only be operated using the key. The key
must be close to the driver's door handle.
Convenience opening feature
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof are in
the desired position.
X To interrupt convenience opening:
release the % button.
X
When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously:
Rclose
Rclose
Using the key
The key must be close to the driver's door
handle.
X Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Press and hold the & button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof are
fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
sliding sunroof are closed.
X
Convenience closing feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When using the convenience closing feature,
make sure that nobody can become trapped.
Proceed as follows if there is a risk of entrapment:
With the key:
Rrelease
the side windows
the sliding sunroof
To interrupt convenience closing:
release the & button.
Using KEYLESS-GO
The KEYLESS-GO key must be outside the
vehicle. All the doors must be closed.
the & button.
Rpress
and hold the % button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof open
again.
Z
Opening and closing
Convenience opening feature
89
Side windows
90
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle until the side windows and the
sliding sunroof are fully closed.
i Make sure you only touch recessed sensor surface :.
Opening and closing
X
X
Make sure that all the side windows and the
sliding sunroof are closed.
X
To interrupt convenience closing:
release recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle.
Resetting the side windows
If a side window can no longer be closed fully,
you must reset it.
X Close all doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed. (Y page 88)
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
Immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 88).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released,
the side window has been reset correctly.
If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
X
Sliding sunroof
91
Problems with the side windows
G WARNING
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot
be closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
X
X
Remove the objects.
Close the side window.
A side window cannot If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
be closed and you can- slightly:
not see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens
again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Sliding sunroof
G WARNING
Important safety notes
Children could injure themselves if they operate the sliding sunroof.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. Always take the key with you when leaving
the vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for
a short time.
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when opening and closing the sliding sunroof.
If there is a risk of entrapment, release the
switch immediately. During automatic operation, push the switch briefly in any direction
to stop the sliding sunroof.
G WARNING
The glass in the panorama sunroof could
break in an accident. If you are not wearing a
seat belt, there is a risk that you could be
thrown through the opening in the event of the
vehicle overturning. Therefore, always wear a
seat belt to reduce the risk of injuries.
! Only open the panorama sliding sunroof
if it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could
be damaged.
i Resonance noises can occur in addition
to the usual airflow noises when the sliding
sunroof is open. They are caused by minor
pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior.
Z
Opening and closing
Closing the side windows with increased force or without the anti-entrapment feature could lead
to serious or even fatal injury. Make sure that nobody can become trapped when closing the side
windows.
Sliding sunroof
92
Change the position of the sliding sunroof
or open a side window slightly to reduce or
eliminate these noises.
Opening and closing
Operating the sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
Rain-closing feature
If the key is in position 0 in the ignition lock
or if it is removed, the sliding sunroof closes
automatically:
Rif
it starts to rain
extreme outside temperatures
Rafter six hours
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply
The rear of the sliding sunroof is then raised
in order to ventilate the vehicle interior.
Rat
i If the sliding sunroof is obstructed while
being closed by the rain-closing feature, it
opens again slightly. The rain-closing feature is then deactivated.
The sliding sunroof does not close if:
Rit
Overhead control panel
: To raise
; To open
= To close/lower
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
i If you press the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, an automatic opening/
closing process is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic
operation by pressing again.
The sun protection cover automatically opens
along with the sliding sunroof. You can open
or close the sun protection cover manually
when the sliding sunroof is raised or closed.
X
i You can continue to operate the sliding
sunroof after switching off the engine or
removing the key. This function remains
active for five minutes or until you open a
front door.
is raised at the rear.
is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen being monitored by the rain sensor,
e.g. because the vehicle is under a bridge
or in a carport.
Rit
Resetting
! If the sliding sunroof still cannot be
opened or closed fully after resetting, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Reset the sliding sunroof if it does not move
smoothly.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Raise the sliding sunroof fully at the rear
(Y page 92).
X Keep the 3 switch pressed for another
second.
X Make sure that the sliding sunroof can be
fully opened and closed again (Y page 92).
X If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
Sliding sunroof
93
Problems with the sliding sunroof
G WARNING
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The sliding sunroof can- If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing and reopens
not be closed and you again slightly:
cannot see the cause. X Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the 3
switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed with increased force.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed again during closing and
reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the sliding sunroof blocks, pull the 3
switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
Z
Opening and closing
You could be severely or even fatally injured when closing the sliding sunroof with increased
closing force or if the anti-entrapment feature is deactivated. Make sure that nobody can become
trapped when closing the sliding sunroof.
94
95
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Useful information .............................. 96
Correct driver's seat position ............ 96
Seats .................................................... 97
Steering wheel .................................. 102
Mirrors ............................................... 105
Memory function .............................. 107
Correct driver's seat position
96
Useful information
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 23).
Correct driver's seat position
Ryou
have moved the backrest to an almost
vertical position.
Ryou have set the seat angle so that your
thighs are gently supported.
Ryou can depress the pedals properly.
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted properly.
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by
the centre of the head restraint.
X Observe the safety guidelines on steering
wheel adjustment (Y page 102).
X Make sure that steering wheel : is adjusted properly.
Adjusting the steering wheel manually
(Y page 103)
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
(Y page 103)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure that:
Ryou
can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent.
Ryou can move your legs freely.
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly.
X Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 48).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 49).
The seat belt should:
Observe the safety guidelines on seat
adjustment (Y page 97).
X Make sure that seat = is adjusted properly.
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 98)
When adjusting the seat, make sure that:
X
Ryou are as far away from the driver's airbag
as possible.
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position.
Ryou
can fasten the seat belt properly.
Rfit
snugly across your body
routed across the middle of your shoulder
Rbe routed in your pelvic area across the hip
joints
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors in such a way
that you have a good view of road and traffic conditions (Y page 105).
X Vehicles with a memory function: save
the seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror
Rbe
Seats
Seats
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The seats can still be adjusted when there is
no key in the ignition lock. For this reason,
children should never be left unsupervised in
the vehicle. They could adjust the seats and
become trapped.
G WARNING
Only adjust the driver's seat when the vehicle
is stationary. You will otherwise be distracted
from the road and traffic conditions and you
could lose control of the vehicle as a result of
the seat moving. This could cause an accident.
G WARNING
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
others could be trapped and thereby injured.
Children in particular could unintentionally
press the buttons to electrically adjust the
seats and become trapped.
Take care that:
Rwhile
moving the seats, your hands do not
get under the lever assembly of the seat
adjustment system.
Rchildren in the vehicle do not slide their
hands under the levers.
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when adjusting the seats.
Observe the notes on airbags.
Secure children as recommended; see the
"Children in the vehicle" section.
G WARNING
Make sure that the back of your head is supported at eye level by the central area of the
head restraint. If your head is not supported
correctly by the head restraint, you could suffer a severe neck injury in the event of an
accident. Never drive if the head restraints are
not engaged and set correctly.
G WARNING
A seat belt can only offer its intended degree
of protection when the backrest is almost vertical and the occupant is sitting upright. Avoid
seat positions that do not allow the seat belt
to be routed correctly. Adjust the backrest so
that it is as upright as possible. Never travel
with the backrest reclined too far backwards.
You could otherwise be seriously or even
fatally injured in the event of an accident or
sudden braking.
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
settings with the memory function
(Y page 107).
97
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
98
Seats
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see "Interior care".
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
A Backrest angle
i Vehicles with memory function: if PRE-
SAFE® has been triggered, the frontpassenger seat will be moved to a better
position if it was previously in an unfavourable position.
i You can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 107).
i Vehicles with the through-loading feature
and memory function: if you fold down a
rear seat backrest, the respective front
seat is moved forwards slightly if necessary.
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats when moving
the seat back. There is a risk that the seats
and/or the objects could be damaged.
i Vehicles with memory function: when the
seat is moved forwards or backwards, the
headrest is moved up or down automatically.
i The head restraints in the front seats are
fitted with the NECK-PRO system
(Y page 46). For this reason, it is not possible to remove the head restraints from
the front seats.
For more information, contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i Further related subjects:
RRear
Adjusting the head restraints
Adjusting the head restraints manually
Adjusting the head restraint height
bench seat through-loading feature
Adjusting the seats electrically
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down to the desired position.
X
: Head restraint height
; Seat cushion angle
= Seat height
Seats
99
To adjust the side bolsters of the head
restraint: push or pull right and/or lefthand side bolster : into the desired position.
X To adjust the angle of the head
restraint: push or pull the head restraint in
the direction of arrow ;.
X
X
Push or pull the lower edge of the head
restraint in the direction of the arrow.
Adjusting the head restraints electrically
Rear seat head restraints
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
angle
X
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
switch for head restraint adjustment : up
or down in the direction of the arrow.
Adjusting the luxury head restraints
G WARNING
When folding back the head restraint side bolsters, do not put your hands between the side
bolster and the cushion holder. There is a
danger of becoming trapped.
X
Pull or push the top of the head restraint
until it is in the desired position.
Removing and fitting the rear seat head
restraints
G WARNING
Occupants should only travel sitting on seats
that have the head restraints fitted. This
reduces the risk of injury to the occupant in
the event of an accident.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the angle of the head restraints
Seats
100
! Make sure that the rear window roller
sunblind is retracted when removing the
rear head restraints. Otherwise, you could
damage the roller sunblind.
You can adjust the contour of the front seats
individually so as to provide optimum support
for your back and sides.
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the active multicontour
seat
Overview
To remove: pull the head restraint up as
far as it will go.
X Press release catch : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that
the notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X
: To adjust the seat cushion length
; To switch the dynamic function on or off
= To adjust the side bolsters of the seat
backrest
? To switch the massage function on or off
Adjusting the multicontour seat
A To adjust the contour of the backrest to
increase/decrease support
B To adjust the height/depth of the back-
rest contour
The active multicontour seat automatically
adapts the sides of the backrest to your current driving style.
Dynamic function
: To adjust the thigh cushion
; To adjust the backrest contour in the lum-
bar region
= To adjust the backrest contour in the
upper back region
? To adjust the side bolsters of the seat
backrest
The dynamic function adjusts the air cushions
in the side bolsters of the seat backrests to
ensure ideal lateral support at all times.
Seats
To switch on: press button ; once or
twice until the desired level is set.
One or two indicator lamps in button ;
light up.
X To switch off: press button ; repeatedly
until all indicator lamps in button ; go out.
X
101
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
Level 1 (one indicator lamp)
Level 2 (two indicator lamps)
Standard setting:
slightly increased
lateral support and
slow build-up of air
pressure in the side
bolsters of the seat
backrest.
Sport setting:
increased lateral
support and fast
build-up of pressure
in the side bolsters
of the seat backrest.
Massage function (PULSE)
The massage function helps you to prevent
muscle tension on long journeys. You can
choose between two levels.
X To switch on: press button ? once or
twice until the desired level is set.
One or two indicator lamps in button ?
light up. The air cushions in the lumbar
region vibrate for approximately
20 minutes.
: To raise the backrest contour
; To soften the backrest contour
= To lower the backrest contour
? To harden the backrest contour
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum
support for your back.
Switching the seat heating on/off
Switching on/off
G WARNING
Repeatedly setting the seat heating to level
3 may result in excessive seat temperatures.
The health of passengers that have limited
temperature sensitivity or a limited ability to
react to excessively high temperatures may
be affected or they may even suffer burn-like
injuries. Therefore, do not use seat heating
level 3 repeatedly.
Adjusting the lumbar support
You can adjust the contour of the driver's seat
so as to provide optimum support for your
back.
X Move adjustment lever : in the direction
of the arrow until the desired backrest contour is achieved.
Driver's and front-passenger seat
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
You can choose between two different levels.
Steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
102
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches down
from level 3 to level 2 after approximately
eight minutes.
The system automatically switches down
from level 2 to level 1 after approximately ten
minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
The three blue indicator lamps in the buttons
indicate the ventilation level you have selected.
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired ventilation level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
Problems with the seat ventilation
heating may switch off.
Problems with the seat heating
The seat heating has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
X
Switch off electrical consumers that you do
not need, such as the rear window heating
or interior lighting.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
ventilation may switch off.
i You can open the side windows and the
sliding sunroof using the "Convenience
opening" feature (Y page 89). The seat ventilation of the driver's seat automatically
switches to the highest level.
The seat ventilation has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
X
Switch off electrical consumers that you do
not need, such as the rear window heating
or interior lighting.
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Switching on/off
G WARNING
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.
Adjusting the steering wheel while driving, or
driving without the steering wheel adjustment
feature locked could cause the driver to lose
control of the vehicle.
The electrical steering wheel adjustment feature can be operated at any time. Therefore,
do not leave children unattended in the vehicle, or with access to an unlocked vehicle. A
child's unsupervised access to a vehicle could
result in an accident and/or serious personal
injury.
Steering wheel
Adjusting the steering wheel manually
103
i Further related subjects:
REASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature
(Y page 104)
RStoring settings (Y page 107)
Steering wheel heating
: Release lever
; To adjust the steering wheel height
= To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up completely.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
X
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X To switch on/off: turn the lever in the
direction of arrow : or ;.
Indicator lamp = lights up or goes out.
X
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: when you
remove the key from the ignition lock, the
steering wheel heating is switched off.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: when you switch
off the ignition and open the driver's door, the
steering wheel heating is switched off.
i The steering wheel heating does not
switch off automatically.
: To adjust the steering wheel height
; To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Switching on/off
Steering wheel
104
Problems with the steering wheel heating
If steering wheel heating indicator lamp = is
flashing, the steering wheel heating has
switched off automatically. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Switch off electrical consumers that you do
not need, such as the rear window heating
or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the
steering wheel heating will switch back on
automatically.
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when you activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature.
If there is a risk of someone becoming trapped, stop the adjustment procedure. To halt
the procedure:
Rpress
the steering column adjustment button.
Rbriefly press one of the memory function
position buttons.
The steering column stops moving immediately.
Do not keep the memory function position
button pressed down, otherwise the memory
function will start and the steering wheel and
seat will begin to move.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. They could open the driver's door and
thereby unintentionally activate the EASYENTRY feature and become trapped.
The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting
in and out of your vehicle easier.
You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board computer (Y page 226).
Position of the steering wheel when the
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is active
The steering wheel tilts upwards if you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door and KEYLESS-GO is
in position 1
Ropen the driver's door and the key is in
position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock
Ropen
i The steering wheel only moves upwards if
it has not already reached the upper end
stop.
Position of the steering wheel for driving
The steering wheel is moved to the previously
set position if:
Rthe
Ryou
driver's door is closed and
insert the key into the ignition lock
or
Ryou
press the Start/Stop button once on
vehicles with KEYLESS-GO.
If you close the driver's door with the key
inserted into the ignition lock, the steering
wheel is automatically moved to the previously set position.
The last position of the steering wheel is
stored when you switch off the ignition or
when you store the setting with the memory
function (Y page 107).
Crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature
If the crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
triggered in an accident, the steering column
will move upwards when the driver's door is
opened. This occurs irrespective of the position of the key in the ignition lock. This makes
it easier to exit the vehicle and rescue the
occupants.
Mirrors
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
X
Anti-dazzle mode: flick anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, or
to the left or right until you have adjusted
the exterior mirror to the correct position.
You should have a good overview of traffic
conditions.
X
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
The exterior mirrors are automatically heated
if the rear window heating is switched on and
the outside temperature is low.
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
electrically
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects are actually closer than they
appear. You could misjudge the distance from
vehicles driving behind and cause an accident, e.g. when changing lane. For this reason, make sure of the actual distance from the
vehicle driving behind by glancing over your
shoulder.
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while driving. They
could otherwise vibrate.
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
only operational if the EASY-EXIT/ENTRY feature is activated in the on-board computer.
105
Mirrors
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
106
Setting the exterior mirrors
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must
be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise
not fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 227).
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 in
the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
G WARNING
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
automatically
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 227):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside.
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door.
i If the exterior mirrors have been folded in
manually, they do not fold out.
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
If incident light from headlamps is prevented
from striking the sensor in the rear-view mirror, for instance, by luggage piled too high in
the vehicle, the mirror's automatic anti-dazzle
function will not operate.
Incident light could then blind you. This may
distract you from the traffic conditions and,
as a result, you may cause an accident.
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antidazzle mode if the following conditions are
met simultaneously:
Rthe
ignition is switched on and
light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror.
The mirrors do not go into anti-dazzle mode if
reverse gear is engaged or if the interior lighting is switched on.
Rincident
Parking position for the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side
Setting and storing the parking position
Using reverse gear
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position, proceed as follows:
Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror
into the correct position manually.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors: press and hold mirror-folding
button : until you hear a click and then
the mirrors engage in position
(Y page 105).
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 105).
X
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
You can store this position.
Memory function
Using the memory button
You can set the front-passenger side exterior
mirror so that you can see the rear wheel on
that side as soon as you engage reverse gear.
This setting can be stored using memory button M ?.
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X With the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side activated, use adjustment
button = to adjust the exterior mirror. In
the exterior mirror, the rear wheel and the
kerb should be visible.
X Press memory button M ? and one of the
arrows on adjustment button = within
three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the exterior
mirror does not move.
X If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
X
Calling up a stored parking position setting
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side using button ;.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
X
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of
15 km/h
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side
Memory function
Storing settings
G WARNING
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side when the vehicle is stationary. You could
otherwise be distracted from the traffic conditions by the steering wheel and seat moving
of their own accord, and as a result, cause an
accident.
G WARNING
The memory function can still be used when
the key has been removed. For this reason,
children should never be left unsupervised in
the vehicle. They could otherwise become
trapped when adjusting the seat or the steering wheel.
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rposition
of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
Ractive multicontour seat: seat cushion
length, lateral cushions of the seat backZ
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror to a position that allows you
to see the rear wheel and the kerb.
The parking position is stored.
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
X
107
Memory function
108
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
rest, contour of the backrest, dynamic
function level
Rdriver's side: steering wheel position
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides
Adjust the seat (Y page 98).
On the driver's side, adjust the steering
wheel (Y page 103) and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 105).
X Press the M memory button and then press
storage position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed.
X
X
Calling up a stored setting
Press and hold the relevant storage position button 1, 2 or 3 until the seat, steering
wheel and exterior mirrors are in the stored
position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
soon as you release the storage position
button.
X
109
110
110
118
119
121
Lights and windscreen wipers
Useful information ............................
Exterior lighting ................................
Interior lighting .................................
Replacing bulbs .................................
Windscreen wipers ...........................
110
Exterior lighting
Useful information
"extended range foglamps" functions (Intelligent Light System) are not available.
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Lights and windscreen wipers
ist workshops: (Y page 23).
Setting the exterior lighting
Setting options
Exterior lighting can be set using the:
Rlight
switch
Rcombination
Ron-board
switch (Y page 113)
computer (Y page 222)
Light switch
Exterior lighting
Operation
Important safety notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due
to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.
Driving abroad
Symmetrical dipped-beam headlamps
If your journey takes you to countries where
vehicles are driven on the opposite side of the
road to the country in which the vehicle is
registered, your headlamps must be switched
to symmetrical dipped beam. This prevents
oncoming traffic from being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an
area of the edge of the carriageway.
Convert the headlamps as close to the border
as possible before driving in these countries
(Y page 223).
Asymmetrical dipped beam
Convert the headlamps back to asymmetrical
dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing the border (Y page 223).
If the headlamps are converted to symmetrical dipped beam, the "motorway mode" and
1W Left-hand parking lamps
2X Right-hand parking lamps
3T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
BR Rear foglamp
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X
Turn the light switch to Ã.
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door with the key in position 0
Ropen
Exterior lighting
G WARNING
If the light switch is set to à and it is foggy,
snowing or there is poor visibility, the dippedbeam headlamps will not come on automatically. This could endanger you and others. In
such situations turn the light switch to L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle's
lighting at all times.
ically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
X To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to Ã.
The daytime driving lights improve the visibility of your vehicle during the day. Here, the
daytime driving lights function must be
switched on via the on-board computer
(Y page 222).
When the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on, the green L indicator lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up and the
daytime driving lights go out or are dimmed.
Dipped-beam headlamps
G WARNING
1W Left-hand parking lamps
2X Right-hand parking lamps
3T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
If the light switch is set to à and it is foggy,
snowing or there is poor visibility, the dippedbeam headlamps will not come on automatically. This could endanger you and others. In
such situations turn the light switch to L.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle's
lighting at all times.
ment cluster lighting
4Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
BR Rear foglamp
à is the preferred light switch setting. The
light setting is automatically selected according to the brightness of the ambient light
(exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions such as fog, snow or spray):
1W Left-hand parking lamps
RKey
2X Right-hand parking lamps
in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
RWith the engine running: if you have activated the daytime driving lights function via
the on-board computer, the daytime driving
lights or the dipped-beam headlamps and
side lamps are switched on or off automat-
3T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
lamps
BR Rear foglamp
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Automatic headlamp mode
111
112
Exterior lighting
Lights and windscreen wipers
Even if the light sensor does not detect that
is dark, the side lamps and dipped-beam
headlamps switch on when the key is inserted
into the ignition lock and the light switch is
set to the L position. This is a particularly
useful function in the event of rain and fog.
X To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Rear foglamp
Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
X
Side lamps
! If the battery has been excessively discharged, the side lamps or parking lamps
are automatically switched off to enable
the next engine start. Always park your
vehicle safely and sufficiently lit according
to legal standards. Avoid the continuous
use of the T side lamps for several
hours. If possible, switch on the X right
or the W left parking lamp.
1W Left-hand parking lamps
2X Right-hand parking lamps
3T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
1W Left-hand parking lamps
2X Right-hand parking lamps
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam head-
3T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
The rear foglamp improves visibility of your
vehicle for the traffic behind in the event of
heavy fog. Please take note of the countryspecific regulations for the use of rear foglamps.
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X
lamps
BR Rear foglamp
ment cluster lighting
4Ã Automatic headlamp mode, controlled by the light sensor
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
BR Rear foglamp
To switch on: turn light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Exterior lighting
Parking lamps
113
Combination switch
1W Left-hand parking lamps
2X Right-hand parking lamps
3T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4Ã Automatic headlamp mode, controlled by the light sensor
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
BR Rear foglamp
Switching on the parking lamps ensures the
corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
X To switch on the parking lamps: the key
is not in the ignition lock or it is in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side
of the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of
the vehicle).
: Main-beam headlamps
; Turn signal, right
= Headlamp flasher
? Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
X
Main-beam headlamps
: Main-beam headlamps
; Turn signal, right
= Headlamp flasher
? Turn signal, left
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Turn signals
Exterior lighting
114
To switch on the main-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of
arrow :.
In the à position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the engine is running.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the main-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
i Vehicles with Adaptive Highbeam Assist:
when Adaptive Highbeam Assist is active,
it controls activation of the main-beam
headlamps (Y page 116).
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Headlamp flasher
Hazard warning lamps
To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on
a turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning
lamps: press button :.
X
The hazard warning lamps automatically
switch on if:
Ran
airbag is deployed.
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of more than 70 km/h and comes to
a standstill.
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
over 10 km/h again after a full brake application.
Rthe
i The hazard warning lamps still operate if
the ignition is switched off.
: Main-beam headlamps
; Turn signal, right
= Headlamp flasher
? Turn signal, left
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2, or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow =.
X
Headlamp cleaning system
The headlamps are cleaned automatically if
the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is operated five times (Y page 121) while the lights
are on and the engine is running. When you
switch off the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is
resumed from 0.
Exterior lighting
Intelligent Light System
115
Cornering light function
The Intelligent Light System is a system that
adjusts the headlamps automatically to suit
the prevailing driving and weather conditions.
It offers advanced functions for improved illumination of the road surface, e.g. depending
on the vehicle speed or weather conditions.
The system includes the active light function,
cornering light function, motorway mode and
extended range foglamps. The system is only
active when it is dark.
You can activate or deactivate the "Intelligent
Light System" using the on-board computer
(Y page 222).
Active light function
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. It can only
be activated when the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
Rif
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this
way, relevant areas remain illuminated while
driving. This allows you to recognise pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on.
you are driving at speeds below
40 km/h and the turn signal is activated or
the steering wheel is turned.
Rif you are driving at speeds between
40 km/h and 70 km/h and turn the steering wheel.
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
40 km/h or switch off the turn signal or turn
the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position.
The cornering lamp may remain lit for a short
time, but is automatically switched off after
no more than three minutes.
Motorway mode
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
General notes
116
Exterior lighting
Active: if you are driving at a speed above
110 km/h and do not make any large steering
movements for at least 1000 m or if you are
driving at a speed above 130 km/h.
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Extended range foglamps
The extended range foglamps reduce the
glare experienced by the driver and improve
the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp.
Not active: if, following activation, you are
driving at speeds above 100 km/h or if you
switch off the rear foglamp.
The system may not recognise the following
road users:
Rroad users that have no lighting, e.g. pedes-
trians
users that have poor lighting, e.g.
cyclists
Rroad users whose lighting is not clearly visible, e.g. road users behind a crash barrier
Ron rare occasions: road users that have
lights that may be recognised too late or not
at all
The automatic main-beam headlamps will not
be deactivated, or they may be activated
despite road users travelling in front of or
approaching the vehicle.
Thus, you could cause an accident and injure
yourself and others. Always observe traffic
conditions and, if necessary, dip the lights
manually.
Rroad
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid
designed to assist driving. The driver is
responsible for adjusting the vehicle's lighting
to the prevailing light, vision and traffic conditions.
The system may be impaired or deactivated:
Rif
there is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray
Rif the area of the windscreen around the
optical sensor is dirty, misted up or covered
up, e.g. by a sticker
You can use this function to set the headlamps to change between dipped beam and
main beam automatically. The system recognises vehicles with their lights on, either
approaching from the opposite direction or
travelling in front of your vehicle, and consequently switches the headlamps from main
beam to dipped beam.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system
no longer detects any other vehicles, it reactivates the main-beam headlamps.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist
on/off
the main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds below
45 km/h or other road users are recognised or the roads are adequately lit:
the main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out. The _
indicator lamp in the multifunction display
remains lit.
X To deactivate: move the combination
switch back to its normal position.
The _ indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Headlamps misted up on the inside
The headlamps may mist up on the inside if
there is high atmospheric humidity.
: Main-beam headlamps
; Turn signal, right
= Headlamp flasher
? Turn signal, left
To activate: activate the Adaptive Highbeam Assist function using the on-board
computer (Y page 223).
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of
arrow : .
The _ indicator lamp in the multifunction display lights up if it is dark and the
light sensor activates the dipped-beam
headlamps.
If you are driving at speeds above
45 km/h:
the headlamp range is set automatically
depending on the distance between the
vehicle and other road users.
If you are driving at speeds above
55 km/h and no other road users are recognised:
X
Switch on the lights and drive off.
The level of moisture diminishes, depending on the length of the journey and the
weather conditions (humidity and temperature).
If the level of moisture does not diminish:
X
X
Have the headlamps checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Z
117
Lights and windscreen wipers
Exterior lighting
118
Interior lighting
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Interior lighting control
General notes
Lights and windscreen wipers
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except for when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
The colour and brightness of the ambient
lighting may be set using the on-board computer (Y page 223).
Automatic interior lighting control
Front overhead control panel
: u Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
; | Switches the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
= p Switches the right-hand front read-
ing lamp on/off
? c Switches the front interior lighting
on/off
A p Switches the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
Front overhead control panel
: u To switch the rear interior lighting
on/off
; | To switch the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
= p To switch the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
? c To switch the front interior lighting
on/off
A p To switch the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
Rear-compartment overhead control panel
: p Switches the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
; p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
X
To activate/deactivate: press the |
button.
When the automatic interior lighting control is activated, the button is flush with the
overhead control panel.
Replacing bulbs
Runlock
the vehicle
Ropen a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior lighting is activated for a short
time when the key is removed from the ignition lock. You can activate this delayed
switch-off using the on-board computer
(Y page 224).
Manual interior lighting control
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X
To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X
Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes
Xenon bulbs
G DANGER
Front overhead control panel
: u To switch the rear interior lighting
on/off.
Xenon bulbs are under high voltage. If you
touch the electrical contacts of a xenon bulb,
you could suffer an electric shock and be seriously or even fatally injured. For this reason,
do not remove the cover of xenon bulbs.
Do not change the xenon bulbs yourself, but
have them replaced at a qualified workshop.
= p To switch the right-hand reading
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
? c To switch the front interior lighting
LED lamps
; | To switch the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
lamp on/off
on/off
A p To switch the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
To switch the front interior lighting on/
off: press the c button.
X To switch the rear interior lighting on/
off: press the u button.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
X
You can neither replace xenon bulbs nor LED
bulbs. Have LED bulbs changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Other bulbs
G WARNING
Bulbs and lamps can be very hot. You should
therefore allow them to cool down before you
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
119
Lights and windscreen wipers
120
Replacing bulbs
change them. Otherwise, you could be burned
if you touch them.
Keep bulbs out of the reach of children. Otherwise, they could damage the bulbs, for
example, and injure themselves.
Never use a bulb which has been dropped.
Such a bulb may break or even explode and
injure you.
Halogen bulbs are pressurised and can
explode when you change them, particularly
if they are very hot. You should therefore wear
eye protection and gloves when you are
changing them.
There are bulbs other than xenon and LED
bulbs that you cannot replace. Replace only
the bulbs listed (Y page 120). Have the bulbs
that you cannot replace yourself changed at
a qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance changing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not touch the glass tube of new bulbs with
your bare hands. Even minor contamination
can burn into the glass surface and reduce
the service life of the bulbs. Always use a lintfree cloth or only touch the base of the bulb
when fitting.
Only use bulbs of the correct type.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Overview of bulb replacement – bulbs
You can replace the following bulbs. The
details for the bulb type can be found in the
legend.
Tail lamps
: Reversing lamp: W 16 W
Replacing the rear bulbs
Reversing lamp
Lamp cluster
Switch off the lights.
Open the boot.
X Reach up into the side panelling and pull
downwards until the lamp cluster is easily
accessible.
X Press the detent of connector ; and pull
out connector ;.
X Use a suitable tool to loosen and remove
four nuts :.
X Remove the entire lamp cluster.
X Turn bulb holder = anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Pull out the bulb.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder =.
X
X
Windscreen wipers
121
Insert bulb holder = into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Reinsert the lamp cluster.
X Tighten four nuts :.
X Push in connector ; until it engages.
X Insert the side panelling.
X
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
G WARNING
The windscreen will not longer be wiped properly if the wiper blades are worn. This could
prevent you from observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident. Replace
the wiper blades twice a year, ideally in spring
and autumn.
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers
when the windscreen is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windscreen can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windscreen is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windscreen wipers in dry weather conditions,
always operate them using washer fluid.
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may
be due to wax or other residue. Clean the
windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.
! Intermittent wiping with rain sensor: due
to optical influences and the windscreen
becoming dirty in dry weather conditions,
the windscreen wipers may be activated
inadvertently. This could damage the windscreen wiper blades or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor
set to low sensitivity)
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/ î To wipe the
windscreen using washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
In the Ä or Å position, the appropriate
wiping frequency is set automatically according to the intensity of the rain. In the Å
position, the rain sensor is more sensitive
than in the Ä position, causing the windscreen wipers to wipe more frequently.
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The wiper arms could start moving and cause
an injury if you leave the windscreen wipers
switched on.
Remove the key from the ignition lock before
replacing the wiper blades.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers
Windscreen wipers
122
Lights and windscreen wipers
! Never open the bonnet if a windscreen
wiper arm has been folded away from the
windscreen.
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without
a wiper blade back onto the windscreen.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release
the windscreen wiper arm without a wiper
blade and it falls onto the windscreen, the
windscreen may be damaged by the force
of the impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
Replacing the wiper blades
Removing the wiper blades
X Remove the key from the ignition lock or
turn the key to position 0 (KEYLESS-GO).
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen until it engages.
Fitting the wiper blades
X Position the new wiper blade in the retainer
on the wiper arm and slide it into place in
the opposite direction to the arrow.
The wiper blade audibly engages.
X Make sure that wiper blade is seated correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
Problems with the windscreen wipers
The windscreen wipers are obstructed
X
For safety reasons, you should remove the
key from the ignition lock.
or
Switch off the engine using the Start/Stop
button and open the driver's door.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
X
The windscreen wipers are inoperative
The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Firmly press release knob : and pull the
wiper blade upwards from the wiper arm in
the direction of the arrow.
123
124
124
127
136
Climate control
Useful information ............................
Overview of climate control systems ...................................................
Operating the climate control system .....................................................
Adjusting the air vents .....................
124
Overview of climate control systems
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Climate control
ist workshops: (Y page 23).
Overview of climate control systems
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. The windows could otherwise mist up. This may prevent you from
observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident.
Climate control regulates the temperature
and the humidity in the vehicle interior and
filters undesirable substances out of the air.
Climate control is only operational when the
engine is running. The system only works
optimally if the side windows and the roof are
closed.
The residual heat function can only be activated or deactivated with the ignition
switched off (Y page 132).
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 89). This
will speed up the cooling process and the
desired vehicle interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter can filter out most
particles of dust and completely filters out
pollen. A clogged filter reduces the amount
of air supplied to the vehicle interior. For
this reason, you should always observe the
interval for replacing the filter, which is
specified in the Service Booklet. As it
depends on environmental conditions, e.g.
heavy air pollution, the interval may be
shorter than stated in the Service Booklet.
Overview of climate control systems
125
Climate control
Control panel for THERMATIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
: Sets the temperature, left (Y page 128)
; Demists the windscreen (Y page 130)
= Switches the ZONE function on/off (Y page 130)
? Switches cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 127)
A Switches the rear window heating on/off (Y page 131)
B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 128)
C Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 131)
D Sets the air distribution (Y page 129)
E Increases the airflow (Y page 129)
F Reduces the airflow (Y page 129)
G Switches climate control on/off (Y page 127)
H Sets climate control to automatic mode (Y page 128)
Information about using THERMATIC
automatic climate control
The following contains notes and recommendations on optimum use of THERMATIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps above
the à and ¿ buttons light up.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the demisting function briefly until
the windscreen is clear again.
ROnly
use the air-recirculation mode briefly,
e.g. if there are unpleasant outside odours
or when in a tunnel. The windows could
otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn
into the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side as well. The indicator lamp above the á button goes
out.
Z
126
Overview of climate control systems
Climate control
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (3-zone)
Front control panel
: Sets the temperature, left (Y page 128)
; Demists the windscreen (Y page 130)
= Activates/deactivates the residual heat function (Y page 132)
? Switches cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 127)
A Switches the rear window heating on/off (Y page 131)
B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 128)
C Switches the ZONE function on/off (Y page 130)
D Switches climate control on/off (Y page 127)
E Sets the air distribution (Y page 129)
F Increases the airflow (Y page 129)
G Reduces the airflow (Y page 129)
H Sets the climate mode (Y page 128)
I Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 131)
J Sets climate control to automatic mode (Y page 128)
Rear control panel
K Increases the airflow (Y page 129)
L Reduces the airflow (Y page 129)
M Display
N To reduce the temperature (Y page 128)
O To increase the temperature (Y page 128)
Operating the climate control system
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most
out of your THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps above
the à and ¿ buttons light up.
RIn automatic mode, you can also use the
ñ button to set a climate mode
(FOCUS/MEDIUM/DIFFUSE). The
MEDIUM level is recommended.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the demisting function briefly until
the windscreen is clear again.
ROnly use the air-recirculation mode briefly,
e.g. if there are unpleasant outside odours
or when in a tunnel. The windows could
otherwise mist up as no fresh air is drawn
into the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side and the rear compartment as well. The indicator lamp above
the á button goes out.
RUse the residual heat function if you want
to heat or ventilate the vehicle interior
when the ignition is switched off. The residual heat function can only be activated or
deactivated with the ignition switched off.
Switching on/off
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To switch on: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
X To switch off: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
X
Activating/deactivating the cooling
with air dehumidification function
Points to observe before use
G WARNING
If the "cooling with air dehumidification" function is deactivated, the air inside the vehicle
will not be cooled (during warm weather) or
dehumidified. The windows could mist up
more quickly. This may prevent you from
observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident.
Points to observe before use
The cooling with air dehumidification function
is only available when the engine is running.
The air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified according to the temperature selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This
is normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
i If climate control is switched off, the air
i The cooling with air dehumidification
Operating the climate control system
Switching climate control on/off
supply and air circulation are also switched
off. Only use this setting for a brief period.
The windows could otherwise mist up.
i Switch on climate control primarily using
function uses refrigerant R134a. This
refrigerant does not contain chlorofluorocarbons, and therefore does not damage
the ozone layer.
the à button (Y page 128).
Z
Climate control
Information about using
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
127
Operating the climate control system
128
Switching on/off
X
To activate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The cooling with air dehumidification
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
or
X
Climate control
Problems with the cooling with air
dehumidification function
When you press the ¿ button, the indicator lamp in the button flashes three times or
remains off. You can no longer switch on the
cooling with air dehumidification function.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
Automatic mode will achieve optimal operation if cooling with air dehumidification is also
activated. If desired, cooling with air dehumidification can be deactivated.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are activated.
i THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: when automatic mode is activated, you
can select a climate mode (Y page 128).
X
To switch off: press the _ button.
Press the I or K button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out.
Setting the climate mode
In automatic mode you can select the following climate modes:
FOCUS
high airflow that is set slightly
cooler
MEDIUM medium airflow, standard setting
DIFFUSE low airflow that is set slightly
warmer and with less of a draught
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the à button.
X Press the ñ button repeatedly until the
desired climate mode appears in the display.
X
Setting the temperature
THERMATIC automatic climate control
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce: turn control : or
B clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 125).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X
Operating the climate control system
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control zones
You can select different temperature settings
for the driver's and front-passenger sides as
well as for the rear compartment.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the front: turn controls : and B clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 126).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the rear compartment using the front
control panel: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
X Turn control : clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 126).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the rear compartment
and the front-passenger side.
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the rear compartment using the rear
control panel: press the r or s
button on the rear control panel.
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X
Setting the air distribution
Air distribution settings
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the footwell air vents
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
b Directs the airflow through the demister, centre and side air vents (only for
certain countries).
a Directs the airflow through the footwell and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister vents, the centre and side air vents
as well as the footwell air vents
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed when the controls on the side air
vents are turned downwards.
Adjusting
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the _ button repeatedly until the
desired symbol appears in the display.
X
Setting the airflow
Adjusting
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase: press the K button.
X To reduce: press the I button.
X
i You can use THERMOTRONIC automatic
climate control to set the airflow in the rear
compartment separately.
Z
Climate control
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate
control
129
Operating the climate control system
130
Rair
distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
Switching the ZONE function on/off
To switch on: press the á button.
The indicator lamp above the á button
lights up.
THERMATIC automatic climate control: the
temperature setting for the driver's side is
not adopted for the front-passenger side.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: the temperature setting for the driver's
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side and the rear compartment.
X To switch off: press the á button.
The indicator lamp above the á button
goes out.
THERMATIC automatic climate control: the
temperature setting for the driver's side is
adopted for the front-passenger side.
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control: the temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger side
and the rear compartment.
Climate control
X
X
To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previous settings are reactivated.
The heating with air dehumidification function remains on. Air-recirculation mode
remains deactivated.
or
X
Press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X
Turn controls : or B clockwise or anticlockwise (Y page 125) (THERMATIC automatic climate control), (Y page 126)
(THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control ).
or
X
Press the K or I button.
Demisting the windscreen
You can use this function to demist the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen and the side windows.
Switch off the "demisting" function as soon
as the windscreen is clear again.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
Rheating
with dehumidification on
airflow (depending on the outside
temperature)
Rhigh temperature (depending on the outside temperature)
Rhigh
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Activate the ¿ cooling with air dehumidification function.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the demisting function (Y page 130).
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
Windows misted up on the outside
Press the _ button repeatedly until the
P or O symbol appears in the display.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
Rear window heating
Switching on/off
G WARNING
Clear all windows of ice or snow before setting
off. Otherwise, impaired visibility could
endanger you and others.
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear. It otherwise
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
Problems with the rear window heating
The rear window heating has switched off
prematurely or cannot be activated.
X Switch off any consumers that are not
required, e.g. reading lamps or interior
lighting.
When the battery is sufficiently charged,
the rear window heating is activated again
automatically.
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
G WARNING
Only switch over to air-recirculation mode
briefly at low outside temperatures. Otherwise, the windows could mist up, thus impairing visibility and endangering yourself and
others. This may prevent you from observing
the traffic conditions, thereby causing an
accident.
1
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odours are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
The operation of air-recirculation mode is the
same for all control panels.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up.
i In the event of high pollution levels1 or at
high outside temperatures, air-recirculation mode is automatically activated. When
air-recirculation mode is activated automatically, the indicator lamp above the
g button does not light up.
Outside air is added after about
30 minutes.
To deactivate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out.
i Air-recirculation mode deactivates automatically:
X
Rafter
approximately five minutes at outside temperatures below approximately
5†
Rafter approximately five minutes if cooling with air dehumidification is deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately
5†
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
between the side window and the door frame
as the side windows are opened and closed.
Make sure that all objects and body parts are
clear of the side windows when they are being
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control only.
Z
131
Climate control
Operating the climate control system
Operating the climate control system
132
opened or closed. You or the objects could be
drawn in or become trapped between the side
window and the door frame as the window
moves. If there is a risk of entrapment, operate the W switch to move the side window
in the opposite direction.
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as the sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof is opened and closed. If there is a risk of
entrapment, operate the 3 switch to move
the sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof
in the opposite direction.
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows and the sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof are closed.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
X Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows and the sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof are opened. The side windows and the sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof move back to their original
position.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
Climate control
X
i If you open the side windows or the sliding
sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof manually after closing them with the convenience closing feature, they will remain in this
position when opened using the convenience opening feature.
Activating/deactivating the residual
heat function
The residual heat function is only available
with THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
of the engine to continue heating the stationary vehicle for up to 30 minutes after the
engine has been switched off. The heating
time depends on the temperature that has
been set for the vehicle interior.
X To activate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button lights
up.
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless of the airflow setting.
i If you activate the residual heat function
at high temperatures, only the ventilation
will be activated. The blower runs at
medium speed.
X
To deactivate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button goes
out.
i It is possible that the residual heat func-
tion may be activated automatically an hour
after the key has been removed. The vehicle is then ventilated for 30minutes to dry
the air-conditioning system.
Residual heat is deactivated automatically:
Rafter
approximately 30 minutes
the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
Rwhen
Auxiliary heating
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Exhaust fumes are produced when the auxiliary heating is in operation. Inhaling these
exhaust fumes can be poisonous. You should
therefore switch off the auxiliary heating in
confined spaces without an extraction system, e.g. a garage.
G WARNING
When operating the auxiliary heating parts of
the vehicle can get very hot. Make sure that
the exhaust system does not under any circumstances come into contact with easily
ignitable material such as dry grass or fuels.
The material could otherwise ignite and set
Operating the climate control system
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
The auxiliary heating heats the air in the
passenger compartment to the selected temperature. It does not use the heat of the running engine to do this. The auxiliary heating
is operated directly using the vehicle's fuel.
For this reason, the tank content must be at
least at reserve fuel level to ensure that the
auxiliary heating functions.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation automatically adjusts to changes in temperature and
weather conditions. For this reason, the auxiliary heating could switch from ventilation
mode to heating mode or from heating mode
to ventilation mode.
The auxiliary heating switches off automatically after 50 minutes. This time limit can be
altered. To do this, visit a qualified specialist
workshop.
You cannot use the auxiliary ventilation to
cool the vehicle interior to a temperature
lower than the outside temperature.
Before switching on
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated or deactivated using the remote control
or the button on the centre console.
The on-board computer can be used to specify up to three departure times, one of which
may be preselected (Y page 225).
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the centre console
button
The colours of the indicator lamps on the button have the following meanings:
Blue Auxiliary ventilation switched on
Red
Auxiliary heating switched on
Yellow Departure time preselected
(Y page 225)
Climate control
the vehicle alight. Choose your parking spot
accordingly.
Operating the auxiliary heating is thus prohibited at filling stations or when your vehicle
is being refuelled. You must therefore switch
off the auxiliary heating at filling stations.
Switch in the centre console
To switch the auxiliary heating/ventilation on: press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button : lights up.
X To switch the auxiliary heating/ventilation off: press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button : goes out.
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Set the temperature.
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the remote control
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated even when climate control is set to
manual. Optimum comfort can be attained
when the system is set to automatic mode.
Set the temperature to 22 †.
Points to observe before use
Your vehicle comes with one remote control.
You may use two additional remote controls
for your vehicle. For more information, please
contact a qualified specialist workshop.
X
133
Z
134
Operating the climate control system
The remote control has a maximum range of
approximately 300 metres. This range is
reduced by:
Rsources
of radio interference
objects between the remote control
and the vehicle
Rthe remote control being in an unfavourable position in relation to the vehicle
Rtransmitting from an enclosed space
Rsolid
i The optimum range can be achieved if you
Climate control
hold the remote control vertically, pointing
upwards when you press one of the buttons.
i A battery symbol appears in the display
when the battery in the remote control is
low. Replace the remote control battery
(Y page 135).
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off
To switch on: press the u button.
ON is shown in the remote control display.
X To deactivate: press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
X
Checking the status of the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the , or . button.
The following messages may appear in the
display:
Display
Meaning
The auxiliary heating/
ventilation is switched
off.
The auxiliary ventilation
is switched on. The number in the display shows
the remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation.
The auxiliary heating is
switched on. The number
in the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating.
Auxiliary heating remote control
: Display
; . To check the status/set the depar-
ture time
= ^ To switch off the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
? u To switch on the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
A , To check the status/set the depar-
ture time
A departure time has
been activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary ventilation is currently selected. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary heating is currently
selected. The departure
time appears in the display.
Operating the climate control system
X
Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The new departure time is stored.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
Climate control
Setting the departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the time to be changed appears in the
display.
X Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The Î symbol in the remote control display flashes.
X Press the , or . button to set the
desired departure time.
i The longer you press the , or .
button, the faster the time changes.
Activating the set departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the desired departure time appears in
the display.
X Press the u button.
The Í symbol and the departure time
appear in the display.
Deactivating a set departure time
X Press the , or . button.
The status of the auxiliary heating is shown
in the display.
X Press the . button.
The first departure time stored appears in
the display.
X Press the ^ button.
The display message OFF appears in the
display.
Replacing the remote control battery
G WARNING
Batteries contain poisonous substances.
Swallowing/ingesting batteries can result in
serious personal injury or death.
Always keep batteries away from children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek immediate medical attention.
135
One 6 V pin battery, type 2CR11108 is
required.
X Prise apart the side arms of battery
cover ; and pull off battery cover ;.
X Remove old battery :.
X Insert the new battery. Observe the polarity
signs on the back of the remote control
when doing so.
X Slide battery cover ; back onto the
remote control.
X Use the remote control to check the vehicle's auxiliary heating functions.
Z
136
Adjusting the air vents
Problems with the auxiliary heating/ventilation
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
FAIL
The starter battery is not charged sufficiently or the system is
faulty.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
$
The signal transmission between the transmitter and the vehicle
is faulty.
X Change your position in relation to the vehicle, moving closer if
necessary.
X Make another attempt to switch the auxiliary heating on or off
using the remote control.
Climate control
FAIL
©
FAIL
There is not enough fuel in the fuel tank, or the auxiliary heating
is faulty.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Important safety notes
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
G WARNING
Rkeep
Adjusting the air vents
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could cause burns or frostbite to
bare skin in the immediate vicinity of the
vents. Keep bare skin away from these air
outlets. If necessary, direct the airflow away
to a different area of the vehicle interior.
the air inlet between the windscreen
and the bonnet free of blockages, such as
ice, snow or leaves.
Rnever cover the vents or ventilation grilles
in the vehicle interior.
Adjusting the air vents
Setting the centre air vents
137
midification" function. Otherwise, temperature-sensitive items stored in the glove
compartment could be damaged.
: Centre air vent, left
= Centre vent thumbwheel, right
? Centre vent thumbwheel, left
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheels =
and ? up or down.
Setting the side air vents
: Air vent thumbwheel
; Air vent
When automatic climate control is activated,
the glove compartment can be ventilated, for
instance to cool its contents. The level of airflow depends on the airflow and air distribution settings.
X To open/close: turn thumbwheel :
clockwise or anti-clockwise.
Setting the rear-compartment air
vents
Setting the centre vents in the rear compartment
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel = up or
down.
i Side window demister vent : is only
open when side air vent ; is open.
Setting the glove compartment air
vent
! Close the air vent when heating the vehi-
cle.
At high outside temperatures, open the air
vent and activate the "cooling with air dehu-
: Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel
; Rear-compartment air vent, right
Z
Climate control
; Centre air vent, right
Adjusting the air vents
138
= Rear control unit, only with
THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control
? Rear-compartment air vent, left
Climate control
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel : up or
down.
Useful information ............................
Running-in notes ...............................
Driving ...............................................
Automatic transmission ...................
Refuelling ...........................................
Parking ...............................................
Driving tips ........................................
Driving systems ................................
140
140
140
148
156
159
161
165
Driving and parking
139
140
Driving
Useful information
Driving and parking
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
After 1500 km, you may gradually accelerate
the vehicle to full road and engine speeds.
Additional running-in notes for AMG vehicles:
RDo not drive at speeds above 140 km/h for
the first 1500 km.
allow the engine to reach a maximum
engine speed of 4500 rpm briefly.
ROnly
i You should also observe these notes on
running in if the engine or parts of the drive
train on your vehicle have been replaced.
ist workshops: (Y page 23).
Running-in notes
Important safety notes
New and replaced brake pads and discs only
reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for this by applying greater force to the
brake pedal.
The first 1,500 km
If you treat the engine with sufficient care
from the very start, you will be rewarded with
excellent performance for the remainder of
the engine's life.
RDrive
at varying vehicle speeds and engine
speeds for the first 1,500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, before the rev
counter needle is Ô of the way to the red
area of the rev counter.
RDo not shift down a gear manually in order
to brake.
RTry to avoid depressing the accelerator
pedal beyond the point of resistance (kickdown).
RThe shift ranges 3, 2 or 1 should only be
engaged when driving slowly, e.g. when
driving in mountainous terrain.
AMG vehicles with rear axle differential lock
Your vehicle is equipped with a self-locking
differential on the rear axle. Change the oil
after a running-in period of 3000 km to
improve protection of the rear axle differential. This oil change will lengthen the service
life of the differential. Have the oil change
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell can restrict the
pedal travel or obstruct a depressed pedal.
The operating and road safety of the vehicle
is jeopardised. There is a risk of an accident.
Make sure that all objects in the vehicle are
stowed correctly, and that they cannot enter
the driver's footwell. Fit the floormats
securely and as specified in order to ensure
sufficient clearance for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats.
G WARNING
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
with high heels
Rslippers
Rshoes
Driving
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
Key positions
Key
Driving and parking
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
Rlose
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only set the automatic transmission to the
respective drive positions when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. Otherwise, you could damage the
drive train.
! AMG vehicles: at low engine oil temperatures (below +20 †), the maximum
engine speed is restricted in order to protect the engine. To protect the engine and
maintain smooth engine operation, avoid
driving at full throttle when the engine is
cold.
141
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the engine
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle,
it can still be turned in the ignition lock.
However, the ignition will not be switched
on. The engine cannot be started.
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
RDo not keep the KEYLESS-GO key together
with:
- electronic devices, e.g. a mobile phone
or another key
- metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal film
RDo not keep the KEYLESS-GO key together
in metallic objects, e.g. a metal case.
This can affect the functionality of KEYLESS-GO.
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with
a key featuring an integrated KEYLESS-GO
start function and a detachable Start/Stop
button.
The Start/Stop button must be inserted in the
ignition lock and the key must be in the vehicle.
Z
Driving
Driving and parking
142
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times
in succession corresponds to the different
key positions in the ignition lock. This is only
the case if you are not depressing the brake
pedal.
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately.
Removing the Start/Stop button
Key positions with KEYLESS-GO
X
Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
You can remove the Start/Stop button from
the ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal using the key.
i You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
Switching on the power supply
Position 0: if Start/Stop button : has not
yet been pressed, this corresponds to the
key being removed from the ignition.
X Position 1: press Start/Stop button :.
The power supply is switched on. You can
now activate the windscreen wipers, for
example.
i If you then open the driver's door when in
this position, the power supply is deactivated.
Switching on the ignition
X
Position 2 (ignition): press Start/Stop button : twice.
The ignition is switched on.
i The ignition is switched off if:
X
Rthe
driver's door is open and
press Start/Stop button : once
when in this position.
Ryou
button from the ignition lock when you
leave the vehicle.
i When you insert Start/Stop button :
into ignition lock ;, the system needs
approximately two seconds recognition
time. You can then use Start/Stop button :.
Starting the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases leads to poisoning. There
is a risk of fatal injury. Therefore never leave
the engine running in enclosed spaces without sufficient ventilation.
! Do not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
General notes
i The catalytic converter is preheated for
up to 30seconds after a cold start. The
Driving
mode for starting the engine operates independently of the ECO start/stop automatic
engine start function.
sound of the engine may change during this
time.
X
Shift the transmission to position P.
The transmission position display in the
multifunction display shows P.
i You can also start the engine when the
transmission is in position N.
Starting procedure with the key
i To start the engine using the key instead
of KEYLESS-GO, pull the Start/Stop button
out of the ignition lock.
To start a petrol engine: turn the key to
position 3 in the ignition lock
(Y page 141) and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
X To start a diesel engine: turn the key to
position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 141).
The % preglow indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X When the % erlischt, den Schlüssel auf
Stellung 3(Y page 141) and release it as
soon as the engine is running.
X
i You can start the engine without preglow
if the engine is warm.
Using KEYLESS-GO to start the engine
G WARNING
Your vehicle can be started using a valid KEYLESS-GO key. For this reason, children should
never be left unsupervised in the vehicle.
Always take the key with you when leaving the
vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for a
short time.
i The Start/Stop button can be used to
start the vehicle manually without inserting
the key into the ignition lock. The key must
be in the vehicle and the Start/Stop button
must be inserted in the ignition lock. This
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X To start a petrol engine: press the Start/
Stop button (Y page 141) once.
The engine starts.
X To start a diesel engine: press the Start/
Stop button (Y page 141) once.
Preglow is activated and the engine starts.
X
Pulling away
Automatic transmission
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or
R, the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There
is a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
X Release the parking brake (Y page 160).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
X
i It is only possible to shift the transmission
from position P to the desired position if
you depress the brake pedal. Only then is
the parking lock released.
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 225).
Z
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
143
144
Driving
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
Driving and parking
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Hill start assist
G WARNING
After a short time, hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient.
It holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
X Take your foot off the brake pedal.
The vehicle is then held for about a second.
X Pull away.
Hill start assist will not function if:
Ryou
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient.
Rthe transmission is in position N.
Rthe parking brake is applied.
RESP® is malfunctioning.
ECO start/stop function
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off automatically and
you exit the vehicle, the engine is restarted
automatically. The vehicle may begin moving.
There is a risk of accident and injury.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the ignition and secure the vehicle against
rolling away.
General notes
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving.
When pulling away again, the engine starts
automatically. The ECO start/stop function
thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.
Every time you switch on the engine using the
key or the Start/Stop button, the ECO start/
stop function is activated.
AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop function
is only available in drive program C.
The system is operational when ECO symbol
¤ is shown in green in the multifunction
display.
AMG vehicles: the AMG menu in the multifunction display additionally shows the Stop/
Start active message.
If conditions for automatic engine switch-off
have not been fulfilled (Y page 145), the
¤ symbol will be shown in yellow.
AMG vehicles: the AMG menu in the multifunction display additionally shows the Stop/
Start inactive message.
If the ECO start/stop function has been manually deactivated (Y page 145) or a malfunction has caused the system to be deactivated,
the ¤ symbol is not displayed.
AMG vehicles: in the AMG menu on the multifunction display, the Stop/Start active
or Stop/Start inactive display message
disappears.
If the engine is switched off and the ¤
symbol is shown in green in the multifunction
display, the engine has been switched off
automatically. However, all vehicle systems
remain active.
Deactivating/activating the ECO start/
stop function
ECO button
To switch off (except AMG vehicles):
press button :.
Indicator lamp ; on button : and the
¤ symbol in the multifunction display go
out.
X To switch on (except AMG vehicles):
press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. If all conditions
for automatic engine switch-off
(Y page 145) are fulfilled, the ¤ symbol
is shown in green in the multifunction display.
If not all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 145) are fulfilled, the
¤ symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the
ECO start/stop function is not available.
X
X
To switch off (AMG vehicles): press button : in drive program C.
or
X
Switch to drive program S, S+ or M
(Y page 152).
Indicator lamp ; on button : and the
¤ symbol in the multifunction display go
out.
The Stop/Start active or Stop/Start
inactive message in the AMG menu in the
multifunction display goes out.
X
To switch on (AMG vehicles): press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. If drive program S, S+ or M is active, the automatic
transmission switches to drive program C.
If all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 145) are fulfilled, the
¤ symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display. In addition, the Stop/
Start active message is shown in the
AMG menu in the multifunction display.
If conditions for automatic engine switchoff have not been fulfilled, the (Y page 145)
¤ symbol will be shown in yellow. If this
is the case, the ECO start/stop function is
not available. In addition, the Stop/Start
inactive message is shown in the AMG
menu in the multifunction display.
i If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/
stop function has been deactivated manually or as the result of a malfunction. The
engine will then not be switched off automatically when the vehicle stops.
i Every time you switch on the engine using
the key or the Start/Stop button, the ECO
start/stop function is activated.
Automatic engine switch-off
Method of operation
If the vehicle is braked to a standstill in D or
N, the ECO start/stop function switches off
the engine automatically.
The ECO start/stop function is operational
and the ¤ symbol is displayed in green in
the multifunction display, if:
Rthe
indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit
green.
Rthe vehicle is stationary.
Rthe outside temperature is within the comfort range.
Rthe engine is at normal operating temperature.
Z
145
Driving and parking
Driving
146
Driving
Driving and parking
Rthe
set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached.
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged.
Rthe system detects that the windscreen is
not misted up when the air-conditioning
system is switched on.
Rthe bonnet is closed.
Rthe driver's door is closed and the driver's
seat belt is fastened.
If conditions for automatic engine switch-off
have not been fulfilled, the ¤ symbol will
be shown in yellow.
AMG vehicles: the AMG menu in the multifunction display additionally shows the Stop/
Start inactive message.
i If you shift the transmission from R to D,
the ECO start/stop function is available
again once the ¤ symbol reappears in
green in the multifunction display.
i All vehicles (except AMG vehicles):
automatic engine switch-off can take place
a maximum of four times consecutively (initial stop and three subsequent stops). The
¤ symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunction display after the engine has been
started automatically for the fourth time.
The automatic engine switch-off is available once again when the ¤ symbol is
shown in green in the multifunction display.
i AMG vehicles: times which the engine
can be automatically switched off.
i You can also activate the HOLD function
when the vehicle is stationary if the engine
has been switched off automatically. It is
then not necessary to continue applying
the brakes during the automatic stop
phase. When you depress the accelerator
pedal, the engine starts automatically and
the braking effect of the HOLD function is
deactivated. Depress the accelerator pedal
gently, as the engine must be started first.
i During automatic engine switch-off, the
climate control system only operates at a
reduced capacity. If you require full climate
control capacity, the ECO start/stop function can be deactivated by pressing the
ECO button (Y page 145).
Automatic engine start
The engine is started automatically if:
Ryou
switch off the ECO start/stop function
by pressing the ECO button.
Ryou release the brakes when in transmission position D or N, when the HOLD function is not active.
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal.
Ryou engage reverse gear R.
Ryou move the transmission out of position
P.
Ryou switch to drive program S, S+ or M
(AMG vehicles).
Ryou unfasten your seat belt or open the
driver's door.
Rthe vehicle starts to roll.
Rthe brake system requires this.
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range.
Rthe system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on.
Rthe battery's charge status is too low.
i Shifting the transmission to position P
does not start the engine.
Driving
147
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 179) or DISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 177).
X Try to start the engine again.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
RThere
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
X Before attempting to start the engine again, turn the key in the
ignition back to position 0 or press the Start/Stop button
repeatedly until all indicator lamps in the instrument cluster go
out.
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 142). Avoid excessively
long and frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain
the battery.
RThere
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine does not
The fuel tank is empty.
start. The starter motor X Refuel the vehicle.
can be heard. The
reserve fuel warning
lamp is lit and the fuel
gauge display shows 0.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak
or discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 319).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Driving and parking
148
Automatic transmission
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicles with a petrol
engine:
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The coolant temperaThe coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
ture display is showing is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
more than 120 †. The X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant
coolant warning lamp
to cool down.
may also be lit and a
X Check the coolant level (Y page 299). Observe the warning
warning tone may
notes as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
sound.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Automatic transmission
Important safety notes
Selector lever
Overview of transmission positions
G WARNING
If the engine speed is above the idling speed
and you engage transmission position D or
R, the vehicle could pull away suddenly. There
is a risk of an accident.
When engaging transmission position D or R,
always firmly depress the brake pedal and do
not simultaneously accelerate.
Selector lever in AMG vehicles with P button
j Park position with parking lock
k Reverse gear
i Neutral
h Drive
Automatic transmission
Transmission position and drive program display
multifunction display is not working, you
should pull away carefully to check whether
the desired transmission position is
engaged. Ideally, you should select transmission position D and drive program C. Do
not restrict the shift range.
transmission position display
(Y page 149) in the multifunction display.
Transmission position and drive program display
! If the transmission position display in the
multifunction display is not working, you
should pull away carefully to check whether
the desired transmission position is
engaged. Ideally, you should select transmission position D and drive program E or
S. Do not restrict the shift range.
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
DIRECT SELECT lever
Overview of transmission positions
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
i The arrows in the transmission position
display show how and into which transmission positions you can change using the
DIRECT SELECT lever.
Engaging park position P
! If the engine speed is too high, do not shift
the automatic transmission directly from
D to R, from R to D or directly to P. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be
damaged.
P
R
N
D
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever in the direction of arrow P.
The DIRECT SELECT lever is on the right of the
steering column.
i The DIRECT SELECT lever always returns
to its original position. The current transmission position P, R, N or D appears in the
Z
Driving and parking
! If the transmission position display in the
149
Automatic transmission
150
i The automatic transmission shifts automatically into park position P if you:
Driving and parking
Ropen
the driver's door when the vehicle
is stationary and the transmission is in
position D or R
Ropen the driver's door when driving at
very low speed with the transmission in
position D or R
braked to a standstill in transmission position D.
For further information on the ECO start/stop
function, see (Y page 144).
Engaging drive position D
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever down past
the first point of resistance.
i Depress the brake and push the DIRECT
SELECT lever up or down to disengage the
parking lock. The transmission is in neutral
N.
If you want to shift from park position P
directly to R or D:
Transmission positions
B
Engaging reverse gear R
Park position
This prevents the vehicle from rolling away when stopped. Do not
shift the transmission into position
P(Y page 159) unless the vehicle
is stationary.
The automatic transmission shifts
to P automatically if you:
! Only shift the automatic transmission to
Rremove
Rdepress
the brake and
the DIRECT SELECT lever up or
down past the first point of resistance.
Rpush
the key
off the engine when in R
or D and open one of the front
doors
R when the vehicle is stationary.
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up past the
first point of resistance.
Neutral N with ECO start/stop function
activated
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically when the vehicle is
stationary if the vehicle is braked to a standstill in neutral N.
For further information on the ECO start/stop
function, see (Y page 144).
Shifting to neutral (N)
X
Rswitch
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
to the first point of resistance.
Drive position D with ECO start/stop
function activated
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically when the vehicle is
C
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
Automatic transmission
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
only shift the transmission to position N if the vehicle is in danger of
skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
If you switch off the engine using
the key or the Start/Stop button,
the automatic transmission shifts
to neutral N automatically.
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
7
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
AMG vehicles
When shifting down, the double-clutch function is active regardless of the currently selected drive program. The double-clutch function
reduces load change reactions and is conducive to a sporty driving style. The sound generated by the double-clutch function depends
on the drive program selected.
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
X
Program selector button
Changing gear
General notes
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. Gearshifting is determined by:
Ra
shift range restriction, if selected
selected drive program(Y page 151)
Rthe position of the accelerator pedal
Rthe road speed
Rthe
Driving tips
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle
throttle: early upshifts
throttle: late upshifts
Rmore
Example: program selector button
X
Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired gearshift
program appears in the multifunction display.
The program selector button allows you to
choose between different driving characteristics.
Z
Driving and parking
A
151
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
152
E Economy
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program C each time the
engine is started.
i RS cannot be selected during normal driving. For further information on RACE
START, see (Y page 180).
i For further information on the automatic
drive program, see (Y page 152).
i The automatic transmission switches to
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
automatic drive program E each time the
engine is started.
AMG vehicles
: Left-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle
; Right-hand steering wheel gearshift pad-
dle
Drive program selector with manual drive program
X
Turn drive program selector : until the
desired drive program appears in the multifunction display in the speedometer.
The drive program indicator on drive program selector : lights up in red.
C Controlled
Efficiency
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
S+ SportPlus
Extremely sporty driving
style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
RS RACE
START
Optimal vehicle acceleration from a standstill
i For further information on the automatic
drive program, see (Y page 152).
You can restrict or derestrict the shift range
by using the steering wheel gearshift paddles.
You can change gear yourself by using the
steering wheel gearshift paddle in the manual
drive program.
i You can only change gear with the steer-
ing wheel gearshift paddles when the transmission is in position D.
Automatic drive program
Drive program E (drive program C on AMG
vehicles) is characterised by the following:
Rcomfort-oriented engine and automatic
transmission settings
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears, unless the
accelerator pedal is depressed fully
Automatic transmission
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. This results in the vehicle being
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin
Drive program S (or, in the case of AMG vehicles, drive programs S and S+) is characterised by the following:
Rsporty
engine and automatic transmission
settings
Rthe vehicle pulling away in first gear
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher.
Shift range:
= To use the engine's braking effect
5 To use the braking effect of the
engine on downhill gradients and
for driving:
Ron
steep mountain roads
mountainous terrain
Rin arduous conditions
Rin
4 To use the braking effect of the
engine on extremely steep downhill
gradients and on long downhill
stretches
Restricting the shift range
X
Shift ranges
Introduction
i If the engine exceeds the maximum
engine speed when shifting down, the automatic transmission protects against engine
damage by not shifting down.
i On AMG vehicles and vehicles with
steering wheel gearshift paddles, you
can restrict or derestrict the shift range
using the steering wheel gearshift paddles.
When the automatic transmission is in position D, it is possible to restrict or derestrict
the shift range (Y page 153).
The shift range selected is shown in the multifunction display. The automatic transmission shifts only as far as the selected gear.
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The automatic transmission shifts down
one gear and restricts the shift range to the
relevant gear.
i If the maximum engine speed for the shift
range is reached and you continue to accelerate, the automatic transmission shifts up,
even if the shift range is restricted. This
prevents the engine from overrevving.
Extending the shift range
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The shift range is derestricted.
Z
Driving and parking
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
153
Automatic transmission
154
Clearing the shift range restriction
Driving and parking
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle until the number for the gear disappears from the multifunction display.
or
X
Shift the transmission to position D.
The automatic transmission shifts from the
current shift range directly to D.
Selecting the ideal shift range
X
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. You must make sure that
the engine speed does not reach the red
area of the rev counter. Otherwise, there is
a risk of engine damage.
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle and hold it in position.
The automatic transmission shifts to the
gear which allows optimum acceleration
and deceleration. To do this, the automatic
transmission shifts down one or more
gears.
X
AMG vehicles
X If the colour in the multifunction display in
the speedometer changes to red and the
UP display message is shown, shift up a
gear.
Downshifting
X
Manual drive program
Activating the manual drive program
X
X
Press the program selector button
(Y page 151) repeatedly until M appears in
the multifunction display.
AMG vehicles: turn the drive program
selector (Y page 152) until M appears in the
multifunction display.
The indicator M on the drive program selector lights up in red.
AMG vehicles and vehicles with a DIRECT
SELECT lever: you can select manual drive
program M using the program selector or the
drive program selector button. In manual
drive program M, you can change gear using
the steering wheel gearshift paddles if the
transmission is in position D.
Upshifting
! In manual gearshift program M, the auto-
matic transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting
speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
i If you slow down or stop without shifting
down, the automatic transmission automatically shifts down.
i For maximum acceleration, pull the left-
hand steering wheel gearshift paddle until
the transmission selects the optimum gear
for the current speed.
Kickdown
You can also use kickdown for maximum
acceleration in manual drive program M.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Shift back up once the desired speed is
reached.
X
i AMG vehicles: it is not possible to use
kickdown in manual drive program M.
Automatic transmission
155
Switching off the manual drive program
All vehicles (except AMG vehicles) with
a DIRECT SELECT lever: press the program selector button (Y page 151) repeatedly until E or S appears in the multifunction display.
X AMG vehicles: turn the drive program
selector (Y page 152) until C, S or S+
appears in the multifunction display.
Driving and parking
X
Z
156
Refuelling
Problems with the transmission
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
The transmission is losing oil.
problems shifting gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
It is only possible to shift into second gear and reverse gear.
The transmission no
X Stop.
longer changes gear.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Wait at least ten seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
If D is selected, the transmission shifts into second gear; if R is
selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames
and smoking are therefore prohibited when
handling fuels.
Switch off the engine and the auxiliary heating
before refuelling.
G WARNING
Avoid contact with fuels.
It is hazardous to your health if your skin
comes into direct contact with fuels or you
breathe in fuel vapours.
G WARNING
Do not use petrol to refuel a diesel tank. Never
mix diesel with petrol. Doing so could damage
the fuel system and the engine. The vehicle
could also catch fire.
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Even small
amounts of the wrong fuel result in damage
to the fuel system and the engine.
! Do not switch on the ignition if you acci-
dentally refuel with the wrong fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel lines. Notify
a qualified specialist workshop and have
the fuel tank and fuel lines drained completely.
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Take care not to spill any fuel on painted
surfaces. You could otherwise damage the
paintwork.
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
can. The fuel lines and/or the diesel injection system could otherwise be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
Further information on fuel and on fuel grades
can be found in the "Fuel" section
(Y page 360).
Refuelling
Opening/closing the fuel filler flap
insert the fuel filler cap into the holder on
the inside of fuel filler flap;
X Completely insert the filler neck of the fuel
pump nozzle into the tank and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
i Do not add any more fuel after the pump
stops filling for the first time. Otherwise,
fuel may leak out.
X
Closing
Replace the cap on the filler neck and turn
clockwise until it engages audibly.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
X
: To open the fuel filler flap
; To insert the fuel filler cap
= Tyre pressure table
i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle. Otherwise, the locking pin of the
central locking prevents the fuel filler flap
from closing.
? Fuel type to be refuelled
The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked automatically when you open or close the vehicle
with the key or using KEYLESS-GO.
The position of the fuel filler cap is displayed
8 in the instrument cluster. The arrow
next to the filling pump indicates the side of
the vehicle.
Fuel filler flap emergency release
X
open the boot lid.
Opening
Switch off the engine.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door.
This corresponds to key position 0: "key
removed".
The driver's door can be closed again.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap opens slightly.
X Open the fuel filler flap fully.
X Turn the fuel filler flap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X
X
Slide the luggage net down.
Open the right-hand side trim panel.
X Remove the first-aid kit (Y page 310).
X Detach the emergency release from
retainer :.
X Pull the emergency release in the direction
of arrow ;.
The fuel filler flap is released.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
X
X
Z
Driving and parking
Refuelling
157
158
Refuelling
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Driving and parking
Problem
Fuel is leaking from the
vehicle.
The engine does not
start.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of explosion or fire
The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock immediately and
remove it (Y page 141).
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel tank of a vehicle with a diesel engine has been run completely dry.
X Refuel the vehicle with at least 5 litres of diesel.
X Turn the ignition on for approximately ten seconds
(Y page 141).
X Start the engine continuously for up to ten seconds until it runs
smoothly.
or
X Start the engine using the touch-start function. To do this, turn
the key to position 3 in the ignition lock and then release it
immediately (Y page 141).
If the engine does not start:
X Turn the ignition on again for approximately ten seconds
(Y page 141).
X Start the engine again continuously for up to ten seconds until
it runs smoothly.
or
X Start the engine again via the touch-start function.
If the engine does not start after three attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The fuel filler flap cannot be opened.
The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
or
The key battery is discharged.
X Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element
(Y page 78).
X Open the boot lid or the tailgate.
X open the boot lid.
X Manually unlock the fuel filler flap using the emergency release
(Y page 157).
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
G WARNING
Important safety notes
If you leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, they could set it in motion by, for example:
G WARNING
If flammable materials such as leaves, grass
or twigs are exposed to prolonged contact to
parts of the exhaust system that heat up, they
could ignite. There is a risk of fire.
Park the vehicle so that no flammable materials come into contact with parts of the vehicle which are hot. Take particular care not to
park on dry grassland or harvested grain
fields.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
the parking position P
Rstarting the engine.
They could also operate the vehicle's equipment. There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unsupervised in the vehicle.
Rshifting
! A moving vehicle can lead to damage to
the vehicle or damage to the drive train.
To ensure that the vehicle is secured against
rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe
parking brake must be applied.
transmission must be in position P and
the key must be removed from the ignition
lock.
Ron uphill or downhill gradients, the front
wheels must be turned towards the kerb.
Rthe
Z
159
Driving and parking
Parking
Parking
160
Switching off the engine
Vehicles with automatic transmission
Firmly depress the parking brake.
X All vehicles (except AMG vehicles): shift
the transmission to position P.
Driving and parking
X
one of the front doors, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
i The engine can be turned off while the
vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding
the Start/Stop button for about three seconds. This function operates independently
of the ECO start/stop automatic engine
switch-off function.
Parking brake
G WARNING
Selector lever in AMG vehicles with P button
X
AMG vehicles: press P button :.
Using the key
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
i If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic
transmission shifts to N automatically.
If you then open one of the front doors or
remove the key from the ignition, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
If you shift the automatic transmission to
N before switching off the engine, the automatic transmission remains in N even if a
door is opened.
Using KEYLESS-GO
X
Press the Start/Stop button (Y page 141).
The engine stops and all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
i When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's door is open, this corresponds to key
position 0, i.e. key removed.
X
i If you use the Start/Stop button to switch
off the engine, the automatic transmission
shifts to N automatically. If you then open
If you must brake the vehicle with the parking
brake, the braking distance is considerably
longer and the wheels could lock. This increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
Only use the parking brake to brake the vehicle when the service brake is faulty. Do not
apply the parking brake too firmly. If the
wheels lock, release the parking brake until
the wheels begin turning again.
G WARNING
If you leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, they could set it in motion by, for example:
Rreleasing
the parking brake
the automatic transmission out of
the parking position P
Rstarting the engine.
They could also operate the vehicle's equipment. There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the key
with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave
children unsupervised in the vehicle.
Rshifting
Driving tips
161
Driving and parking
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
ECO display
When you apply the parking brake to brake
the vehicle, the brake lamps do not light up.
X To apply: depress parking brake ; firmly.
The J indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up if the engine is running.
X To release: depress the brake pedal and
keep it depressed.
X Pull release handle :.
The J indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharging.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a result of lack of use.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Driving tips
General notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
ECO display (example)
The ECO display gives you information on how
economical your driving style is. The ECO display assists you in achieving the optimum
driving style in terms of consumption, taking
the actual and selected conditions into consideration. Your driving style can significantly
influence the vehicle's consumption.
The ECO display consists of three bars:
RAcceleration
RConstant
RCoasting
The percent value is the average value of the
three bars. The three bars and the average
value commence with a value of 50%. A higher
percentage indicates a more economical driving style.
The ECO display provides no information on
the actual fuel consumption. A fixed percentage value of the ECO display does not correspond to a fixed consumption figure in
l/100km.
Apart from driving style, consumption is
dependent on many factors such as:
Rload
Rtyre
pressure
start
Rselected route
Rnumber of consumers that are switched on
Rcold
Z
Driving and parking
162
Driving tips
These variable are not included in the ECO
display.
Your driving style is evaluated on the basis of
the following three categories:
Acceleration (evaluation of all acceleration processes)
The bar fills up:
The bar depletes:
Moderate acceleration, espeically at
higher speeds
Sporty acceleration
Constant (evaluation of the driving style
at any point in time)
The bar fills up:
The bar depletes:
Constant speed and Fluctuations in
avoidance of unnec- speed
essary acceleration
and deceleration
processes
Coasting (evaluation of total deceleration)
The bar fills up:
The bar depletes:
Drive with care,
Frequent braking
keep your distance
from the vehicle
ahead and remove
your foot from the
accelerator pedal in
good time: the vehicle can coast without braking
i An economical driving style depends in
particular on driving at moderate speeds.
Achieving a higher value in the categories
"Acceleration" and "Constant":
Robserve the gearshift recommendations.
Rdrive
in drive program E.
i On long journeys at constant speed, such
as on the motorway, only the "Constant"
category bar changes.
i The ECO display sums up the driving
behaviour from the start to the end of the
journey. As a result, the bars change
dynamically at the start of the journey. During long journeys there are fewer changes.
For more dynamic changes, perform a manual reset.
For further information on ECO display, see
(Y page 213).
Engine oil
! Vehicles with a diesel particle filter: if
the vehicle is mostly driven for short distances, it is possible that malfunctions may
occur during the automatic cleaning of the
diesel particle filter. This may lead to fuel
collecting in the engine oil and cause
engine failure. Therefore, if you frequently
drive short distances, you should take a 20
minute trip on a motorway or rural road at
least every 500km.
Brakes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
Downhill gradients
On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden, you must select
shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good time.
Driving tips
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to prevent the
vehicle from gaining speed. This relieves the
load on the brake system and prevents the
brakes from overheating and wearing too
quickly.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
The braking system can overheat if you leave
your foot on the brake pedal while driving.
This increases the braking distance and could
even cause the braking system to fail. There
is a risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Do
not simultaneously depress both the brake
pedal and the accelerator pedal while driving.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
load, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but
drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed. This improves the grip of the
brakes.
Wet road surfaces
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time. This may also occur after the vehicle has
been washed or driven through deep water.
You have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance from the
vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying atten-
tion to the traffic conditions. This will warm
up the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salted roads, a layer of salt
residue may form on the brake discs and
brake pads. This can result in a significantly
longer braking distance.
RBrake occasionally to remove any possible
salt residue. Make sure that you do not
endanger other road users when doing so.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal and the
beginning and end of a journey.
RMaintain a greater distance to the vehicle
ahead.
New brake pads/linings
New and replaced brake pads and discs only
reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for this by applying greater force to the
brake pedal.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which correspond to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake pads/linings which have not
been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which are not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
AMG high-performance and ceramic
brakes
The AMG brake systems are designed for
heavy loads. This may lead to noise when
braking. This is dependent on:
Rspeed
Rbraking
force
Renvironmental conditions, such as temper-
ature and humidity
Z
Driving and parking
i This also applies if you have activated
163
Driving and parking
164
Driving tips
The wear of individual components of the
brake system, such as the brake pads/linings
or brake discs, depends on the individual driving style and operating conditions.
For this reason, it is impossible to state a
mileage lifetime that will be valid under all
circumstances. An aggressive driving style
will lead to high wear. You can obtain further
information about this from your MercedesBenz Service Centre.
New and replaced brake pads and discs only
reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Compensate for this by applying greater force to the
brake pedal. Do not forget this, and adapt
your driving and braking accordingly during
this run-in period.
Excessively heavy braking results in correspondingly high brake wear. Observe the
brake system warning lamp in the instrument
cluster and note any brake status messages
in the multifunction display. For high-performance driving in particular, it is important
to maintain and have the brake system
checked regularly.
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
are driving at low speeds.
tyres have adequate tread depth.
For this reason, do not drive in tyre ruts and
brake carefully.
Rthe
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. You could otherwise dam-
age the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
If you have to drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe
maximum permissible still water depth
is 25 cm.
Ryou should drive no faster than at walking
pace.
Winter driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
G DANGER
If the exhaust pipe is blocked or adequate
ventilation is not possible, poisonous gases
such as carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle. This is the case, e.g. if the vehicle
becomes trapped in snow. There is a risk of
fatal injury.
If you leave the engine or the auxiliary heating
running, make sure the exhaust pipe and area
around the vehicle are clear of snow. To
ensure an adequate supply of fresh air, open
a window on the side of the vehicle that is not
facing into the wind.
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 330).
Driving with summer tyres
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 330).
Driving systems
G WARNING
If you shift down on a slippery road surface in
an attempt to increase the engine's braking
effect, the drive wheels could lose their grip.
This increases the risk of skidding and having
an accident.
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
X
X
Move the transmission to position N.
Try to bring the vehicle under control by
using corrective steering.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres.
i For more information on driving with
snow chains, see (Y page 331).
Driving systems
Cruise control
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
G WARNING
Do not use cruise control
Rin traffic conditions that do not allow you to
drive at a constant speed (e.g. heavy traffic
or winding roads). You may otherwise
cause an accident.
Ron slippery roads. The drive wheels may
lose their grip when braking or accelerating
and the vehicle may skid.
Rwhen there is low visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow.
General notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden, you must select shift range
1, 2 or 3 in good time. By doing so, you will
make use of the braking effect of the engine.
This relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
Cruise control lever
G WARNING
Cruise control cannot take account of road
and traffic conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions
even when cruise control is activated.
Cruise control is only an aid designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for the vehicle's
speed and for braking in good time.
: To activate or increase speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To activate at the current speed/last
stored speed
? To activate or reduce speed
Z
Driving and parking
Slippery road surfaces
165
Driving systems
166
A To switch between cruise control and var-
iable SPEEDTRONIC
Driving and parking
B To deactivate cruise control
You can operate cruise control and variable
SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control is
selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds. In the multifunction display,
the segments between the stored speed and
the maximum speed light up.
Activation conditions
To activate cruise control, all of the following
activation conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
parking brake must be released.
must be driving faster than 30 km/h.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe cruise control function must be selected (Y page 166).
Ryou
Selecting cruise control
You can accept the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever
up : or down ;.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the stored speed.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically applying the brakes.
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
Only call up a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and if it is suitable for the current
traffic and driving situation. You can otherwise endanger yourself or others by unintentionally triggering sudden acceleration or
braking.
Driving systems
167
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
X
Deactivating cruise control
Setting a speed
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards =.
or
X
Brake
or
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ; to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: press the cruise control lever
X
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow ;.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp : in the cruise control lever
lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
depress the parking brake.
are driving at less than 30 km/h.
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®.
Ryou shift the transmission to position N
while driving.
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear
a warning tone. You will see the Cruise
Ryou
Z
Driving and parking
briefly up : or down ; beyond the pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
168
Driving systems
control off message in the multifunction
display for approximately five seconds.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
Driving and parking
switch off the engine.
SPEEDTRONIC
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Never depress the brake pedal continuously
while the vehicle is in motion, e.g. never cause
the brakes to rub by applying constant slight
pedal pressure. This causes the brake system
to overheat, increases the braking distance
and can lead to the brakes failing completely.
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
G WARNING
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed and call up the
last stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower
speed
SPEEDTRONIC is only an aid designed to
assist driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed and for braking in good time.
A To switch between cruise control or DIS-
SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that
you do not exceed the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden, you must select shift range
1, 2 or 3 in good time. By doing so, you will
make use of the braking effect of the engine.
This relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly. If you need additional
braking, depress the brake pedal repeatedly
rather than continuously.
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
Rvariable
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. when driving with winter tyres
fitted (Y page 170)
TRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control or
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC
G WARNING
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the limit speed stored.
Only use variable SPEEDTRONIC if you will not
have to accelerate suddenly to a speed above
Driving systems
Rusing
the cruise control lever
Rby depressing the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown)
It is not possible to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC by braking.
The segments in the multifunction display
light up from the start of the scale up to the
stored speed.
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
Storing the current speed and calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
Only select a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and whether it is suitable for the
current driving and traffic situation. Otherwise, sudden braking could endanger you or
others.
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp : is on.
If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow ;.
LIM indicator lamp : in the cruise control
lever lights up. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
selected.
Storing the current speed
X
Setting a speed
X
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever
up : or down ;.
The current speed is stored and shown in
the multifunction display.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : past the pressure point for
Z
Driving and parking
that stored as the limit speed. You could otherwise cause an accident.
You can only exceed the limit speed stored if
you deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC:
169
Driving systems
170
a higher speed, or down ; for a lower
speed.
or
Keep the cruise control lever pressed
beyond the pressure point until the desired
speed is set. Press the cruise control lever
up : for a higher speed or down ; for a
lower speed.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : to the pressure point for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for
a higher speed or down ; for a lower
speed.
Driving and parking
X
Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC
G WARNING
It is not possible to deactivate variable Speedtronic by braking.
There are several ways to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
deactivated.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated automatically if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown), but
only if your current speed does not differ by
more than 20 km/h from the stored speed.
You will hear a warning tone if this is the case.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
160 km/h(e.g. for driving on winter tyres) and
the maximum speed (Y page 224).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC remains active,
even if variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated.
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed,
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
DISTRONIC PLUS
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid designed to
assist driving. The driver remains fully responsible for the vehicle's distance from other
vehicles, the vehicle's speed and for braking
in good time.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not react in particular
to:
Rpedestrians
Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stop-
ped or parked vehicles
and crossing traffic
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or vehicles driving on a different line. Therefore,
always pay attention to traffic conditions even
when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
Roncoming
G WARNING
General notes
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take account of road
and traffic conditions. If DISTRONIC does not
recognise or no longer recognises the vehicle
in front, do not activate DISTRONIC or, if it is
already active, deactivate it. This is especially
the case:
DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and
automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. DISTRONIC PLUS brakes automatically so that
the set speed is not exceeded.
On long and steep downhill gradients, you
must select shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good time.
By doing so, you will make use of the braking
effect of the engine. This relieves the load on
the brake system and prevents the brakes
from overheating and wearing too quickly.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a slower-moving
vehicle in front, your vehicle is braked in order
to maintain the preset distance to the vehicle
in front.
The radar sensor system is switched off automatically in the vicinity of radio telescope
facilities (Y page 368).
If you want DISTRONIC PLUS to assist you,
the radar sensor system must be activated
(Y page 225) and operational.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control in the speed range between
30 km/h and 200 km/h. If a vehicle is driving
in front of you, DISTRONIC operates in the
speed range between 0 km/h and
200 km/h.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS on roads with
steep gradients.
Rbefore
corners
filter lanes
Rwhen changing to a lane with faster moving
traffic
Rin complex driving situations or where lanes
are diverted, e.g. at roadworks on a motorway
DISTRONIC PLUS otherwise maintains the
current speed set by you or accelerates up to
the set speed.
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take account of
weather conditions. Deactivate, or do not
activate, DISTRONIC PLUS:
Ron
Rif
the roads are slippery, snow-covered or
icy. The wheels could lose their grip when
braking or accelerating. The vehicle could
start to skid.
Rif the sensors are dirty or there is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow, rain or fog. Distance control may be impaired.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions
even when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers
in time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle up to a
maximum of 4 m/s2 depending on its speed.
This corresponds to approximately 40% of
your vehicle's maximum braking power. You
must also apply the brakes yourself if this
braking power is not sufficient.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a risk of collision
with a vehicle in front, an intermittent warning
tone sounds. In addition, the · distance
warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights
up. Brake to avoid a collision.
Z
171
Driving and parking
Driving systems
172
Driving systems
Cruise control lever
Activation conditions
To activate DISTRONIC PLUS, the following
conditions must be fulfilled:
Driving and parking
Rthe engine must be running. It may take up
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To set the specified minimum distance
= LIM indicator lamp
? To store the current speed and call up the
last stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower
speed
B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and
variable SPEEDTRONIC
C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
to two minutes of driving before DISTRONIC PLUS is ready for use.
Rthe parking brake must be released.
RESP® must be switched on, but not intervening.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe bonnet must be closed.
Rthe driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front-passenger door and the rear
doors must be closed.
Rthe vehicle must not be skidding.
Activating while driving
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: DISTRONIC PLUS
is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
Activating DISTRONIC PLUS
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The vehicle can be braked when DISTRONIC
PLUS is activated. For this reason, deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle is to be set in
motion by other means (e.g. in a car wash or
by towing).
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ;, or press it up : or down =.
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed
up : or down = until the desired speed
is set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
X
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you
can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle in front has been detected and is shown
in the multifunction display. If the vehicle in
front is no longer detected and displayed,
DISTRONIC PLUS switches off and you will
hear a tone.
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS suspended
message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower-moving
vehicle in front will then not be maintained.
You will be driving at the speed you determine by the position of the accelerator
pedal.
Activating when driving towards a stationary vehicle
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ;, or press it up : or down =.
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
X
Press the cruise control lever repeatedly
up : or down = until the desired speed
is set.
If the vehicle in front of you is stationary, you
can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS once your
vehicle is stationary as well.
i DISTRONIC PLUS can only be activated at
under 30 km/h if a vehicle in front has been
detected. Therefore, the DISTRONIC PLUS
distance display in the instrument cluster
should be activated (Y page 219).
i You can use the cruise control lever to set
the stored speed and the control on the
cruise control lever to set the specified
minimum distance (Y page 176).
Pulling away and driving
G WARNING
If you depress the brake, DISTRONIC PLUS is
deactivated unless your vehicle is stationary.
DISTRONIC PLUS then no longer brakes your
vehicle. In such cases, control the distance
from vehicles travelling in front with the brake
alone. You could otherwise cause an accident
and thereby injure yourself and others. The
driver remains fully responsible for the vehicle's distance from other vehicles, the speed
being driven and for braking in good time.
X
If the vehicle in front pulls away: remove
your foot from the brake pedal.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ;, or press it up : or down =.
or
X
Accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its
speed to that of the vehicle in front.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle
in front has slowed down, it brakes your vehicle. In this way, the distance you have selected is maintained.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle
in front is driving faster, it accelerates your
vehicle, but only up to the speed you have
stored.
Changing lanes
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS and Active Blind Spot Assist
are only an aid designed to assist driving.
They do not relieve you of the responsibility
of paying attention. The driver remains fully
responsible for the vehicle's distance from
other vehicles, the vehicle's speed and for
braking in good time. Always pay attention to
traffic conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
If you change to the overtaking lane, DISTRONIC PLUS supports you if:
Ryou
are driving faster than 60 km/h.
PLUS is maintaining the distance to a vehicle in front.
Ryou switch on the respective turn signals.
RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger
of collision.
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is
accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted
if changing lanes takes too long or if the disRDISTRONIC
Z
173
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
174
Driving systems
tance between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front becomes too small.
Afterwards, the vehicle accelerates back to
the set speed you specified.
i When changing lanes, DISTRONIC PLUS
Stopping
monitors the left lane for left-hand-drive
vehicles and the right lane for right-handdrive vehicles.
Vehicles with COMAND Online
i The following function is not operational
in all countries.
DISTRONIC PLUS uses additional information
from your navigation system so that it can
react appropriately to certain traffic situations. This is the case if, while following a
vehicle, DISTRONIC PLUS is active and you:
Rapproach
or drive around a roundabout
Rapproach a T-junction
Rturn off at a motorway exit
Even if the vehicle in front leaves the detection range, DISTRONIC PLUS temporarily
maintains the current driving speed and does
not accelerate. This is based on the current
map data in the navigation system.
Example: roundabout
The current speed is maintained:
Rapproximately
ten seconds before the
roundabout/T-junction and for approximately 1.5seconds when driving on the
roundabout
Rapproximately twelve seconds before
reaching a motorway exit and approximately four seconds after the motorway
exit
G WARNING
Never get out of the vehicle when DISTRONIC
PLUS is activated.
DISTRONIC PLUS must also never be operated, activated or deactivated by a passenger
or from outside the vehicle.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not replace the parking brake and must not be used for parking.
The DISTRONIC PLUS braking effect is cancelled and the vehicle can start moving if:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS is deactivated using the
cruise control lever.
Ryou accelerate.
Rthere is a malfunction in the system or an
interruption in the power supply, e.g. battery failure.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
If you wish to leave the vehicle or park it,
deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the
vehicle against rolling away.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle
in front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until
it is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains
stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake.
i Depending on the specified minimum dis-
tance, your vehicle will come to a standstill
at a sufficient distance behind the vehicle
in front. The specified minimum distance is
set using the control on the cruise control
lever.
Driving systems
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened.
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe bonnet is opened.
Ra system fault occurs.
Rthe power supply is not sufficient.
i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC PLUS
adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Rthe
Setting a speed
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS
is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the new speed stored.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 km/h increments: briefly press the cruise control
lever up : or down ; to the pressure
point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 1 km/h increments.
X To adjust the set speed in 10 km/h
increments: briefly press the cruise control lever up : or down ; beyond the
pressure point.
The last stored speed increases or decreases in 10 km/h increments.
Storing the current speed or calling up
the stored speed
G WARNING
Only call up a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and if it is suitable for the current
traffic and driving situation. You can otherwise endanger yourself or others by unintentionally triggering sudden acceleration or
braking.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you :.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. The first
time it is activated, the current speed is
stored. Otherwise, it sets the vehicle cruise
speed to the previously stored value.
X
Z
Driving and parking
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, the
transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
175
176
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance
for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span
between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that
DISTRONIC PLUS keeps to the vehicle in
front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can
see this distance in the multifunction display
(Y page 176).
X To increase: turn control = in direction ;.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control = in direction :.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
i Make sure that you maintain a sufficient
and safe distance from the vehicle in front.
Adjust the distance to the vehicle in front if
necessary.
Displaying DISTRONIC PLUS in the
speedometer
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, one or
two segments ; in the set speed range light
up.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed
in the speedometer may differ slightly from
the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front,
segments ; between speed of the vehicle in
front : and stored speed = light up.
Displaying DISTRONIC PLUS in the multifunction display
General notes
In the Assistance menu (Y page 219) of the
on-board computer, you can select the distance display.
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
: Symbol for activated PRE-SAFE® Brake
; Vehicle in front, if detected
Driving systems
the vehicle in front
? Specified minimum distance to the vehicle in front; adjustable
A Own vehicle
X
Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS
Select the Distance display function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 219).
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
There are several ways to deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
or
X
: DISTRONIC PLUS activated
; Own vehicle
= Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
? Vehicle in front, if detected
You will see the stored speed for about five
seconds when you activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
X Select the Distance display function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 219).
i You will see the stored speed for about
five seconds when you activate DISTRONIC
PLUS.
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
When you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, you
will see the DISTRONIC PLUS off message
in the multifunction display for approximately
five seconds.
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine.
DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
engage the parking brake.
are driving slower than 25 km/h and
there is no vehicle in front, or if the vehicle
in front is no longer detected.
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®.
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position.
Rthe vehicle is near a radio telescope facility
(Y page 368).
Ryou switch off the radar sensor system
(Y page 225).
Ryou
Z
Driving and parking
= Distance indicator: current distance to
177
178
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Ryou
pull the cruise control lever towards
you in order to pull away, and the frontpassenger door or one of the rear doors is
open.
Rthe vehicle has skidded.
If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will
hear a warning tone. You will see the DIS‐
TRONIC PLUS off message in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds.
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles
travelling on a different line. The distance to
the vehicle in front will be too short.
Other vehicles changing lane
Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
The following contains descriptions of certain
road and traffic conditions in which you must
be particularly attentive. In such situations,
brake if necessary. DISTRONIC PLUS is then
deactivated.
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle cutting in. The distance to this vehicle
will be too short.
Cornering, going into and coming out of a
bend
Narrow vehicles
The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle
may brake unexpectedly or late.
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway, because of its narrow width. The distance to the vehicle in front will be too short.
Vehicles travelling on a different line
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function is deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
Activation conditions
You can activate the HOLD function if:
Rthe
vehicle is stationary.
engine is running or it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe driver's door is closed or your seat belt
is fastened.
Rthe parking brake is released.
Rthe bonnet is closed.
Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N.
RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
Rthe
DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals
an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS will not brake for these.
Crossing vehicles
Activating the HOLD function
G WARNING
The vehicle's brakes are applied when the
HOLD function is activated. For this reason,
deactivate the HOLD function if the vehicle is
to be set in motion by other means (e.g. in a
car wash or by towing).
DISTRONIC PLUS may mistakenly detect
vehicles that are crossing your lane. Activating DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with
crossing traffic, for example, could cause
your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.
HOLD function
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until ë appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
Rwhen
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
Z
179
Driving and parking
Driving systems
180
Driving systems
Deactivating the HOLD function
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Never get out of the vehicle when the HOLD
function is activated.
The HOLD function must never be operated
or deactivated by a passenger or from outside
the vehicle.
The HOLD function does not replace the parking brake and must not be used for parking.
The braking effect of the HOLD function is
cancelled and the vehicle could roll away if:
Rthe
HOLD function is deactivated by
depressing the accelerator pedal or the
brake pedal.
Rthere is a malfunction in the system or an
interruption in the power supply, e.g. battery failure.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
If you leave the vehicle or park it, deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
Ra
system fault occurs.
power supply is not sufficient.
Rthe
RACE START
Important safety notes
G WARNING
RACE START is only available when SPORT
handling mode is activated. SPORT handling
mode will only be able to stabilise the vehicle
to a limited degree if the vehicle starts to skid
or a wheel starts to spin. The vehicle is therefore harder to control at the threshold range.
You could lose control of the vehicle and
cause an accident.
RACE START should only be used on closed
off circuits. Always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
i RACE START is only available in AMG vehicles.
RACE START enables optimum acceleration
from a standing start. The precondition for
this is a suitable high-grip road surface.
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Activation conditions
Ryou
You can activate RACE START if:
accelerate and the transmission is in
position D or R.
Ryou shift the transmission to position P.
Ryou depress the brake pedal again with a
certain amount of pressure until ë disappears from the multifunction display.
Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
When the HOLD function is activated, the
transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened.
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe bonnet is opened.
Rthe
doors are closed.
Rthe engine is running and it has reached an
operating temperature of approximately
80 †. This is the case when the engine oil
temperature in the multifunction display
stops flashing.
RSPORT handling mode is activated
(Y page 66).
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position.
Rthe vehicle is stationary and the brake
pedal is depressed (left foot).
Rthe transmission is in position D.
Activating RACE START
Depress the brake pedal with your left foot
and keep it depressed.
X Turn the drive program selector clockwise
(Y page 151) until the RS lamp lights up.
The RACE START Confirm: Paddle UP
Cancel: Paddle DOWN message appears
in the multifunction display.
i If the activation conditions are no longer
fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The
RACE START cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 152).
Drive program S+ is activated. SPORT handling mode remains activated.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if
you release the accelerator pedal during
RACE START or if any of the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled. The RACE START
not possible See Owner's Manual message appears in the multifunction display.
i After using it several times in short succession, RACE START will be unavailable
until a certain distance has been driven.
AIRMATIC
or
Vehicle level
To confirm: pull the right steering wheel
shift paddle (Y page 152).
The RACE START available Depress
accelerator message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not depress the accelerator
pedal fully within two seconds, RACE
START is cancelled. The RACE START not
possible See Owner's Manual message
appears in the multifunction display.
Important safety notes
Fully depress the accelerator pedal.
The engine speed rises to approximately
3500 rpm.
The RACE START Release brake to
start message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not release the brake pedal
within five seconds, RACE START is cancelled. The RACE START cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
! The vehicle is lowered by about 15 mm if:
X
X
X
Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
The RACE START active message appears
in the multifunction display.
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
G WARNING
If you have selected "Comfort tuning", the
vehicle will be lowered if you lock it within
60 seconds of the engine being switched off.
Make sure, therefore, that nobody is in the
vicinity of the wheel housing or under the
vehicle when you lock the vehicle. Otherwise,
limbs could become trapped.
Ryou
have selected "Comfort tuning"
switch off the engine and
Ryou lock the vehicle within approximately
60 seconds
When parking, position your vehicle so that
it does not make contact with the kerb as
the vehicle is lowered. Your vehicle could
otherwise be damaged.
Ryou
Your vehicle regulates its height automatically. All-round level control ensures the best
possible suspension and constant ground
clearance, even with a laden vehicle. When
you drive fast, the vehicle is lowered automatically to improve driving safety and to
reduce fuel consumption.
Z
181
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
182
The following vehicle levels are possible:
If indicator lamp ; is not lit:
Rnormal
X
Driving and parking
Rraised:
the vehicle is raised by about
25 mm when compared with the normal
level.
Rlowered: the vehicle is lowered by about
10 mm when compared with the normal
level.
The "Normal" and "Raised" vehicle levels can
be set manually.
The "Lowered" vehicle level is set automatically:
Rat
speeds above 140 km/h
you have selected "Comfort tuning"
(Y page 182) and then lock the vehicle
within 60 seconds of the engine being
switched off
Rif you have selected "Sports tuning"
(Y page 182)
Rif
Setting the vehicle level
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel housing or under the vehicle while lowering the vehicle when it is stationary. Otherwise, limbs could become trapped.
Select the "Normal" setting for normal road
surfaces and "Raised" for driving with snow
chains or on particularly poor road surfaces.
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
Setting raised level
X
Start the engine.
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. The vehicle
height is adjusted to raised level.
The Vehicle rising message appears in
the display.
The "Raised level" setting is cancelled if you:
Rdrive
at a speed over approximately
120 km/h
Rdrive for approximately three minutes at a
speed over 80 km/h.
The "Raised Level" remains saved when you
are not driving within these speed ranges.
Setting the normal level
X Start the engine.
If indicator lamp ; is lit:
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; goes out. The vehicle is
adjusted to normal level.
Suspension tuning
General notes
The electronically controlled damping system
works continuously. This improves driving
safety and ride comfort.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour
driving style, e.g. sporty
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection, i.e. sports or comfort
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
Rthe
Driving systems
Vehicle level
The vehicle automatically sets the vehicle
level at the rear axle. Rear axle level control
ensures the best possible suspension and
that the ground clearance remains constant
even when the vehicle is loaded. This
improves driving safety and fuel consumption.
Suspension tuning
The firmer suspension tuning in Sport mode
ensures even better contact with the road.
Select this mode when employing a sporty
driving style, e.g. on winding country roads.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected "Sports tuning".
The AIRMATIC SPORT message appears in
the multifunction display.
Comfort tuning
In comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Therefore, select this mode if you prefer a more
comfortable driving style. Select comfort
mode also when driving fast on straight roads,
e.g. on straight stretches of motorway.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp = lights up. You have selected "Comfort tuning".
The AIRMATIC COMFORT message appears
in the multifunction display.
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension
General notes
i AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension
is available for the CLS 63 AMG model.
General notes
The electronically controlled damping system
works continuously. This improves driving
safety and ride comfort.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour
driving style, e.g. sporty
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection of Sport, Sport +
or Comfort
If you select Sport or Sport + mode and
restart the engine, the suspension setting
reverts to Comfort mode.
Rthe
Sport mode
: Mode selector button
; Button for storing, calling up and display-
ing the selected mode
= Sport + mode indicator lamp
? Sport mode indicator lamp
The firmer suspension tuning in Sport mode
ensures even better contact with the road.
Z
Driving and parking
Sports tuning
183
Driving systems
Driving and parking
184
Select this mode when employing a sporty
driving style, e.g. on winding country roads.
X Press button : once.
Indicator lamp ? lights up. You have selected Sport mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
Sport + mode
The very firm setting of the suspension tuning
in Sport + mode ensures the best possible
contact with the road. Select this mode only
when driving on race circuits.
If indicator lamps = and ? are off:
X
Press button : twice.
Indicator lamps = and ? light up. You
have selected Sport + mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT + message
appears in the multifunction display.
If indicator lamp ? lights up:
X
Press button : once.
Second indicator lamp = lights up. You
have selected Sport + mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT + message
appears in the multifunction display.
Comfort mode
In comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Therefore, select this mode if you prefer a more
comfortable driving style. Select comfort
mode also when driving fast on straight roads,
e.g. on straight stretches of motorway.
X Press button : repeatedly until indicator
lamps = and ? go out.
You have selected Comfort mode.
The AMG Ride Control COMFORT message appears in the multifunction display.
Storing and calling up settings
Once the suspension tuning and drive program have been selected, you can store and
call up your settings using AMG button ;.
X
To store: press AMG button ; until you
hear a tone.
X
To call up: press AMG button ;.
The stored suspension tuning and drive
program are selected.
X
To display: briefly press AMG button ;.
Your selection appears in the multifunction
display.
4MATIC (permanent all-wheel drive)
G WARNING
4MATIC cannot reduce the risk of an accident
if you drive too fast.
If a drive wheel spins due to insufficient grip:
Ronly depress the accelerator pedal as far as
necessary when pulling away.
Raccelerate less when driving.
Radapt your driving style to suit road and
traffic conditions.
! Never tow the vehicle with one axle
raised. This may damage the transfer case.
Damage of this sort is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty. All
wheels must remain either on the ground
or be fully raised. Observe the instructions
for towing the vehicle with all wheels in full
contact with the ground.
i In wintry driving conditions, the maximum
effect of 4MATIC can only be achieved if
you use winter tyres (M+S tyres), with snow
chains if necessary.
4MATIC ensures that all four wheels are permanently driven. Together with ESP®, it
improves the traction of your vehicle whenever a drive wheel spins due to insufficient
grip.
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
G WARNING
PARKTRONIC is only an aid and may not
detect all obstacles. It is not a substitute for
attentive driving.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. You could otherwise endanger
yourself and others.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill, could cause PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
G WARNING
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically if
you:
: Example: sensors in the front bumper,
left-hand side
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush. Otherwise, they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 304).
Rswitch
on the ignition
the transmission to position D, R or N
Rrelease the parking brake
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
PARKTRONIC monitors the area around your
vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper
and four sensors in the rear bumper.
Rshift
Range of the sensors
Example: side view
General notes
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when
they are in the immediate vicinity of the
vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or
the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and
objects which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Z
185
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving and parking
186
Driving systems
Example: top view
Front sensors
Centre
Approx. 100 cm
Corners
Approx. 60 cm
Rear sensors
Centre
Approx. 120 cm
Corners
Approx. 80 cm
Minimum distance
Centre
Approx. 20 cm
Corners
Approx. 15 cm
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now
reached the minimum distance.
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
Warning displays
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the centre air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the roof lining in the rear compartment.
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow
segments showing operational readiness =
light up.
: Indicator lamp
; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated. Active Park Assist is then also
deactivated.
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Driving systems
187
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approximately 20 seconds,
and the indicator lamp
in the PARKTRONIC
button lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 304).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approxThe problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
imately 20seconds.
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Active Parking Assist is merely an aid and may
sometimes recommend parking spaces that
are not suitable for parking. For example,
these might be spaces where parking is prohibited, driveways, unsuitable surfaces, etc.
Active Parking Assist measures the parking
space as you drive past it. Any later changes
to the parking space are not taken into
account. For instance, this may be the case
when the vehicle parked in front of or behind
the space changes its position or when an
obstacle is moved into the parking space.
Active Parking Assist does not relieve you of
the responsibility of paying attention. If you
rely solely on Active Parking Assist, you could
cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring.
G WARNING
Objects located above the height range of
Active Parking Assist will not be detected
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking
procedure is calculated, e. g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles. In some circumstances, Active Parking Assist may therefore guide you into the
parking space too early. This may lead to a
collision. For this reason, you should avoid
using Active Parking Assist in such situations.
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
188
Driving systems
Driving and parking
G WARNING
The front of the vehicle will veer out in the
direction of the oncoming traffic during the
parking operation. In some cases the vehicle
will also take you onto sections of the oncoming lane during the parking procedure.
You are responsible for safety at all times and
must pay attention to any road users
approaching or passing. Stop the vehicle if
necessary or cancel the Active Parking Assist
parking procedure.
G WARNING
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at
a sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tyres.
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. Ultrasound is used to
measure the road on both sides of the vehicle.
A suitable parking space is indicated by the
parking symbol. Active steering intervention
can assist you during parking. You may also
use PARKTRONIC (Y page 185). When PARKTRONIC is switched off, Active Parking Assist
is also unavailable.
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are on straight roads, not bends
Rthat are on the same level as the road, e.g.
not on the pavement
Parking tips:
Rthat
Ron
narrow roads, drive as closely as possible past the parking space.
Rparking spaces that are littered, overgrown
or partially occupied by trailer drawbars
might be identified incorrectly or not at all.
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
Rpay
attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 186) warning messages during the
parking procedure.
Rat any time, you can intervene in the steering procedure to correct it. Active Parking
Assist will then be cancelled.
Rwhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use
Active Parking Assist.
Rwhen snow chains or an emergency spare
wheel are fitted, you should not use Active
Parking Assist here either.
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
Rthe way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
location. It may be the case that Active
Parking Assist guides you too far into a
parking space, or not far enough into it. In
some cases, it may also lead you across or
onto the kerb. If necessary, you should cancel the parking procedure with Active Parking Assist.
Ryou can also engage forward gear prematurely. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space. Should
a gear be changed too early to achieve a
sensible parking position, the parking procedure will be cancelled.
Driving systems
Detecting parking spaces
189
Parking
Example: detected parking space
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Active Parking Assist is switched on automatically when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle. When
driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you will see
the parking symbol as a status indicator in the
instrument cluster. Active Parking Assist only
displays parking spaces on the frontpassenger side as standard. Parking spaces
on the driver's side are displayed as soon as
the turn signal on the driver's side is activated. To park on the driver's side, you must
leave the driver's side turn signal switched
on. This must remain switched on until you
acknowledge the use of Active Parking Assist
by pressing the a button on the multifunction steering wheel.
When a parking space has been detected, an
arrow towards the right or the left also
appears.
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are at least 1.3 m longer than your
vehicle
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m away from it.
Rthat
PARKTRONIC and Active Parking Assist are
merely parking aids and may not detect all
obstacles. They do not relieve you of the
responsibility of paying attention.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. You could, otherwise, endanger
yourself and others.
G WARNING
When parking, you need to make sure that no
obstacles are located in the vicinity of the
vehicle during the entire operation. Active
Parking Assist does not relieve you of the
responsibility of paying attention. It merely
aids you by intervening actively in the steering.
To stop the vehicle or avoid an accident you
need to apply the brakes yourself.
Stop the vehicle when the parking space
symbol shows the desired parking space in
the instrument cluster.
X Shift the transmission to position R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the
% button on the multifunction steering
wheel or pull away.
or
X To park using Active Parking Assist:
press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
X
Release the multifunction steering wheel.
Reverse the vehicle, being ready to brake
at all times. When reversing, drive at a
speed below 10 km/h. Otherwise, Active
Parking Assist will be cancelled.
Z
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Driving systems
190
i In tight parking spaces, you will achieve
X
Driving and parking
the best parking results by backing up as
far as possible. When doing so, also
observe the PARKTRONIC messages.
X
Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
The Park Assist active Select D
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Shift the transmission to position D while
the vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
The Park Assist active Select R
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
Further transmission shifts may be necessary.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the Park Assist switched off message appears in the multifunction display.
PARKTRONIC continues to be available.
X Manoeuvre if necessary.
X Always observe the warning messages displayed by PARKTRONIC (Y page 186).
Cancelling Active Parking Assist
You can cancel Active Parking Assist at any
time.
Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled at
once. The Park Assist cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X
Press the PARKTRONIC button on the
centre console (Y page 186).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active
Parking Assist is immediately cancelled.
The Park Assist cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is cancelled automatically if:
Rthe
transmission is shifted too early.
using Active Parking Assist is no
longer possible.
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h.
Ra wheel spins and ESP® intervenes or fails.
The ä warning lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol
disappears and the multifunction display
shows the Park Assist cancelled message.
When Active Parking Assist is cancelled, you
must steer again yourself.
Rparking
Reversing camera
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
Driving systems
General notes
Rat
191
night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Reversing camera : is an optical parking aid.
It shows the area behind your vehicle in the
COMAND display.
Reversing camera : is located in the handle
strip of the tailgate.
View through the camera
G WARNING
The reversing camera is only an aid and may
display obstacles in a distorted or incorrect
manner, or may not even display them at all.
The reversing camera does not relieve you of
the responsibility to pay attention. The camera cannot show objects:
Rvery near to the rear bumper
Rbelow the rear bumper
Rthat are located above the tailgate handle
recess
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. This applies to the areas
behind, in front of and next to the vehicle. You
could otherwise endanger yourself and others.
G WARNING
Under the following circumstances, the
reversing camera will not function, or will
function in a limited manner:
Rif
Rin
the tailgate is open
heavy rain, snow or fog
the area is lit by fluorescent light or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in
winter
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
event, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose.
Do not use the reversing camera in these
types of situation. You could otherwise injure
others or damage objects and your vehicle
while you are parking.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
Activating the reversing camera
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the "Reversing camera"
function is selected in COMAND APS (see
the separate operating instructions for
COMAND APS).
X Engage reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown with
guide lines in the COMAND display.
X
Guide lines in the COMAND display
G WARNING
Using the reversing camera can be dangerous
if you are colour blind or your ability to distinguish colours is impaired.
Only use the reversing camera if you can see
and distinguish between all the coloured
guide lines that are displayed by the reversing
camera in the COMAND display.
Z
Driving and parking
Rif
192
Driving systems
G WARNING
Driving and parking
Please note that objects not at ground level
may appear to be further away than they
actually are. These include:
Rthe
bumper of a vehicle that is parked
behind your vehicle
Ra trailer drawbar
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe tail-end of a lorry
Rslanted posts
The lines are only guides, not accurate measurements of the distance to an obstacle.
Therefore, you should never pass the red line
when approaching an obstacle. You could otherwise cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
ATTENTION ASSIST
Important safety notes
G WARNING
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid and may
detect your tiredness or lapses in concentration too late or not at all. It is not a substitute
for a well rested and attentive driver.
Fatigue may cause you to recognise hazardous situations too late, misjudge a situation
or react slower. For this reason, make sure
you feel rested before you begin driving and
during your journey. Always take breaks in
good time and regularly, especially during
long journeys. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in time, cause an accident and
injure yourself and others.
General notes
Information in the COMAND display (example)
Guide lines ; and = show the approximate
distance to the rear area. Yellow guide
line ; approximately 1.0 m and red guide
line = approximately 0.25 m. The distances
only apply to objects that are at ground level.
Blue guide lines : depict the width required
for the vehicle. They are used to align the
vehicle with the edge of the carriageway, e.g.
the kerb.
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 80 km/h
to 180 km/h range.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
ATTENTION ASSIST assesses your level of
fatigue or lapses in concentration by taking
the following criteria into account:
Ryour
personal driving style, e.g. steering
characteristics
Rjourney-related parameters, e.g. time of
day, length of journey
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
Rif
the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
Rif you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Driving systems
you are predominantly driving slower
than 80 km/h or faster than 180 km/h
Rif you are currently using COMAND APS or
making a telephone call with COMAND APS
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
Warning and display messages in the
multifunction display
If ATTENTION ASSIST is active, you will be
warned no sooner than 20 minutes after your
journey has begun. You then hear an intermittent warning tone twice and the Atten‐
tion Assist: Drowsiness detected message appears in the multifunction display.
X Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 220).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Press the a button to confirm the message.
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest properly. If you
do not take a break, you will be warned again
after 15 minutes at the earliest. This will only
happen if ATTENTION ASSIST still detects
typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration.
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset and starts
assessing your tiredness again when you continue your journey if:
Ryou
switch off the engine.
take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break.
Ryou
Speed Limit Assist
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Speed Limit Assist is only an aid and may
detect speed limit signs incorrectly or not at
all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun or from
oncoming traffic.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Rthe traffic signs are covered, for instance
by dirt, snow or trees.
Rthe traffic signs are poorly illuminated.
Rthere are ambiguous traffic signs, for
instance near roadworks or on multi-lane
roads.
Traffic signs always have priority over the
Speed Limit Assist display. Speed Limit Assist
cannot detect road and traffic conditions. It is
not a substitute for attentive driving.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
: Speed Limit Assist camera
Speed Limit Assist shows you detected speed
limits in the multifunction display. Data from
Z
Driving and parking
Rif
193
Driving systems
Driving and parking
194
the navigation system is also used for this
purpose. If a traffic sign indicating a speed
limit or the end of a speed limit is detected,
it is shown in the multifunction display. If
Speed Limit Assist does not detect any traffic
signs, the speed limit from the digital road
map is taken and shown in the display.
Speed Limit Assist detects the traffic signs
with a camera attached behind the top of the
windscreen.
Information in the multifunction display
Permanently showing detected traffic
signs in the multifunction display
X
Display Speed Limit Assist using the onboard computer (Y page 218).
A traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit : appears in the multifunction display as soon as it is detected.
Traffic sign indicating a speed limit : is
generally displayed until:
Ra
traffic sign indicating the end of the
speed limit is detected.
Ryou make a turn.
Ryou leave or enter a town.
Rthe road type changes (e.g. motorway,
country road).
Ryou have travelled a certain minimum
distance without the traffic sign being
repeated or detected again.
i You can also activate Speed Limit Assist
: Traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit (example)
using COMAND APS. The maximum permissible speed is then shown in the
COMAND display; see the COMAND APS
operating instructions.
; Speed Limit Assist is available and the
warning function is switched on in the onboard computer
= Units used in the traffic sign displayed
Briefly showing detected traffic signs in
the multifunction display
X
Activate the Speed Limit Assist warning
function using the on-board computer
(Y page 218).
Symbol ; appears.
A traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit : appears in the multifunction display for around five seconds
as soon as it is detected. Any other information in the multifunction display is hidden for this period.
Night View Assist Plus
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Night View Assist Plus is only an aid designed
to assist driving and does not relieve you of
the responsibility to pay attention. Continue
to look through the windscreen instead of
relying on the Night View Assist Plus display.
You are responsible for safety and must drive
in accordance with traffic conditions. You
could otherwise endanger yourself and others.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
main-beam headlamps due to oncoming traffic.
Rthere
i Infrared light is not visible to the human
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Ron bends, on uphill gradients or downhill
gradients.
G WARNING
Night View Assist Plus does not detect
objects in the immediate vicinity of the vehicle. Look through the windscreen when
manoeuvring. Make sure that there are no
people or animals in the area in which you are
manoeuvring.
eye and therefore does not dazzle. Night
View Assist Plus can therefore remain
switched on even if there is oncoming traffic.
Activating Night View Assist Plus
Activation conditions
You can only activate Night View Assist Plus
if:
Rthe
key is in position 2 in the ignition lock.
is dark.
Rthe light switch is in the à or L position.
Rreverse gear has not been engaged.
Rit
Activating Night View Assist Plus
In addition to the illumination provided by the
normal headlamps, Night View Assist Plus
uses infrared light to illuminate the road.
Night View Assist Plus camera : picks up
the infrared light and displays a monochrome
image in COMAND. The image displayed in
COMAND corresponds to a road lit up by
main-beam headlamps. This enables you to
see the road's course and any obstacles in
good time. When pedestrian recognition is
active, pedestrians recognised by the system
are highlighted in the Night View Assist Plus
display.
Light from the headlamps of oncoming vehicles does not affect the Night View Assist Plus
display in the multifunction display. This is
also the case if you cannot switch on the
Make sure that COMAND APS is switched
on.
X Press button :.
The Night View Assist Plus display appears
in the COMAND display.
X
You can read about how to adjust the brightness of the COMAND display in the COMAND
APS operating instructions.
i The infrared headlamps only switch on
when the vehicle is being driven at speeds
of at least 10 km/h. This means that you
do not have the full visual range while stationary and cannot check whether Night
View Assist Plus is working.
Z
195
Driving and parking
Driving systems
196
Driving systems
Pedestrian recognition
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Pedestrian recognition may be impaired or
inoperative if:
Rpedestrians
are partially or entirely
obscured by objects, e.g. by parked vehicles.
Rthe silhouette of the pedestrian in the Night
View Assist Plus display is incomplete or
interrupted, e.g. by powerful light reflections.
Rpedestrians do not contrast with the surroundings.
Rpedestrians are not in an upright position,
e.g. sitting, squatting or lying.
: Night View Assist Plus display
; Pedestrian recognised
= Framing
? Symbol for active pedestrian recognition
i Animals are not recognised by pedestrian
recognition.
Night View Assist Plus can recognise pedestrians using typical characteristics, e.g. when
there is a silhouette in the shape of a person.
Pedestrian recognition is then switched on
automatically if:
RNight
View Assist Plus is activated.
Ryou are driving faster than about 10
km/h.
surroundings are dark, e.g. when driving outside built-up areas without street
lighting.
Rthe
If pedestrian recognition is active, symbol ? appears. If a pedestrian is now recognised, they are framed = and thereby highlighted. If the pedestrian recognition system
has brought a pedestrian to your attention,
look through the windscreen to evaluate the
situation. The actual distance to objects and
pedestrians cannot be gauged accurately by
looking at a screen.
It may be the case that objects are highlighted
as well as pedestrians.
Misted up or dirty windscreen
If the windscreen in front of the camera is
misted up or dirty on the inside or outside, the
Night View Assist Plus display is affected.
X To demist: check the automatic air conditioning settings (Y page 130) and fold down
the camera cover (Y page 305).
X To demist the inside of the windscreen: fold down the camera cover
(Y page 305) and clean the windscreen
(Y page 304).
Driving systems
197
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The picture quality of
Night View Assist Plus
has deteriorated.
The windscreen wipers are smearing the windscreen.
X Replace the wiper blades (Y page 121).
The windscreen is smeared after the vehicle has been cleaned in
a car wash.
X Clean the windscreen (Y page 304).
There is windscreen chip damage in the camera's field of vision.
X Replace the windscreen.
The windscreen is misted up on the inside.
X Demist the windscreen (Y page 130).
The windscreen is iced up.
X De-ice the windscreen (Y page 130).
There is dirt on the inside of the windscreen.
X Clean the inside of the windscreen (Y page 304).
Lane Tracking package
General notes
The Lane Tracking package consists of Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 197) and Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 199).
Blind Spot Assist
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid designed to
assist driving. It may fail to detect some vehicles and is no substitute for attentive driving.
Blind Spot Assist cannot detect road and traffic conditions. It may fail to detect narrow
vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles, or
only detect them too late.
Monitoring may be affected by dirty sensors,
strong spray or poor visibility caused by snow,
rain or mist, for example. In this case, vehicles
are detected late or not at all.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
General notes
Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor system
to monitor the areas on both sides of your
vehicle. It supports you from speeds of
30 km/h. A warning display in the exterior
mirrors draws your attention to vehicles
detected in the monitored area. If you then
switch on the corresponding turn signal to
change lane, you will also receive an optical
and audible collision warning. For monitoring,
Active Blind Spot Assist uses sensors in the
rear bumper.
For Blind Spot Assist to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system must be activated (Y page 225) and operational.
The radar sensor system is automatically
deactivated near radio telescope facilities
(Y page 368).
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with Night View Assist Plus
198
Driving systems
Monitoring range of the sensors
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist monitors certain areas in the
immediate vicinity of your vehicle. Vehicles
that approach and drive past at high speeds
are not detected. There is no display and no
warning.
If the lanes are very wide, it may not be possible to monitor the complete width of the
neighbouring lane. For this reason, vehicles in
the next lane may not be detected, especially
if they are driving in a staggered formation in
different lanes. This may be the case if vehicles are driving at the edge of their lane that
is furthest away from your vehicle.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders.
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside long vehicles, for example lorries, for a prolonged time.
The two radar sensors for Blind Spot Assist
are integrated into the sides of the rear
bumper. Make sure that the bumper is free of
dirt, ice or slush in the vicinity of the sensors.
The sensors must not be covered, for example by cycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a severe impact or in the event of damage to the bumpers, have the function of the
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. Blind Spot Assist may otherwise
not work properly.
Indicator and warning display
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
30 km/h. The indicator lamps in the exterior
mirrors are yellow. Vehicles in the monitoring
range are then not indicated.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to
3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next to
your vehicle, as shown in the diagram.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may
be the case if there are vehicles at the edge
of their lane nearest your vehicle.
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
If Blind Spot Assist is switched on, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds
above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out
and Blind Spot Assist is operational.
Driving systems
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the monitoring range
of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the
corresponding turn signal, a double warning
tone sounds. Red warning lamp : flashes. If
the turn signal remains on, detected vehicles
are indicated by the flashing of red warning
lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Switching on Blind Spot Assist
X Make sure that the radar sensor system
(Y page 225) and Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 220) are activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately
1.5 seconds and then turn yellow.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun, or reflection from other vehicles.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera
Rseveral or no lane markings for a single lane
are present.
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected.
Rthe lane markings on the road are unclear,
e.g. near roadworks.
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge.
Rthe road is narrow and winding.
Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect road and
traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for
attentive driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed, braking in good time, and
steering correctly. Always adapt your driving
style to suit the prevailing road and weather
conditions. Always pay attention to traffic
conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise,
you may fail to recognise dangers in time,
cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
Lane Keeping Assist
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist does not keep your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid and may detect
the lane markings on the road incorrectly or
not at all.
Z
Driving and parking
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning
always occurs when a vehicle enters the blind
spot monitoring range from behind or from
the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the
warning only occurs if the difference in speed
is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Blind Spot Assist is then
deactivated.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
199
Driving systems
200
Driving and parking
General notes
shown in green. Lane Keeping Assist is
ready for use.
Standard
If Standard is selected, no warning vibration
occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of a camera : at the top of the windscreen. Lane
Keeping Assist detects lane markings on the
road and warns you before you leave your
lane unintentionally.
If you have selected km as the display unit in
the Display unit Speed-/odome‐
ter(Y page 221) function in the on-board
computer, Lane Keeping Assist assists you at
speeds above 60 km/h. If miles is selected
as the display unit, the assistance range
starts at 40 mph.
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you
by means of intermittent vibration in the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
Activating Lane Keeping Assist
Adaptive
If Adaptive is selected, no warning vibration
occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Ryou brake hard.
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
X
Switch on Active Lane Keeping Assist using
the on-board computer; to do so, select
Standard or Adaptive(Y page 220).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, symbol : is
Rthe
Ryou
road has narrow lanes.
cut the corner on a bend.
Active Driving Assistance package
General notes
The Active Driving Assistance package consists of DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 170), Active
Blind Spot Assist (Y page 201) and Active
Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 204).
Active Blind Spot Assist
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid and may
detect vehicles/obstacles incorrectly or not
at all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray.
Rthe rear and/or front sensors are dirty.
Active Blind Spot Assist may not detect narrow vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles,
or only detect them too late. It cannot detect
vehicles which are overtaken at a small distance and then enter the blind spot area.
Active Blind Spot Assist cannot detect road
and traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for
attentive driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed, braking in good time, and
steering correctly. Always adapt your driving
style to suit the prevailing road and weather
conditions. Always pay attention to traffic
conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise,
you may fail to recognise dangers in time,
cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
ing. If a risk of lateral collision is detected,
corrective braking may help you avoid a collision. To support the course-correcting brake
application, Active Blind Spot Assist uses the
forward-facing radar sensor system. The free
space in the direction of travel is then evaluated.
Active Blind Spot Assist supports you from a
speed of approximately 30 km/h.
The radar sensor system is switched off automatically in the vicinity of radio telescope
facilities (Y page 368).
For Active Blind Spot Assist to assist you
when driving, the radar sensor system must
be activated (Y page 225) and operational.
Monitoring range
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors certain
areas in the immediate vicinity of your vehicle.
Vehicles that approach and drive past at high
speeds are not detected. No visual nor audible warnings are emitted and the system does
not brake the vehicle to correct your course.
If the lanes are very wide, it may not be possible to monitor the complete width of the
neighbouring lane. For this reason, vehicles in
the next lane may not be detected, especially
if they are driving in a staggered formation.
This may be the case if vehicles are driving at
the edge of their lane that is furthest away
from your vehicle.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
General notes
Active Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor
system to monitor the area to the sides of
your vehicle which are behind the driver. A
warning display in the exterior mirrors draws
your attention to vehicles detected in the
monitored area. If you then switch on the corresponding turn signal to change lane, you
will also receive an optical and audible warnZ
201
Driving and parking
Driving systems
202
Driving systems
Indicator and warning display
G WARNING
Driving and parking
Active Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds
below 30 km/h. The indicator lamps in the
exterior mirrors are yellow. Vehicles in the
monitoring range are then not indicated.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time and cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up
to 3.0 m behind your vehicle and directly next
to your vehicle, as shown in the diagram. For
this purpose, Active Blind Spot Assist uses
radar sensors in the rear bumper.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may
be the case if there are vehicles at the inner
edge of your lane.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders.
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside long vehicles, for example lorries, for a prolonged time.
The Active Blind Spot Assist radar sensors are
integrated into the front and rear bumpers
and behind a cover in the radiator grille. Make
sure that the bumpers and the cover in the
radiator grille are free of dirt, ice or slush. The
rear sensors must not be covered, e.g. by
bicycle racks or overhanging loads. Following
a severe impact or in the event of damage to
the bumpers, have the function of the radar
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop. Active Blind Spot Assist may otherwise no longer work properly.
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
If Active Blind Spot Assist is switched on,
indicator lamps : in the exterior mirrors light
up yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At
speeds above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp
goes out and Active Blind Spot Assist is
operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning
always occurs when a vehicle enters the blind
spot monitoring range from behind or from
the side. When you overtake a vehicle, the
warning only occurs if the difference in speed
is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Active Blind Spot Assist is
then no longer active.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Visual and acoustic collision warning
If you switch on the turn signals to change
lanes and a vehicle is detected in the side
monitoring range, you receive a visual and
acoustic collision warning. You then hear a
double warning tone and red warning
lamp : flashes. If the turn signal remains on,
detected vehicles are indicated by the flashing of red warning lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Course-correcting brake application
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid
designed to assist driving. It is not a substitute
for attentive driving. Automatic braking by the
system may not always be sufficient to avoid
a collision. In such cases, you need to steer,
brake or accelerate yourself.
In very rare cases, the system may detect a
risk of collision where there is none and brake
in error near crash barriers or similar road
boundaries. Active Blind Spot Assist cannot
detect all traffic situations and road users.
Ensure at all times that there is sufficient lateral distance between you and other road
users or obstacles. You can, for example,
countersteer gently or depress the accelerator pedal at any time to cancel inappropriate
braking action.
You are responsible for the vehicle's speed,
correct steering and for braking in good time.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
203
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of a
lateral collision in the monitoring range, a
course-correcting brake application is carried
out. This is designed to help you avoid a collision.
If a course-correcting brake application
occurs, red warning lamp : flashes in the
exterior mirror and a dual warning tone
sounds. In addition, the message shown in
the illustration appears in the multifunction
display.
The course-correcting brake application is
available in the speed range between
30 km/h and 200 km/h.
Either no braking application, or a coursecorrecting brake application adapted to the
driving situation occurs if
Rthere
are vehicles or obstacles, e.g. crash
barriers, on both sides of your vehicle.
Ra vehicle approaches too closely on the
side.
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds.
Ryou brake or accelerate decisively.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP® or PRE-SAFE® Brake.
Z
204
Driving systems
RESP®
is deactivated.
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre is
Driving and parking
detected.
Activating Active Blind Spot Assist
X Make sure that the radar sensor system
(Y page 225) and Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 220) are activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately
1.5 seconds and then turn yellow.
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Rthe
lane markings change quickly, e.g.
branch off, cross, or merge.
Rthe road is narrow and winding.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect
road and traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for attentive driving. You are responsible
for the vehicle's speed, braking in good time,
and steering correctly. Always adapt your
driving style to suit the prevailing road and
weather conditions. Always pay attention to
traffic conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
General notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not keep
your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid and
may detect the lane markings on the road
incorrectly or not at all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to inadequate illumination of the road surface,
snow, rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun, or reflection from other vehicles.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, fogged up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Rseveral or no lane markings for a single lane
are present.
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and as a result the lane markings cannot be recognised.
Rthe lane markings on the road are unclear,
e.g. near roadworks.
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area
in front of your vehicle by means of a camera : at the top of the windscreen. Active
Lane Keeping Assist detects lane markings on
the road and warns you before you leave your
lane unintentionally. If you do not react to the
warning, a lane-correcting application of the
brakes can bring the vehicle back into the
original lane.
If you have selected km as the display unit in
the Display unit Speed-/odome‐
ter(Y page 221) function in the on-board
computer, Active Lane Keeping Assist assists
you at speeds above 60 km/h. If miles is
selected as the display unit, the assistance
range starts at 40 mph.
Warning vibration in the steering wheel
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you
by means of intermittent vibration in the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
prevailing road and weather conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Ryou
Rthe
Ryou
road has narrow lanes.
cut the corner on a bend.
Lane-correcting brake application
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not keep
your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid
designed to assist driving. It is not a substitute
for attentive driving. Corrective braking may
not always be sufficient to return your vehicle
to its original lane. In such cases, you must
steer the vehicle yourself to ensure that it
does not leave the lane.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect the
current traffic situation or other road users.
Ensure at all times that there is sufficient lateral distance between you and other road
users or obstacles. In rare cases, broken lines
or certain structures on the road surface may
be detected by the system as solid lane markings. You can, for example, countersteer gently at any time to cancel inappropriate braking
action, e.g. if you intentionally drive across a
solid lane marking.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot take
weather conditions into account.
You are responsible for the vehicle's speed,
correct steering and for braking in good time.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
The message shown in the illustration
appears in the multifunction display when a
lane-correcting brake application occurs.
If you leave your lane under certain circumstances, the vehicle will brake briefly on one
side. This is designed to help you bring the
vehicle back into the original lane.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A lane-correcting brake application can only
be made after driving over a solid, recognisable lane marking. Before this, a warning
must be emitted by means of intermittent
vibration in the steering wheel. In addition, a
lane with lane markings on both sides must
be recognised. The brake application also
slightly reduces driving speed.
i A further lane-correcting brake applica-
tion can only occur after your vehicle has
returned to the original lane.
No lane-correcting brake application occurs
if:
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake, or
accelerate.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Ryou have switched on the turn signals.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist.
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration.
Z
205
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
206
Driving and parking
RESP®
is deactivated.
Rthe transmission is not in position D.
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre
has been detected and displayed.
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not detect
road and traffic conditions. An inappropriate
brake application may be interrupted at any
time if:
Ryou
steer slightly in the opposite direction.
use a turn signal.
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate.
A lane-correcting brake application is interrupted automatically if:
Ryou
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist.
Rlane markings can no longer be recognised.
Activating Active Lane Keeping Assist
X
Switch on Active Lane Keeping Assist using
the on-board computer; to do so, select
Standard or Adaptive(Y page 220).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, symbol : is
shown in green. Active Lane Keeping Assist
is ready for use.
If Standard is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed
for a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such
as ABS, BAS or ESP®.
If Adaptive is selected, no warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this case, the warnings are suppressed
for a certain period of time.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such
as ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou accelerate hard, e.g. kickdown.
Ryou brake hard.
Ryou steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid
an obstacle or change lane quickly.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Useful information ............................
Important safety notes ....................
Displays and operation ....................
Menus and submenus ......................
Display messages .............................
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................
208
208
209
212
231
258
On-board computer and displays
207
On-board computer and displays
208
Important safety notes
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 23).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Only use the on-board computer when road
and traffic conditions permit. You would otherwise be distracted and unable to concentrate properly on driving, and could cause an
accident.
G WARNING
No messages will be displayed if either the
instrument cluster or the multifunction display is inoperative.
As a result, you will not be able to see information about your driving conditions, such as
speed, outside temperature, warning and indicator lamps, display messages or system failures. Driving characteristics may be impaired.
Adjust your driving style and vehicle speed
accordingly.
Contact a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
G WARNING
The on-board computer only records and displays malfunctions and warnings from certain
systems. For this reason, you should always
make sure that your vehicle is safe to use. You
could otherwise cause an accident by driving
an unsafe vehicle.
G WARNING
The operating safety of your vehicle could be
impaired if maintenance work is carried out
incorrectly. This could cause you to lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident.
Moreover, the safety systems may no longer
be able to protect you or others as they are
designed to do.
Always have service work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
For an illustration of the instrument cluster,
see (Y page 30).
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation
209
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster: kilometres
: Speedometer with segments (Y page 210)
; Multifunction display (Y page 211)
= Rev counter (Y page 210)
? Coolant temperature (Y page 210)
A Fuel gauge
Instrument cluster: miles
: Speedometer with segments (Y page 210)
; Multifunction display (Y page 211)
= Rev counter (Y page 210)
Z
On-board computer and displays
210
Displays and operation
? Coolant temperature (Y page 210)
A Fuel gauge
Coolant temperature gauge
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the left-hand side
(Y page 30).
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
At high outside temperatures and when driving uphill, the coolant temperature may rise
to the end of the scale.
Rev counter
The segments light up from the stored
speed to the maximum speed.
RVariable SPEEDTRONIC activated
(Y page 168):
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
RDISTRONIC PLUS activated (Y page 170):
One or two segments in the set speed
range light up.
RDISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front:
The segments between the speed of the
vehicle in front and the stored speed light
up.
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Operating the on-board computer
Overview
Outside temperature display
G WARNING
At temperatures just above freezing point, the
street may be icy, especially in wooded areas
or on bridges. If you do not adapt your driving
style to the conditions, the vehicle could skid.
For this reason, adapt your driving style and
speed to the weather conditions.
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 211).
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
: Multifunction display
; Right control panel
= To switch on LINGUATRONIC; see the sep-
Speedometer with segments
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
RCruise
control activated (Y page 165):
arate operating instructions
? Back button
A Left control panel
X
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the key to position 1 in the ignition lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
9
:
a
up the menu and menu bar
RScrolls
through lists
RSelects a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects a
stored station, an audio track or
a video scene
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone
number
Right control panel
~
6
RMakes
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
W
X
RAdjusts
8
RMute
the volume
Back button
%
Press briefly:
RBack
RSwitches
off LINGUATRONIC;
see the separate operating
instructions
RHides display messages/calls
up the last Trip menu function
used
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
RIn
RConfirms selection/display mes-
or ends a call
telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
Press and hold:
the Audio menu: selects the
previous/next station or selects
an audio track or a video scene
using rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling if the phone
book is open
RRejects
%
Press and hold:
RCalls
up the standard display in
the Trip menu
Multifunction display
sage
the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialling the selected
number
RIn the Audio menu: stops the
station search function at the
desired station
RIn
: Description field
; Menu bar
= Drive program (Y page 149)
Z
211
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
212
? Transmission position (Y page 149)
A Permanent display: outside temperature
or speed (Y page 221)
X
To show the menu bar ;: press the
= or ; button on the steering wheel.
Menu bar ; disappears after a few seconds.
Text field : shows the selected menu or
submenu as well as display messages.
The following messages can appear in the
multifunction display:
XjY
Active Parking Assist
(Y page 187)
¯
Cruise control (Y page 165)
È
SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 168)
_
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
(Y page 117)
À
ATTENTION ASSIST
(Y page 192)
¤
ECO start/stop function
(Y page 144)
Ä
Speed Limit Assist
(Y page 193)
Ã
Lane Keeping Assist
(Y page 199)
Ã
Active Lane Keeping Assist
(Y page 204)
ë
HOLD function (Y page 179)
Ä
PRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 68)
120 km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
Menus and submenus
Menu overview
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to call up the menu bar and select
a menu.
Operating the on-board computer
(Y page 210).
Depending on the equipment fitted in the
vehicle, you can call up the following menus:
RTrip
menu (Y page 212)
menu (navigation instructions)
(Y page 214)
RAudio menu (Y page 215)
RTel menu (telephone) (Y page 217)
RAssist. menu (assistance) (Y page 218)
RServ. menu (Y page 220)
RSettings menu (Y page 221)
RAMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 228)
The Audio, Navi and Tel menus differ slightly
in vehicles with an audio system and in vehicles with COMAND Online. The examples
given in this Owner's Manual apply to vehicles
equipped with COMAND Online.
RNavi
Trip menu
Standard display
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
trip meter : and total distance
recorder ; is shown.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
Example: "From start" trip computer
: Distance
; Time
= Average speed
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ECO DISPLAY.
X
When the ignition is switched off for more
than four hours, the ECO display is automatically reset.
For further information on the ECO display,
see (Y page 161).
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
? Average fuel consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
From start or From reset.
X
The values in the From start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey, whilst
the values in the From reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 214).
The From start trip computer is automatically reset if:
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours.
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9,999 kilometres have been exceeded.
The From reset trip computer is automatically reset if the value exceeds 9,999 hours
or 99,999 kilometres.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
current fuel consumption (not for AMG
vehicles) and the approximate range.
X
The approximate range which can be covered
depends on the fuel level and your current
driving style. If there is only a small amount
of fuel left in the fuel tank, the display shows
a vehicle being refuelled C instead of the
range.
Digital speedometer
ECO display
: Digital speedometer
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
digital speedometer.
X
Example: ECO display
Z
213
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
214
Resetting values
Route guidance not active
Example: resetting the trip computer "From start"
: Direction of travel
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press the a button.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
; Current street
X
Activated route guidance
No change of direction announced
You can reset the values of the following functions:
Rtrip
meter
computer "From start"
Rtrip computer "From reset"
RECO display
Rtrip
: Distance to the destination
; Distance to the next change of direction
i If you reset the values in the ECO display,
the values in the "From start" trip computer
will also be reset. If you reset the values in
the "From start" trip computer, the values
in the ECO display will also be reset.
= Current street
? Symbol indicating "follow the road's
course"
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions. For more
information on the navigation system, see the
separate operating instructions.
Becker®
Switch on the audio system with
MAP PILOT or COMAND Online; see the
separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
X
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction has been
announced, you will see visual distance display ; next to the symbol for change of
direction =. This shortens from the bottom
to the top of the display as you approach the
point of the announced change of direction.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
: Waveband
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
=
?
A
B
distance display
Lane recommendation
Lane continues through change of direction
New lane during a change of direction
Change-of-direction symbol
On multilane roads, the system can display
lane recommendation = for the next change
of direction. During the change of direction,
additional lanes may be displayed.
Lane recommendations are only displayed if
the relevant data is available on the digital
map.
Other status indicators of the navigation system
RO: you have reached the destination or an
intermediate destination.
RNew route... or Calculating route:
calculating a new route
ROff map or Off road: the vehicle position
is outside the area of the digital map (offmap position).
RNo route: no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
; Station frequency with memory position
i Station ; is displayed with the station
frequency or station name. The memory
position is only displayed along with station ; if this has been stored.
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select Radio; see the separate
operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a stored station: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a station from the station
list: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
If no station list is received:
X To select a station using the station
search: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X
i For information on switching wavebands
and storing stations, see the separate operating instructions.
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcasting): see the separate operating instructions.
Z
215
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
216
Audio player or audio media operation
TV operation
Example: CD/DVD changer display
: Current track
: Channel frequency with memory position
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and activate audio CD/DVD mode
or MP3 mode; see the separate operating
instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
9 or : button until desired
track : has been reached.
If you press and hold the 9 or : button, the rapid scrolling speed is increased.
Not all audio devices or media support this
function.
X
i The memory position is only displayed
along with station : if this has been
stored.
Switch on COMAND Online and select TV;
see the separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a stored station: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a station from the station
list: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X
i Storing a TV channel: see the separate
operating instructions.
i Depending on the digital TV broadcaster,
radio stations can also be received. The
multifunction display shows TV (RADIO).
Video DVD operation
If track information is stored on the audio
device or medium, the multifunction display
will show the number and title of the track.
The current track does not appear in audio
AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external
audio source connected).
Example: CD/DVD changer display
: Current scene
Switch on COMAND Online and select
video DVD; see the separate operating
instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X
To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
9 or : button until desired
scene : has been reached.
X
Telephone menu
or COMAND Online, the mobile phone
searches for a network.
RTelephone ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found
a network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No service: there is no network available or the mobile phone is
searching for a network.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Introduction
G WARNING
Observe the legal requirements of the country
in which you are currently driving regarding
the use of mobile phones in the vehicle.
If it is permitted to use mobile phones while
the vehicle is in motion, you should only use
them when the road and traffic conditions
allow. Otherwise, you may be distracted from
the traffic conditions, cause an accident and
injure yourself and others.
Switch on the mobile phone (see the separate operating instructions).
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online; see the separate operating instructions.
X Insert the mobile phone into the bracket
(Y page 286).
or
X Establish a Bluetooth® connection to the
audio system or COMAND Online; see the
separate operating instructions.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
Rfrom
any Mercedes Benz Service Centre
the Internet at: http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Ron
Accepting a call
X
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RPlease
enter PIN: the mobile phone has
been placed in the mobile phone bracket
and the PIN has not been entered.
When you enter your PIN via the mobile
phone, LINGUATRONIC, the audio system
Example: incoming call
X
Press the 6 button on the steering
wheel to accept an incoming call.
If someone calls you when you are in the
Tel menu, a display message appears in the
multifunction display.
You can accept a call even if you are not in
the Tel menu.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
You can end or reject a call even if you are not
in the Tel menu.
Dialling a number from the phone book
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X
Z
217
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
218
X
Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
or
To begin rapid scrolling: press and hold
the 9 or : button for longer than
one second.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialling.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the telephone book: press the
~ or % button.
Assistance menu
Introduction
X
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialled in the redial memory.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X To exit the redial memory: press the
~ or % button.
X
In the Assist. menu, you have the following
options:
Rshow Speed Limit Assist and activate/
deactivate its message function
(Y page 218)
Rshow the distance display (Y page 219)
Ractivate/deactivate ESP®(Y page 219)
Ractivate/deactivate the PRE-SAFE® Brake
(Y page 219)
Ractivate/deactivate ATTENTION ASSIST
(Y page 220)
Ractivate/deactivate Blind Spot Assist or
Active Blind Spot Assist (Y page 220)
Ractivate/deactivate Lane Keeping Assist or
Active Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 220)
Speed Limit Assist
Displaying Speed Limit Assist
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Speed Lim. Asst..
X Press the a button.
Under certain conditions, detected speed
limits are shown in the multifunction display (Y page 193).
Activating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Speed Lim. Asst..
Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows Speed
Limit Assist.
X Press the : button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate or deactivate: press a.
If the Speed Limit Assist message function
is activated, a detected speed limit is automatically displayed for five seconds. Other
items in the multifunction display are not
shown during this time.
X
If Speed Limit Assist is operational and the
message function is activated, the multifunction display shows the Ä symbol when the
ignition is switched on.
Showing the distance display
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Distance display.
X Press the a button.
The DISTRONIC PLUS distance display
appears in the multifunction display
(Y page 176).
X
If the Sensors deactivated message
appears, the radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Check whether or not the radar sensor system is permitted to be activated
(Y page 368).
X Switch on the radar sensor system
(Y page 225).
Deactivating/activating ESP®
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilises the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
Activating/deactivating ESP® on AMG vehicles (Y page 66).
For further information about ESP®, see
(Y page 65).
X Start the engine.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ESP.
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ warning lamp and the å warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 263).
Observe the information on display messages
(Y page 232).
Rin
Activating/deactivating PRE-SAFE®
Brake
PRE-SAFE® Brake is only available in vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
PRE-SAFE Brake.
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
X
Z
219
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
220
When PRE-SAFE® Brake is activated, the multifunction display shows the Ä symbol as
long as the HOLD function is not activated
(Y page 179).
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist: if
PARKTRONIC is activated and you are driving
at a speed under 35 km/h, the j Active
Parking Assist symbol is shown instead of the
Ä symbol (Y page 187).
If the PRE-SAFE Brake: Sensors deacti‐
vated message appears, the radar sensor
system is deactivated.
X Check whether or not the radar sensor system may be activated (Y page 368).
X Activate the radar sensor system
(Y page 225).
For more information on PRE-SAFE® Brake,
see (Y page 68).
Activating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Attention Assist.
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
X
When ATTENTION ASSIST is activated, the
À symbol appears in the multifunction
display when the ignition is on.
For further information about ATTENTION
ASSIST, see (Y page 192).
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Blind Spot Asst..
X
Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
X
If the Blind Spot Assist Sensors deac‐
tivated or Active blind spot assist.
sensor system deactivated message
appears, the radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Check whether or not the radar sensor system may be activated (Y page 368).
X Activate the radar sensor system
(Y page 225).
For further information about Blind Spot
Assist, see (Y page 197).
For further information about Active Blind
Spot Assist, see (Y page 201).
Activating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Lane Keep. Asst.
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X Press a to confirm.
X
When Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane
Keeping Assist is activated, the à symbol
appears in the multifunction display when the
ignition is on.
For further information about Active Lane
Keeping Assist, see (Y page 204).
Service menu
In the Serv. menu, you have the following
options:
Rcall up display messages in the message
memory (Y page 231)
Rrestart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 333)
Rcheck the tyre pressure electronically
(Y page 334)
Rcall up when a service is due
(Y page 300)
Settings menu
Introduction
You can determine whether the multifunction
display shows some messages in miles or kilometres.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer: function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
Rthe
digital speedometer in the Trip menu
distance recorder and the trip meter
Rtrip computer
Rcurrent consumption and the range
Rthe navigation instructions in the Navi
menu
Rcruise control
RSPEEDTRONIC
RDISTRONIC PLUS
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rtotal
In the Settings menu, you have the following
options:
Rchange the instrument cluster settings
(Y page 221)
Rchange the light settings (Y page 222)
Rchange the vehicle settings (Y page 224)
Rchange the auxiliary heating settings
(Y page 225)
Rchange the convenience settings
(Y page 226)
Rrestore the factory settings (Y page 227)
Instrument cluster
Selecting the unit of measurement for distance
The Display unit Speed-/odometer:
function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in kilometres or miles in
the multifunction display.
Selecting the permanent display function
You can determine whether the multifunction
display permanently shows your speed or the
outside temperature.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Permanent display: function.
You will see the selected setting: outside
temperature or Dig. speedo [mph].
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
i Speed is displayed in mph.
Z
221
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
222
Menus and submenus
i Vehicles for the United Kingdom: this
function is unavailable.
Lights
Setting the brightness for the instrument
cluster lighting and switches
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the
displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can be adjusted using the Brightness
Display/switches: function.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Brightness Display/Switches: function.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to any level from Level 1 to
Level 5 (bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
If the light switch is set to Ã, T or
L, the brightness is dependent upon
the brightness of the ambient light.
i The light sensor in the instrument cluster
automatically controls the brightness of
the multifunction display.
In daylight, the displays in the instrument
cluster are not illuminated.
Switching the daytime driving lights on/
off
The Day lights function can only be
switched on with the engine turned off.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Day lights: function.
If the Day lights: function has been
switched on, the cone of light and the
W symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Further information on daytime driving lights
(Y page 111).
Switching the Intelligent Light System
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Intell. Light System function.
If the Intell. Light System function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
L symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you activate Intell. Light System,
you activate the following functions:
Rmotorway mode
Ractive light function
Rcornering light function
Rextended range foglamps
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, the multifunction
display shows the Intell. Light System:
system inoperative Inactive for
left-side traffic or Intell. Light
System: System inoperative Inactive
for right-side traffic (Y page 223)
display message instead of the Intell.
Light System function in the Light submenu.
Further information on the Intelligent Light
System (Y page 115).
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the left/right
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Dipped beams Setting for: function.
You will see the selected setting: Rightside traffic or Left-side traffic.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you change the setting, conversion does
not take place until the next time the vehicle is stationary.
This function is only available on vehicles with
the Intelligent Light System.
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical and asymmetrical dipped beam
(Y page 110).
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, then motorway
mode and the extended range foglamps are
unavailable.
A qualified specialist workshop can set the
dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the
right or left .
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist on/
off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Adapt. main beam function.
If the Adapt. main beam function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
_ symbol in the upper multifunction
display are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Setting the brightness of the ambient
lighting
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light +/- function.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to any level from Off to Level
5 (bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
Setting the ambient lighting colour
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Ambient light colour function.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
colour to SOLAR, NEUTRAL or POLAR.
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
Activating/deactivating the surround
lighting and exterior lighting delayed
switch-off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
For further information about Adaptive Highbeam Assist, see (Y page 117).
Z
223
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
224
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Surround lighting function.
When the Surround lighting function is
activated, the light cone and the area
around the vehicle are displayed in red in
the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Deactivating delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting temporarily:
Before leaving the vehicle, turn the key to
position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
The exterior lighting delayed switch-off is
deactivated.
X
Delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting is
reactivated the next time you start the
engine.
If you have activated the Surround light‐
ing function and the light switch is set to
Ã, the following functions are activated
when it is dark:
Rsurround lighting: the exterior lighting
remains lit for 40 seconds after unlocking
with the key. If you start the engine, the
surround lighting is switched off and automatic headlamp mode is activated
(Y page 111).
RExterior lighting delayed switch-off: the
exterior lighting remains lit for 60seconds
after the engine is switched off. If you close
all the doors and the boot lid, the exterior
lighting goes off after 5 seconds.
i Depending on your vehicle's equipment,
when the surround lighting and delayed
switch-off exterior lighting are on, the following light up:
Rside lamps
Rdipped-beam headlamps
Rdaytime driving lights
Rsurround lighting in the exterior mirrors
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
If you activate the Lighting delayed sw.off function, the interior lighting remains on
for 20seconds after you remove the key from
the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light. delay function.
When the Lighting delayed sw.-off
function is activated, the vehicle interior is
displayed in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Vehicle
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Limit speed (winter tyres): function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust
permanent SPEEDTRONIC in increments of
ten (230 km/h to 160 km/h). The Off setting switches permanent SPEEDTRONIC
off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
For further information on permanent SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 170).
Switching the automatic locking feature
on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. door locks function.
When the Automatic door locks function is activated, the vehicle doors are displayed in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you activate the Automatic door locks
function, the vehicle is centrally locked above
a speed of around 15 km/h.
For further information on the automatic locking feature, see (Y page 84).
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you switch on the Acoustic Lock function,
an acoustic signal sounds when you lock the
vehicle.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display lights up red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the radar sensor
system
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
Press the 9 or : button to select
Radar sensor (See Owner's Man.):.
You will see the selected setting: on or
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
i You must deactivate the radar sensor system in certain countries and near radio
telescope facilities. For further information, see (Y page 368).
When you are close to radio telescope facilities, the radar sensor system will be deactivated automatically.
The following systems are switched off when
the radar sensor system is deactivated:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 170)
PLUS (Y page 64)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 68)
RBlind Spot Assist (Y page 197)
RActive Blind Spot Assist (Y page 201)
RBAS
Heating
Auxiliary heating departure time
G WARNING
Exhaust fumes are produced when the auxiliary heating is in operation. Inhaling these
exhaust fumes can be poisonous. You should
therefore switch off the auxiliary heating in
confined spaces without an extraction system, e.g. a garage.
G WARNING
When operating the auxiliary heating parts of
the vehicle can get very hot. Make sure that
the exhaust system does not under any circumstances come into contact with easily
ignitable material such as dry grass or fuels.
The material could otherwise ignite and set
the vehicle alight. Choose your parking spot
accordingly.
Operating the auxiliary heating is thus prohibited at filling stations or when your vehicle
is being refuelled. You must therefore switch
off the auxiliary heating at filling stations.
Z
225
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
226
Menus and submenus
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
This function is only available on vehicles with
auxiliary heating (Y page 132).
In the Heating submenu, you can select a
stored departure time or change a departure
time.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates the switch-on time according to the outside temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by the departure time. When the
departure time is reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat for a further five
minutes and then switches off. The auxiliary
heating adopts the THERMATIC or
THERMOTRONIC temperature setting.
You can switch off the auxiliary heating by
using the remote control or the auxiliary heating button on the centre console.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
Selecting the departure time or deactivating a selected departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
one of the three departure times or Timer
off (no timer active).
X Press a to confirm.
If a departure time is selected, the yellow
indicator lamp lights up on the auxiliary
heating button.
Changing the departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select A,
B or Change C.
X Press a to confirm.
You can now change the departure time.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display to be changed: hours, minutes.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
The yellow indicator lamp on the auxiliary
heating button lights up.
Convenience
Activating/deactivating the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature
G WARNING
The steering wheel moves when the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature is active. There is a risk
of occupants becoming trapped. Before activating the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature, make
sure that nobody can become trapped.
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. The children could open the
driver's door and thereby unintentionally activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature and
become trapped.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Easy Entry/Exit: function.
If the Easy Entry/Exit function is activated, the vehicle steering wheel is displayed
in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Further information on the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature (Y page 104).
Switching the belt adjustment on/off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
When the Belt adjustment function is
activated, the vehicle seat belt is displayed
in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
For further information on belt adjustment,
see (Y page 50).
Switching the fold-in mirrors when locking function on/off
This function is only available on vehicles with
Memory Function (Y page 107).
When you activate the Auto. fold in function, the exterior mirrors are folded in when
the vehicle is locked. When you unlock the
vehicle and then open a door, the exterior
mirrors fold out again.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. fold in function.
If the Auto. fold in function is activated,
the vehicle's exterior mirror is displayed in
red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
: To fold the exterior mirrors in or out
If you have switched the Auto. fold in
function on and you fold the exterior mirrors
in using button :, they will not fold out automatically (Y page 105).
You can then only fold out the exterior mirrors
using button :.
Resetting to factory settings
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset all settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
No or Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
X
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit speed (winter tyres) function
in permanent SPEEDTRONIC can only be set
in the Vehicle submenu. If you want to reset
the Daytime driving lights in the Light
submenu, you must turn the key to position
1 in the ignition lock.
Z
227
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
228
AMG menu in AMG vehicles
AMG displays
SETUP shows the drive program, the ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program) mode and the
suspension tuning.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until
SETUP is displayed.
or
X Briefly press the AMG button on the centre
console (Y page 183).
X
: Digital speedometer
; Gear indicator
= Upshift indicator
RACETIMER
? Engine oil temperature
Displaying and starting the RACETIMER
A Coolant temperature
B ECO start/stop function status indicator
(Y page 144)
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
Upshift indicator UP= indicates that the
engine has reached the overrevving range
when in the manual gearshift program.
Upshift indicator UP= fades out other messages until you have shifted up.
If the engine oil temperature is below 80 †,
the oil temperature is shown in blue. Avoid
using the full output of the engine during this
time.
SETUP
: Lap
; RACETIMER
You can start the RACETIMER when the
engine is running or if the key is in position
2 in the ignition lock.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER is shown.
X To start: press the a button to start the
RACETIMER.
X
Displaying the intermediate time
: Drive program (C/SS+/M)
; ESP® mode (ON/OFF) or SPORT handling
mode (SPORT)
= Suspension tuning (COMFORT/SPORT/
SPORT+)
Press the = or ; button to select
Interm. Time.
X Press a to confirm.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X
Deleting all laps
Starting a new lap
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
X
Press a to confirm New Lap.
i It is possible to store a maximum of six-
teen laps. Lap 16 can only be stopped with
Finish Lap.
If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER
is reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are
deleted.
You cannot delete individual stored laps. If
you have stopped 16 laps, the current lap
does not have to be reset.
X Reset the current lap.
X Press a to confirm Reset.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
Stopping the RACETIMER
Overall evaluation
Press the % button on the steering
wheel.
X Press a to confirm Yes.
: RACETIMER overall evaluation
The RACETIMER interrupts timing if you stop
the vehicle and turn the key to position 1 in
the ignition lock. If you turn the key to position
2 or 3 and then press a to confirm
Start, timing is continued.
? Distance covered
X
Resetting the current lap
X Stop the RACETIMER.
X Press the = or ; button to select
Reset Lap.
X Press a to reset the lap time to "0".
; Total time driven
= Average speed
A Maximum speed
This function is shown if you have stored at
least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation is shown.
X
Z
229
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
230
Lap evaluation
: Lap
; Lap time
= Average lap speed
? Lap length
A Top speed during lap
This function is only available if you have
stored at least two laps and have stopped the
RACETIMER.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
lap evaluation is shown.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu.
The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X Press the 9 or : button to select a
different lap evaluation.
X
Display messages
Introduction
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are simplified in the Owner's Manual and may differ
from the symbols in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in
this Owner's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on:
RHOLD
function (Y page 179)
page 159)
RParking (Y
Hiding display messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message.
The display message is cleared.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. Some high-priority display messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can
call up the display messages:
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages, for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
Z
231
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
232
Display messages
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill
start assist are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Possible causes:
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Rself-diagnosis
Rthe
is not yet complete.
on-board voltage may be insufficient.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
!÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start
assist are unavailable due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the J, ÷, å and ! warning lamps light
up in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are
unavailable due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
The self-diagnosis function may not be complete, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
233
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
234
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
T!
÷
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRESAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are unavailable due
to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
J
Release parking
brake
J
Check brake fluid
level
You are driving with the parking brake applied. A warning tone also
sounds.
X Release the parking brake.
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster and a warning tone sounds.
G WARNING
The braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the error.
#
Check brake pad
wear
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
PRE-SAFE
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
PRE-SAFE
Functions cur‐
rently limited See
Owner's Manual
PRE-SAFE® Brake is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
sensors in the radiator trim and in the bumpers are dirty.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
RAMG vehicles: ESP® is deactivated.
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range.
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
PRE-SAFE® Brake is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rthe
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Clean the sensors in the radiator trim and in the bumpers
(Y page 304).
X Restart the engine.
X AMG vehicles: reactivate ESP®(Y page 66).
X
PRE-SAFE
Functions cur‐
rently limited See
Owner's Manual
PRE-SAFE® Brake is inoperative due to a fault. BAS PLUS or the
distance warning signal may also have failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ü
If the symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has been inserted into a rear seat belt buckle.
For further information on the status indicator for the rear seat
belts: (Y page 51).
Z
235
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
236
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ý
If the symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has not been inserted in a rear seat belt buckle.
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or which has not been
engaged in the seat belt buckle correctly, cannot provide the
intended level of protection.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts (Y page 49).
For further information on the status indicator for the rear seat
belts, (Y page 51).
6
Restraint syst.
malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System). The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
For further information about the Supplemental Restraint System,
see (Y page 41).
6
SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
Front left malfunc‐
G WARNING
tion Consult work‐
shoporFront right
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintenmalfunction Con‐
tionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
sult workshop
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
6
Rear left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop or Rear right
malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
SRS has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand windowbag.
Left windowbag mal‐ The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
function Consult
workshop or Right
G WARNING
windowbag malfunc‐ The left or right windowbag may either be triggered unintentionally
tion Consult work‐ or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
shop
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Lights
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all LEDs have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
Left cornering
(Y page 120).
light or Right cor‐
or
nering light
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Left dipped beam
or Right dipped
beam
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
237
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
238
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Rear left indica‐
tor or Rear right
indicator
b
Front left indica‐
tor or Front right
indicator
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
faulty.
Left mirror indica‐ X
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
tor or Right mir‐
(Y page 120).
ror indicator
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Third brake lamp
b
Left-hand tail
lamp/brake
lamporRight-hand
tail lamp/brake
lamp
b
Left main
beamorRight main
beam
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand high beam is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The rear foglamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Rear fog lamp
b
Front left parking
lamp or Front
right parking lamp
b
Left revers. lamp
or Right revers.
lamp
b
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamp or Right
daytime driving
lamp
b
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
b
Malfunction See
Owner's Manual
b
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
b
Switch off lights
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand reversing lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left-hand or right-hand daytime driving lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 120).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available
without the Intelligent Light System.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The exterior lighting is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The light sensor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
Z
239
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
240
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist inoperative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational again,
the Adaptive Main-beam Assist available again message
is displayed.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is operational again.
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing
so (Y page 299).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
?
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
G WARNING
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns, which
can occur just by opening the bonnet.
This poses a risk of injury.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the display message goes out
and the coolant temperature is under 120 †. The engine may
otherwise be damaged.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
The reading may rise up to 120 † under normal driving conditions
if the coolant has been filled correctly.
Z
241
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
242
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Rfaulty
alternator
poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
Rtorn
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
4
Check eng. oil
lev. when next
refuelling
The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
(Y page 298).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 298).
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if
the engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
4
AMG vehicles: the engine oil level is too low.
X Check the oil level when next refuelling, at the latest
Add 1 litre engine
(Y page 298).
oil when next refu‐
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 298).
elling
X Have the engine checked at a qualified specialist workshop if
the engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
8
Reserve fuel level
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated when the fuel level
drops into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
C
There is only a very small amount of fuel in the fuel tank.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must
be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Please replace air
cleaner
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The
water must be drained off.
Clean the fuel fil‐ X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ter
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue
or a lack of concentration on the part of the driver. A warning tone
also sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
Attention Assist:
Take a break!
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so that you
get enough rest.
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
¨
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Your vehicle is adjusting to the level you have selected.
Vehicle rising
¨
Vehicle rising
Please wait
The vehicle level is too low when the vehicle is stationary. A warning tone also sounds.
X Do not pull away.
The vehicle level is set when the display message disappears.
Z
243
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
244
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
¨
You have pulled away while the vehicle level is still too low.
AIRMATIC sets the vehicle to the selected level after a short
period.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
STOP vehicle Vehi‐
cle too low
AIRMATIC is faulty. A warning tone also sounds.
X Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Make only slight steering movements. Otherwise, the front
wings or the tyres could be damaged if the steering movement
is too large.
X Listen for scraping sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely, paying attention to road
and traffic conditions, and select a higher vehicle level.
Depending on the malfunction, it may be possible to raise the
vehicle.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
¨
Malfunction
Speed Limit Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
The AIRMATIC function is restricted. The vehicle's handling characteristics may be affected.
X Do not drive at speeds above 80 km/h.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Speed Limit Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative.
Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
If the system detects that the camera is fully operational, the display message disappears.
Speed Limit Assist is operational again.
Speed Limit Assist is only available in certain countries.
Speed Limit
Assist: Unavaila‐
X Drive on.
ble in this country
Speed Limit Assist is available again as soon as you drive in a
country in which its use is approved.
Speed Limit Assist
inoperative
Speed Limit Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ë
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 179).
off
Radar sensor deac‐
tivated See Own‐
er's Manual
The radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Check whether or not the radar sensor system may be activated
(Y page 368).
X Activate the radar sensor system (Y page 225).
Radar sensor deac‐
tivated autom. See
Owner's Manual
Vehicles with a navigation system: the vehicle is close to a radio
telescope facility and is therefore prohibited from transmitting any
radar signals. The radar sensor system has switched off automatically (Y page 368).
If DISTRONIC PLUS was activated, it is no longer available. A
warning tone also sounds.
If Active Blind Spot Assist was activated, it is no longer available.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist PLUS) and PRE-SAFE® Brake are then also
unavailable.
X Drive on.
Once you have moved far enough away from the radio telescope,
the above functions are available again.
Vehicles with Becker® MAP PILOT: if the Becker® MAP PILOT is
not connected, the radar sensor system is deactivated automatically.
BAS PLUS, DISTRONIC PLUS, Active Blind Spot Assist and
PRE-SAFE® brake are unavailable.
X
Connect the Becker® MAP PILOT; see the separate operating
instructions.
Z
245
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
246
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Lane Keeping
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual or
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated
and temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
Rthere are no lane markings for a longer period.
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is operational
again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rvisibility
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Clean the windscreen.
X
Lane Keeping
Assist inopera‐
tive or Active
Lane Keeping
Assist inoperative
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Lane Keeping
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual or
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative.
You have established the electrical connection between the trailer
and your vehicle.
X Press a on the steering wheel to confirm the display message.
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is deactivated while
towing a trailer.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
Rthe
sensors are dirty.
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Rthe
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Clean the sensors (Y page 304).
X Restart the engine.
X
Blind Spot Assist
inoperative or
Active Blind Spot
Assist inoperative
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist cancel‐ The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been
fastened.
led
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
You have inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel
while steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure not to touch the
multifunction steering wheel.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Active Parking Assist again later (Y page 187).
Z
247
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
248
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Park Assist inoper‐ You have just carried out a large number of turning or parking
manoeuvres.
ative
Active Parking Assist will become available again after approximately ten minutes (Y page 187).
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
PARKTRONIC is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking Guidance
finished
The vehicle is parked. A warning tone also sounds.
The display message disappears automatically.
DISTRONIC PLUS off
DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 170).
If it was deactivated automatically, a warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS
available again
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 170).
DISTRONIC PLUS cur‐ DISTRONIC PLUS is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes:
rently unavailable Rthe function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
See Owner's Manual R
the sensors in the radiator trim and in the bumpers are dirty.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range.
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
Once the causes listed above no longer apply, the display message
goes out.
DISTRONIC is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Clean the sensors in the radiator trim and in the bumpers
(Y page 304).
X Restart the engine.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DISTRONIC PLUS
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS is faulty.
BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may also have failed.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS
inactive
You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no
longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS
--- km/h
An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled.
X Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 170).
DISTRONIC PLUS and
SPEEDTRONIC
DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control and
SPEEDTRONIC inop‐
erative
SPEEDTRONIC and cruise control are malfunctioning.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Limit
--- km/h
While depressing the accelerator pedal beyond the pressure point
(kickdown), SPEEDTRONIC cannot be activated.
Cruise control
--- km/h
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control
(Y page 165).
120 km/h
Maximum speed
exceeded
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
In addition, the multifunction display shows 120 km/h!.
X Drive more slowly.
Z
249
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
250
Display messages
Tyres
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre pressure
Check tyres
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
With tyre pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X If there is a flat tyre, inspect the tyres (Y page 312).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, correct the tyre
pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 333).
Check tyre pres‐
sures
then restart Run
Flat Indicator
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 333).
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre pressure
displayed after
driving for a few
minutes
The tyre pressure monitor is measuring the tyre pressure.
X Drive on.
The tyre pressures appear in the multifunction display after you
have been driving for a few minutes.
Tyre press. monitor The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
inoperative
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative No
wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have a suitable tyre pressure sensor. The
tyre pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.
Check
tyres
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
With tyre pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X If there is a flat tyre, inspect the tyres (Y page 312).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 334).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Z
251
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
252
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Warning
tyre defect
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
RA
flat tyre affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
could lose control of the vehicle.
RContinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X If there is a flat tyre, inspect the tyres (Y page 312).
RYou
Rectify
tyre pressure
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity
(Y page 334).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor (Y page 335).
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. monitor Due to a source of radio interference, no signals can be received
currently unavail‐ from the wheel sensors. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
able
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
cause has been rectified.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly.
A warning tone also sounds.
Tyre pressure Cau‐
tion Tyre malfunc‐
tion
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tyre, there is a risk of the following hazards:
RA
flat tyre affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
could lose control of the vehicle.
RContinued driving with a flat tyre will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X If there is a flat tyre, inspect the tyres (Y page 312).
RYou
h
Tyre pressure
Check tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
G WARNING
With tyre pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase.
Rthey tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X If there is a flat tyre, inspect the tyres (Y page 312).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 334).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
h
Please correct
tyre pressure
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres, or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity
(Y page 334).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Z
253
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
254
Display messages
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To start engine,
shift to either P
or N
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position R or D.
X Shift the transmission to position P or N.
Auxiliary battery
malfunction
The auxiliary battery for the automatic transmission is no longer
being charged.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Apply brake to
deselect
Park (P) position
You have attempted to move the transmission selector lever to
position D, R or N without depressing the brake pedal.
X Depress the brake pedal.
Risk of vehicle
rolling
Transmission not
in P
The driver's door is open and the transmission is in position R, N
or D.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
Without changing
gear,
consult workshop
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
A warning tone also sounds.
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the
transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The vehicle is moving.
Only select
position P when
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
vehicle is station‐
attention to road and traffic conditions.
ary
X Shift the transmission to position P.
N
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
M
The bonnet is open. A warning tone also sounds.
G WARNING
The open bonnet may then block your view when the vehicle is in
motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Close the bonnet.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
_
The backrest in the rear is not engaged on the left-hand and/or
right-hand side. A warning tone also sounds.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
Rear left seat
backrest not
locked or Rear
right seat back‐
rest not locked
_
Front left seat
backrest not
locked or Front
right seat back‐
rest not locked
&
inoperative Bat‐
tery low
&
inoperative Refuel
vehicle
The driver's or front-passenger seat backrest is not engaged. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
The on-board voltage is too low. The auxiliary heating has switched
itself off or cannot be switched on (Y page 132).
X Drive for a longer distance.
The battery is being charged. The auxiliary heating is operational
again as soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is sufficient.
There is too little fuel in the fuel tank. The auxiliary heating cannot
be switched on (Y page 132).
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
Z
255
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
256
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
&
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Ð
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The auxiliary heating has a temporary malfunction or is faulty.
When the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down, make up to four attempts to switch on the auxiliary heating, waiting several minutes between each attempt
(Y page 132).
X If the auxiliary heating does not switch on, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
X
The power steering assistance is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
Power steering mal‐
G WARNING
function See Own‐
er's Manual
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
Telephone No
service
Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/
receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Top up washer fluid X
Top up the washer fluid (Y page 299).
Key
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Key does not
belong to vehicle
Â
Replace key
The key needs to be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
The batteries of the KEYLESS-GO key are discharged.
X Change the batteries (Y page 79).
Change key batter‐
ies
Â
Key not detected
(red display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Locate the KEYLESS-GO key.
The KEYLESS-GO key is not detected while the engine is running
because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
Â
Key not detected
(white display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key cannot be detected at present.
X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
If the KEYLESS-GO key is still not detected:
X
Â
Key still in vehi‐
cle
Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
The KEYLESS-GO key has been detected inside the vehicle during
locking.
X Remove the KEYLESS-GO key from the vehicle.
Z
257
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
258
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
Remove starting
button, then
insert key
The KEYLESS-GO key is not continually detected.
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Â
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors and lock the vehicle again.
Close doors to
lock vehicle
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster
Warning and indicator lamps overview
L
Dipped-beam headlamps
(Y page 111)
T
Side lamps (Y page 112)
K
Main-beam headlamps
(Y page 113)
#! Turn signals (Y page 113)
R
Rear foglamp (Y page 112)
ü
Seat belts (Y page 259)
J
Brakes (Y page 260)
!
ABS (Y page 261)
÷
ESP®(Y page 263)
å
ESP® OFF (Y page 263)
M
SPORT handling mode in AMG
vehicles (Y page 264)
6
SRS (Y page 266)
;
Engine diagnostics
(Y page 266)
8
Reserve fuel (Y page 267)
?
Coolant (Y page 267)
·
Distance warning signal
(Y page 269)
%
h
Diesel engine: preglow
(Y page 143)
Tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 270)
Safety
Seat belts
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
Only for certain countries: the red seat belt
warning lamp lights up
for six seconds after
the engine starts.
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
to fasten their seat belts.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 49).
ü
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
Only for certain coun- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 49).
tries: the red seat belt
The warning tone ceases.
warning lamp lights up
after the engine starts.
In addition, a warning
tone sounds for up to
six seconds.
ü
The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
The red seat belt warn- X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 49).
ing lamp lights up after
The warning lamp goes out.
the engine starts, as
soon as the driver's or There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
the front-passenger
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
door is closed.
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
ü
The driver or passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At the
The red seat belt warn- same time, the car is being driven faster than 25 km/h or has been
ing lamp flashes and an briefly driven faster than 25 km/h.
intermittent audible
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 49).
warning sounds.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time,
you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster
than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
Z
259
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
260
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Safety systems
Problem
J
The yellow brake system warning lamp
lights up while the
engine is running.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G WARNING
The brake system is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be affected.
There is a risk of an accident.
X If the multifunction display shows a display message, please
observe this.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
J
G WARNING
The red brake system The brake boosting effect is malfunctioning and the braking charwarning lamp comes on acteristics may be affected.
while the engine is runThere is a risk of an accident.
ning. A warning tone
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
also sounds.
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
J
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
The red brake system
G WARNING
warning lamp comes on
while the engine is run- The braking efficiency may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
ning. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Do not top up the brake fluid. Topping up will not rectify the
fault.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) has been deactivated due to a fault.
For this reason, BAS (Brake Assist), BAS PLUS, ESP® (Electronic
Stability Program), PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist and the adaptive brake lights are also deactivated, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other
systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will not be available.
Z
261
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
262
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
ABS is temporarily unavailable. Therefore, BAS, BAS PLUS, ESP®,
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), PRE-SAFE®,
PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist and the
adaptive brake lights, for example, are also deactivated.
Possible causes:
RSelf-diagnosis
is not yet complete.
on-board voltage may be insufficient.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Rthe
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running. A
warning tone also
sounds.
EBD is not available due to a malfunction. Therefore, ABS, BAS,
BAS PLUS, ESP®, PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist and the adaptive brake lights, for example,
are not available either.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
J֌!
The red brake warning
lamp, the yellow ESP®
and ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running.
ABS and ESP® are not available due to a fault. Therefore, BAS, BAS
PLUS, EBD, PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill
start assist and the adaptive brake lights, for example, are not
available either.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
263
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
264
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
The yellow ESP® warn- skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin.
ing lamp flashes while Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
the vehicle is in motion. X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when
pulling away.
X Accelerate more gently while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 65).
å
ESP® is deactivated.
ESP®
The yellow
OFF
G WARNING
warning lamp is lit while
®
®
the engine is running. If ESP is switched off, ESP is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
Reactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 65).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X Drive on carefully.
X Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
M
AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
SPORT handling mode is activated.
G WARNING
When SPORT handling mode is switched on, ESP® is unable to
stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Only switch to SPORT handling mode in accordance with the
conditions written in the "Activating/deactivating SPORT handling mode" section (Y page 66).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
֌
ESP®, BAS, BAS PLUS, PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD
function, hill start assist and the adaptive brake lights are not
available due to a malfunction.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
֌
ESP®
The yellow
and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are
temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Self-diagnosis is not yet complete.
G WARNING
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilise the vehicle.
The danger of skidding and having an accident increases.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
265
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
266
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
You are driving with the parking brake applied.
The red brake system X Release the parking brake.
warning lamp comes on
The warning lamp goes out and the warning tone ceases.
while the vehicle is
moving. A warning tone
also sounds.
6
The red SRS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System).
G WARNING
The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
This poses an increased risk of injury.
X Drive on carefully.
X Have SRS checked at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
For further information about the Supplemental Restraint System,
see (Y page 41).
Engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
There may be a fault, for example:
The yellow engine diag- Rin the engine management
nostics warning lamp
Rin the fuel injection system
lights up while the
Rin the exhaust system
engine is running.
Rin the ignition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
Rin the fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may
be running in emergency mode.
X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the fuel tank has been run dry
(Y page 158).
X Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
If the yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp goes out, emergency running mode is cancelled. The vehicle need not be
checked.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
8
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
The yellow reserve fuel Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated if the fuel level
warning lamp lights up drops into the reserve range.
while the engine is run- X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ning.
?
The red coolant warning lamp lights up while
the engine is running
and the coolant temperature gauge is at the
start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is
faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a
risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
267
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
268
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator
may be blocked or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the
warning notes (Y page 299).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Do not start the engine again until the coolant temperature is
under 120 †. The engine may otherwise be damaged.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running. A warning tone
also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the
engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too
low.
G WARNING
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
Never drive with an overheated engine. Driving when your engine
is overheated can cause some fluids which may have leaked into
the engine compartment to catch fire.
Steam from an overheated engine can cause serious burns, which
can occur just by opening the bonnet.
This poses a risk of injury.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until
the engine has cooled down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant, observing the
warning notes (Y page 299).
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X If the coolant temperature is below 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving in
mountainous terrain and stop-start traffic.
X
Driving systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed
The red distance warn- selected.
ing lamp lights up while X Increase the distance.
the vehicle is in motion.
·
You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line
The red distance warn- of travel at too high a speed.
ing lamp lights up while X Be prepared to brake immediately.
the vehicle is in motion. X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to
A warning tone also
brake or take evasive action.
sounds.
Further information on DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 170).
Further information on PRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 68).
Z
269
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
270
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Tyres
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp is on.
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
least one of the tyres.
G WARNING
With tyre pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthe
tyres may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase.
Rthe tyres may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may
greatly impair tyre traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 159).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X If there is a flat tyre, inspect the tyres (Y page 312).
X Check the tyre pressure (Y page 334).
X If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
271
Stowing and features
Useful information ............................ 272
Stowage areas .................................. 272
Features ............................................. 279
272
Stowage areas
Useful information
Stowing and features
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 23).
Stowage areas
Loading guidelines
G WARNING
Secure and position the load as described in
the loading guidelines.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could
be injured by the load being thrown around in
the event of sharp braking, a sudden change
in direction or an accident.
You will find further information in the "Securing a load" section.
Even if you follow all the loading guidelines,
the load will increase the risk of injury in the
event of an accident.
G WARNING
Keep the boot lid closed while the vehicle is
in operation. Otherwise, you could be poisoned by exhaust fumes entering the vehicle.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the
load within the vehicle. For this reason, you
should observe the following notes when
transporting a load:
Rwhen transporting a load, never exceed the
maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
or the permissible axle loads for the vehicle
(including occupants).
Rposition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the boot as possible.
Rthe load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways place the load against the rear or
front seat backrests. Make sure that the
seat backrests are securely locked into
place.
Ralways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
Rsecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant lashing material. pad sharp
edges for protection.
i Load restraints are available at any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Stowage compartments
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The stowage compartments must be closed
when items are stored in them. Luggage nets
are not designed to secure heavy items of
luggage.
You or other vehicle occupants could be
injured by objects being thrown around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Sharp-edged and fragile objects must not be
placed in the luggage net.
Do not place hard objects in the map pockets.
Objects must not protrude from the map
pockets.
Glove compartment
Spectacles compartment
To open: pull handle : and open glove
compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
There is a compartment to stow spectacles in
the roof lining on the driver's side.
X To open: pull down spectacles compartment : by the handle.
X
i The glove compartment can be ventilated
(Y page 137).
The glove compartment can only be locked
and unlocked using the emergency key element.
X To lock: insert the emergency key element
into the lock and turn it 90° clockwise to
position 2.
X To unlock: insert the emergency key element into the lock and turn it 90° anticlockwise to position 1.
Stowage compartments in the front
centre console
Front stowage compartment (except AMG vehicles)
To open: slide the cover forwards by handle : in the direction of the arrow until it
engages.
X To close: briefly press the front of handle :.
X
Z
273
Stowing and features
Stowage areas
Stowage areas
274
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment, a
Stowing and features
12 V socket, a USB port, and an AUX-IN
jack or a Media Interface are installed in the
stowage compartment. A Media Interface
is a universal interface for portable audio
equipment, e.g. for an iPod® or MP3 player
(see the separate Audio or COMAND Online
operating instructions).
Rear stowage compartment (except AMG vehicles)
X
Briefly press trim ; in the direction of the
arrow.
Cover : swings upwards.
Stowage compartment under the front
seats
G WARNING
Only load the stowage compartment with the
maximum permissible load of 1.5 kg. Otherwise, the transported load could, for example,
be thrown out of the stowage compartment if
you change direction suddenly or brake
sharply, and you or others could be injured.
AMG vehicles
X
Briefly press trim :.
i The stowage tray can be removed.
Stowage compartment/telephone
compartment under the armrest
X
To open: pull handle : up and fold
cover ; forwards.
i On vehicles with a fire extinguisher, the
fire extinguisher is located in the stowage
compartment under the driver's seat.
X
To open: pull handle : up.
The armrest folds out.
Stowage areas
Stowage compartments in the rear
centre console
275
Luggage nets are located in the frontpassenger footwell and on the left and righthand sides of the boot.
Through-loading facility in the rear
bench seat
G WARNING
X
To open: slide covers : and ; in the
direction of the arrow.
i There is a 12 V power socket in the front
stowage compartment.
Stowage compartment in the rear seat
armrest
Do not carry heavy or hard objects inside the
vehicle or in the boot unless they are secured.
Otherwise, you and other vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around the vehicle in the event of sharp braking, a sudden change in direction or an accident.
G WARNING
Always drive with the boot lid closed. Exhaust
fumes could otherwise enter the vehicle interior.
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded down separately to
increase the boot capacity.
Folding the seat backrest forwards
X
X
To open: fold down seat armrest ;.
Fold cover : of the armrest upwards.
Stowage nets
G WARNING
Only place lightweight items in the luggage
net. Do not use it to transport heavy, bulky,
sharp-edged or fragile objects. In the event of
an accident, the luggage net will not secure
the transported goods.
i Vehicles with memory function: when you
fold one or both parts of the rear seat backrest forwards, the respective front seat
moves forward slightly, when necessary, in
order to avoid contact.
Z
Stowing and features
Important safety notes
Stowage areas
276
Vehicles without memory function: if necessary, move the driver's or frontpassenger seat forwards.
X Open the boot.
X Pull right-hand or left-hand rear seat backrest release handle :.
The corresponding rear seat backrest is
released.
Stowing and features
X
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Fold rear seat backrest : back until it
engages.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
i You should always engage the rear seat
Fold rear seat backrest ; forwards.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Folding back the seat backrest
G WARNING
Make sure that the rear seat backrest is correctly engaged. Otherwise, vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
If the rear seat backrest is not engaged, this
will be shown in the multifunction display in
the instrument cluster.
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
backrests if you do not need the throughloading feature. This will prevent unauthorised access to the boot from the vehicle
interior.
Securing a load
Lashing eyelets
General notes
G WARNING
Distribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could be
injured by objects being thrown around if you:
Rbrake
sharply
direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Please observe the loading guidelines.
Rchange
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
Rsecure
the load using the lashing eyelets.
not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load, as these are only intended as an
anti-slip protection for light loads.
Rdo
Stowage areas
edges or corners.
Rpad sharp edges for protection.
Boot
: Lashing eyelets
There are six lashing eyelets in the boot.
EASY-PACK boot box
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Only load the EASY-PACK convenience box to
the maximum permissible load of 10 kg. To
prevent overloading, the floor of the box
moves down onto the boot floor mat when
loaded with more than approx. 5 kg.
Do not transport sharp-edged and fragile
objects in the box.
Otherwise, e.g. in the event of a rapid change
of direction or heavy braking, the objects
could be thrown out of the EASY-PACK convenience box and injure you and others.
! When the EASY-PACK convenience box is
pulled out, no objects may be placed on the
frame of the box or pushed onto the frame
from above. Otherwise, the box could be
damaged.
Bag hook
G WARNING
Only hang light loads on the bag holders. Do
not use them to transport heavy, sharp-edged
or fragile objects. When braking sharply,
changing direction quickly or in the event of
an accident, the bag hooks will not secure the
items sufficiently. This could result in injury to
yourself or others.
Adjusting the height to any position
G WARNING
Make sure that your hands are not inside the
EASY-PACK convenience box when the load
surface moves up. Otherwise, you could be
injured.
! The bag hook can bear a maximum load
of 3 kg. Do not use it to secure a load.
Pull the box out by handle : in the direction of the arrow all the way to the stop.
X Lowering the load surface: push the
centre of load surface ; down by hand in
the direction of the arrow until load surX
X
Pull bag hook ; down by tab :.
Z
Stowing and features
Rdo not route lashing materials across sharp
277
Stowage areas
278
Stowing and features
face ; has reached the desired position
and the box is the desired size.
X To raise the load surface: press switch
=.
Load surface ; of the box moves up automatically.
X To stow the box: push the box in by handle : all the way to the stop.
i Store the EASY-PACK boot box on a flat
surface after removal, e.g. on a suitable
shelf.
Stowage well under the boot floor
! Remove the handle again before closing
the boot lid and snap it in tightly to prevent
the handle flap from protruding. Otherwise,
you could damage the handle.
Removing and fitting
X
To install: insert retainer ; of box : into
slots =
Raise box : and press hooks A into
anchorage ? as far as they will go.
X Turn left-hand rotating catch B clockwise
and right-hand rotating catch B anti-clockwise by 90°.
X To remove: turn left-hand rotating catch
B anti-clockwise and right-hand rotating
catch B clockwise by 90°.
X Move box : downwards and pull it out
from anchorages ?.
X
The TIREFIT kit, the vehicle tool kit, etc. are
located in the stowage compartment.
X To open: pull handle : up.
X
Hook handle : into rain trough ;.
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An incorrectly secured roof carrier, ski rack or
load could become detached from the vehicle. These objects might then be thrown
Features
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use roof carriers that have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Position the load on the roof carrier in such
a way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion.
Ensure that, depending on the vehicle's
equipment, you can raise the sliding sunroof fully and open the boot lid fully when
the roof carrier is fitted.
! To avoid damaging or scratching the covers, do not use metallic or hard objects to
open them.
Attaching the roof carrier
Open covers : carefully in the direction of
the arrow.
X Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
X
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Keep the cup holder closed while the vehicle
is in motion. Otherwise, vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Only use the cup holders for containers of a
suitable size and which have lids. The drinks
could otherwise spill.
Cup holders should not be used for hot drinks.
You may otherwise scald yourself.
Cup holder in the front centre console
All vehicles (except AMG)
X
X
To open: press the front of cover ;.
To remove the insert: slide catch :
inwards on both sides in the direction of the
arrow.
Z
Stowing and features
around, and could injure you or others or
cause an accident. Follow the roof carrier/ski
rack manufacturer's installation instructions
and special instructions for use.
The roof load raises the vehicle's centre of
gravity, thereby affecting vehicle handling.
You must always observe the maximum roof
load of 100 kg. Always adapt your driving style
to the prevailing road, traffic and weather
conditions and drive with particular care if the
roof is laden.
279
Features
280
Remove cup holder insert = upwards.
X To refit the insert: place the insert in the
stowage space.
X Slide catch : outwards in the direction of
the arrow until it engages.
Stowing and features
X
To open: slide cover : forwards.
X To remove the insert: slide catch ;
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove cup holder insert = upwards.
X To refit the insert: place the insert in the
stowage space.
X Slide catch ; outwards in the direction of
the arrow until it engages.
X
You can remove the insert and the rubber mat
of the cup holder to clean them. Clean them
with clean, lukewarm water only.
Cup holder in the rear seat armrest
! Do not sit on or support your body weight
AMG vehicles
: Cup holders
; Cover
X
on the rear seat armrest when it is folded
down, as you could otherwise damage it.
! Close the cup holder before folding the
rear seat armrest up. Otherwise, the cup
holder could be damaged.
To open: slide cover ; to its foremost
position.
You can remove the cup holder insert to clean
it. Clean it with clean, lukewarm water only.
AMG vehicles: you can remove the rubber
mat of the cup holder in the direction of the
arrow to clean it. Clean it with clean, lukewarm water only.
Cup holder in the rear-compartment
centre console
Fold down the rear seat armrest.
To open: raise the rear seat armrest cover.
X Press release catch :.
Cup holder ; folds out forwards.
X Fold the cover of the rear seat armrest back
down again if necessary.
X To close: lift the cover of the rear seat armrest.
Swing cup holder ; back until it engages.
X
X
Features
281
Bottle holders
G WARNING
Do not transport heavy, sharp-edged and fragile bottles in the bottle holder. In the event of
an accident, the bottle holder can not secure
the bottles adequately.
than 0.5 kg that are stored in the bottle
holder rest on the vehicle floor. The bottle
holder could otherwise be damaged.
: Mirror light
; Bracket
= Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
? Vanity mirror
A Mirror cover
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover
A has been folded up.
Press the outer edge of button : and slide
in the direction of the arrow until the bottle
fits into the opening.
X Insert the bottle into the bottle holder.
X
Glare from the side
The bottle holder is suitable for bottles with a
capacity from 0.7 l to 1.5 l.
The bottle holder does not secure bottles; it
merely prevents them from tipping over.
Sun visors
Overview
G WARNING
Keep the vanity mirrors in the sun visors covered while driving. You could otherwise be
dazzled, which may impair your view of traffic
conditions and as a result could cause an
accident.
Fold down sun visor :.
Pull sun visor : out of retainer ;.
X Swing sun visor : to the side.
X Slide sun visor : horizontally as required.
X
X
Z
Stowing and features
! Make sure that any bottles weighing more
Features
282
Rear-window roller sunblind
Extending/retracting the roller sunblind
! Make sure that the roller sunblind can
Stowing and features
move freely. Otherwise, the roller sunblind
or other objects could be damaged.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 141).
X To extend or retract: briefly press button :.
The roller sunblind fully extends or fully
retracts.
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X To remove the insert: hold insert = by
the indentation at the sides and lift it
up ; and out.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X To close: briefly press cover : at the
front.
The cover moves back.
X
X
Ashtray
Front ashtray
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the
ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the
stowage space could be damaged.
AMG vehicles
To open: briefly press the trim on
cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X To remove the insert: slide insert ; forwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove insert ;.
X To refit the insert: place the insert into the
holder and press it in the opposite direction
of the arrow until it engages.
X To close: fold down cover :.
X
i You can remove the ashtray insert and
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
All vehicles (except AMG)
Features
To open: slide cover ; forwards.
To remove the insert: pull insert : up
and out.
X To fit the insert: fit insert : from above
into the holder and press down into the
holder until it engages.
Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X To close: briefly press cover : at the
front.
The cover moves back.
X
X
X
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
Only hold the hot cigarette lighter by its knob.
Otherwise, you might burn yourself.
Make sure that children travelling in the vehicle are not able to injure themselves on the
hot cigarette lighter or cause a fire with it.
AMG vehicles
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 141).
X To open: briefly press the trim on
cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X
12 V sockets
General notes
X
All vehicles (except AMG)
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 141).
X To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X
Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 141).
The sockets can be used for accessories with
a maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories include such items as lamps or chargers
for mobile phones.
If you use the sockets for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
i An emergency cut-off ensures that the on-
board voltage does not drop too low. If the
on-board voltage is too low, the power to
the sockets is automatically cut. This
Z
Stowing and features
Rear-compartment ashtray
283
Features
284
ensures that there is sufficient power to
start the engine.
Stowing and features
Socket under the armrest
AMG vehicles
To open: briefly press the trim on
cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: fold down cover :.
X
Open the stowage space under the armrest
(Y page 274).
X Lift up the cover of socket :.
X
Socket in the front centre console
Socket in the rear-compartment centre
console
All vehicles (except AMG)
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: briefly press cover : at the
front.
The cover moves back.
X
X
X
Slide cover ; forwards.
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Mobile phone
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Observe the legal requirements of the country
in which you are currently driving regarding
operating mobile communications equipment
in a vehicle.
Features
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you must only do so if the traffic situation permits. Otherwise, you could be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause an
accident and injure yourself and others.
Two-way radios and fax equipment used without low-reflection exterior aerials can interfere with the vehicle's electronics and thereby
jeopardise the operating safety of the vehicle
and your safety. Therefore, you must only use
this equipment if it is correctly connected to
a separate reflection-free exterior aerial.
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones with
Audio 20, Audio 50 or COMAND Online can
be obtained:
G WARNING
If the mobile phone is inserted in the mobile
phone bracket, you can speak to the person
you are calling using the hands-free system.
X Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 274).
X If required by the design of the mobile
phone bracket, install the sliding adapter
(Y page 286).
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket (see the separate installation instructions for the mobile phone fitting).
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal
mobile phone reception quality in
the vehicle
Rmutual influences between the vehicle
electronics and mobile phones are minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields gen-
erated by a wireless device to the exterior.
field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have
an exterior aerial.
Rthe
i There are various mobile phone brackets
that may be fitted in your vehicle; in some
cases, these are country-specific.
i You can connect a Bluetooth®-capable
mobile phone with Audio 20, Audio 50 or
COMAND Online via the Bluetooth® interface. This also applies if your vehicle is
equipped with convenience telephony.
Rat
your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
Ron
i The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Using a mobile phone
i On some mobile phone brackets, you first
have to connect the mobile phone via Bluetooth® to the mobile phone bracket (see
the separate operating instructions for the
mobile phone bracket).
If this is the case, the mobile phone does
not have to be inserted into the bracket for
you to be able to use the telephone functions. However, the charging function and
aerial function are not available.
Operating the mobile phone
You can operate the telephone using the
6 and ~ buttons on the multifunction
steering wheel. You can operate other mobile
phone functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 217).
When you remove the key from the ignition
lock, the mobile phone stays switched on.
Z
Stowing and features
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and the
health of others. Using an exterior aerial takes
into account current scientific discussions
relating to the possible health risk posed by
electromagnetic fields.
285
286
Features
However, you can no longer use the handsfree system.
If you have an active call and would like to
take the key out of the ignition lock, first
remove the mobile phone from the bracket.
Certain mobile phone brackets require a sliding adapter so the bracket can be installed
correctly.
Fitting the sliding adapter
Stowing and features
i When using a bracket connected to the
mobile phone via Bluetooth® and you wish
to proceed with a call:
Switch to private mode before removing
the key from the ignition lock. Otherwise, it
may take up to 20 seconds, before the
mobile phone separates from the system.
Only then can the telephone call continue.
Information on the necessary steps for setting up "private mode" can be found in the
separate mobile phone operating instructions.
i Not all mobile phones support "private
mode".
Sliding adapter for the mobile phone
bracket
Overview
Insert sliding adapter : by aligning the
openings with lugs ; of contact plate =.
X Attach the mobile phone bracket to sliding
adapter :; see the separate mobile phone
bracket fitting instructions.
X Press both release buttons ? and press
sliding adapter : with the mobile phone
bracket down until it engages.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate mobile
phone bracket installation instructions.
X
Removing the sliding adapter
: Previous model: example of a mobile
phone bracket
; New model: example of a mobile phone
bracket
= Sliding adapter
i The sliding adapter for the mobile phone
bracket is only available for automatic vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever.
Remove the mobile phone from its bracket;
see the separate mobile phone bracket fitting instructions.
X Press both release buttons ; and press
sliding adapter : with the mobile phone
bracket upwards until it disengages.
X
Features
287
Remove the mobile phone bracket from
sliding adapter :; see the separate mobile
phone bracket fitting instructions.
X Detach sliding adapter : using suitable
tool = and remove.
X
Important safety notes
The HomeLink® garage door opener integrated in the rear-view mirror allows you to operate up to three different door and gate systems.
i The garage door opener is only available
for certain countries. Observe the legal
requirements for each individual country.
The HomeLink® garage door opener is
compatible with most European garage and
gate opener drives. More information on
HomeLink® and/or compatible products is
available from:
Rat a qualified specialised workshop
Rthe HomeLink® hotline
(0) 08000 466 354 65 (free of charge) or
+49 (0) 6838 907 277 (charges apply)
Ron the Internet at:
http://www.homelink.com
Programming
Programming buttons
G WARNING
Only press the button on the integrated
garage door opener if there are no persons or
objects present within the sweep of the
garage door. Persons could otherwise be
injured as the door moves.
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Garage door remote control A is not part of
the integrated garage door opener.
X Before programming for the first time, clear
the memory of the integrated garage door
opener (Y page 289).
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press and hold one of buttons ; to ? on
the integrated garage door opener.
After a short time, indicator lamp : lights
up yellow.
i Indicator lamp : lights up yellow as soon
as button ;, = or ? is programmed for
the first time. If the selected button has
already been programmed, indicator
lamp : will only light up yellow after ten
seconds have elapsed.
Release button ;, = or ?. Indicator
lamp : flashes yellow.
X Point garage door remote control A
towards buttons ; to ? on the rear-view
mirror at a distance of 5to 20 cm.
i The required distance between remote
control A and the integrated garage door
opener depends on the garage door drive
system. Several attempts may be required.
You should test every position for at least
25 seconds before trying another position.
X
Z
Stowing and features
Garage door opener
Features
288
Press and hold button B on remote control
A until indicator lamp : lights up green.
If indicator lamp : lights up green or
flashes, then programming has been successful.
X Release button B of garage door drive
remote control A.
X If indicator lamp : lights up red: repeat
the programming procedure for the corresponding button on the rear-view mirror.
When doing so, vary the distance between
remote control A and the rear-view mirror.
Stowing and features
X
i If the indicator lamp flashes green after
successful programming, the garage door
system is using a rolling code. After programming, you must synchronise the
garage door opener integrated in the rearview mirror with the receiver of the garage
door system.
Synchronising the rolling code
Your vehicle must be within range of the
garage door or exterior gate drive. Make sure
that neither your vehicle nor any persons/
objects are present within the sweep of the
door or gate.
Observe the safety notes when performing
the rolling code synchronisation.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the programming button of the door
or gate drive (see the door or gate drive
operating instructions, e.g. under "Programming of additional remote controls").
i Usually, you now have 30seconds to initiate the next step.
X
Press previously programmed button ;,
= or ? of the integrated garage door
opener until the door closes.
The rolling code synchronisation is then
complete.
Problems when programming
If you have problems when programming the
integrated garage door opener, please note
the following:
RCheck
the transmitter frequency of garage
door drive remote control A. This can usually be found on the back of the remote
control.
RReplace the batteries in garage door
remote control A. This increases the likelihood that garage door remote control A
will transmit a strong and precise signal to
the integrated garage door opener in the
rear-view mirror.
RWhen programming, hold remote control
A at varying distances and angles from the
button which you are programming. Try various angles at a distance between 5and
30 cm or at the same angle but at varying
distances.
RIf there is another remote control for the
same garage door drive, perform the programming steps again using this remote
control. Before performing these steps,
make sure that new batteries have been
fitted in garage door drive remote control
A.
RNote that some remote controls transmit
only for a limited period (the indicator lamp
on the remote control goes out). Press button B on remote control A again before
transmission ends.
RAlign the aerial cable of the garage door
opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission.
Opening or closing the garage door
Once programmed, the integrated garage
door opener will assume the function of the
garage door system's remote control. Please
also read the operating instructions for the
garage door system.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press button ;, = or ? which you have
programmed to operate the garage door.
Garage door system with a fixed code: indicator lamp : lights up green.
Garage door system with a rolling code:
indicator lamp : flashes green.
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
BG (Bulgaria)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 12 April
07
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
i The transmitter will transmit a signal for
CH (Switzer- Article 6 of Directive
land)
1999/5/EC R&TTE14357
27 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
X
as long as the button is pressed. The transmission is halted after a maximum of ten
seconds and indicator lamp : lights up
yellow. Press button ;, = or ? again if
necessary.
CY (Cyprus)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 5 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CZ (Czech
Republic)
General Licence GL-30/R/
2000 Reg. No. 844 13 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433
DK (Denmark)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 20 April
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
DE (Germany)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC
R&TTE7519301 29 April 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
EE (Estonia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
ES (Spain)
000438/2005,
000439/2005,
000440/2005
000441/2005,
000445/2005,
000446/2005
000447/2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Clearing the memory
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press buttons ; and ?.
The indicator lamp lights up yellow.
X Press and hold buttons ; and ? until the
indicator lamp turns green.
X
i Make sure that you clear the memory of
the integrated garage door opener before
selling the vehicle.
Frequencies
Europe
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AD (Andorra) 20 July
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
AT (Austria)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
BE (Belgium) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Z
289
Stowing and features
Features
Stowing and features
290
Features
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
FI (Finland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IS (Iceland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
FR (France)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE10668
13 May 05
27, 30, 40, 433, 868
IT (Italy)
DGPGSR/II/347487/
FOR/15347
DGPGSR/II/347487/
FOR/15348
DGPGSR/II/347487/
FOR/15350
DGPGSR/II/347487/
FOR/15357
DGPGSR/II/347487/
FOR/15358
DGPGSR/II/347487/
FOR/15359
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
GI (Gibraltar) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE13 May
05 (UK)
MHz: 27, 40, 418, 433, 868
GR (Greece)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC
R&TTE11409/18/4/2005
18 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
HR (Croatia)
SDR 224/06
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
HU (Hungary)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IC (Canary
Islands)
000438/2005,
000439/2005
000440/2005,
000441/2005
000445/2005,
000446/2005
000447/2005, 3rd June
2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
IE (Ireland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LI (Liechten- Article 6 of Directive
stein)
1999/5/EC R&TTE 14357
27 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LT (Lithuania)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC
R&TTE27.4-1B-1609 6 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LU (Luxembourg)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC
R&TTE150405/9538 24
May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
LV (Latvia)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
27.4-1B-1609 26 April 06
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Features
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Country
MC (Monaco)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
SI (Slovenia) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
500-1/2005-437 9 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
MT (Malta)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
SK (Slovakia)
NL (Netherlands)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
Slovak
206/11/2005 4 May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
UK (United
Kingdom)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 418, 433, 868
NO (Norway) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC
R&TTE05/02424-SA644 18
May 05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
PL (Poland)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 21 April
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
PT (Portugal) ANCOM-S08399/05
27, 40, 433, 868
RO (Romania)
RU (Russian
Federation)
Article 6.4 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
POCC DE.MJ05.H00015 13
May 05
MHz: 433
SE (Sweden) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 18 May
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
Africa
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
EG (Egypt)
W-KLE-17/08 Mar. 06
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 418, 433,
868
RE (Réunion) Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 July
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
ZA (South
Africa)
11 October 2005
MHz: 27, 40, 433
America
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
BB (Barbados)
Registration not required
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
CL (Chile)
38447/F-23 No.3.3634
MHz: 40, 433
Z
Stowing and features
Country
291
292
Features
Stowing and features
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
GF (French
Guyana)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
GP (Guadeloupe)
Article 6 of Directive
1999/5/EC R&TTE10668
13 May 05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
MQ (Martini- Article 6 of Directive
que)
1999/5/EC R&TTE 11 July
05
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
MX (Mexico) MHz: 280 to 390
Asia
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AE (United
Arab Emirates)
1623/5/10-2/26/76
MHz: 433
JO (Jordan)
TRC/LPD/2005/23
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
KW (Kuwait)
5 October 2005
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 418, 433,
868
LB (Lebanon)
2920/O&M/2006 / 3 July
05
MHz: 27, 40, 433, 868
SA (Saudi
Arabia)
11_02_05/5024-5-6
MHz: 418, 433
SY (Syria)
279/4/14 / 05 March 06
TR (Turkey)
National Certification 23
July 07
MHz: 433
Australia
Country
Radio type approval number
Frequency range (MHz)
AU (Australia)
28 June
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433, 868
NZ (New
Zealand)
20 March 06
MHz: 27, 30, 40, 433
Floormat on the driver's side
G WARNING
Make sure that there is sufficient clearance
around the pedals when floormats are used,
and that the floormats are properly secured.
The floormats must be correctly secured at all
times using the securing knob and retainers.
Before you drive off, check the floormats and
secure them if necessary. A floormat which is
not properly secured can slip and thereby
interfere with the movement of the pedals.
Do not place floormats on top of one another.
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: lay the floormat in the footwell.
X Press studs : onto retainers ;.
X To remove: pull the floormat from retainers ;.
X Remove the floormats.
X
X
Features
293
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Stowing and features
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile
telephone reception. This is particularly the
case for conductive or metallic-coated films.
You can obtain information about anti-glare
film from a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
294
295
296
296
300
301
Maintenance and care
Useful information ............................
Engine compartment ........................
Service ...............................................
Care ....................................................
296
Engine compartment
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
Maintenance and care
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 23).
Engine compartment
Bonnet
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Do not pull the release lever while the vehicle
is in motion. If you do so, the bonnet may open
up and block your view.
G WARNING
There is a risk of injury if the bonnet is open,
even if the engine is not running.
Some engine components can become very
hot.
To avoid the risk of burns, only touch those
components described in the Owner's Manual
and observe the relevant safety notes.
G WARNING
The radiator fan between the radiator and the
engine can start automatically, even if the key
has been removed from the ignition lock. For
this reason, you must not reach into the fan
rotation area. You could otherwise be injured.
Vehicles with a petrol engine: The electronic ignition system uses high voltage. For
this reason, you must never touch ignition
system components (ignition coil, ignition
cables, spark plug connectors or test socket)
while:
Rthe
engine is running
engine is being started
Rthe ignition is switched on and the engine
is being cranked by hand
You could otherwise suffer an electric shock
and be seriously or even fatally injured.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: The electronic injection control uses high voltage. For
this reason, you must never touch injection
system components while:
Rthe
Rthe
engine is running
engine is being started
Rthe ignition is switched on
You could otherwise suffer an electric shock
and be seriously or even fatally injured.
Rthe
G WARNING
The windscreen wipers and wiper linkage
could be set in motion.
When the bonnet is open, you or others could
be injured by the wiper linkage.
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off. Remove the key or make sure
that no ignition position has been selected
with KEYLESS-GO. All indicator lamps must be
off in the instrument panel.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen
wipers or the bonnet.
Engine compartment
297
Radiator
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
X
Engine oil
General notes
Depending on your driving style, the vehicle
consumes up to 0.8 l of oil per 1,000 km. The
oil consumption may be higher than this when
the vehicle is new or if you frequently drive at
high engine speeds.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may
be installed at a different location.
When checking the oil level:
Rpark
the vehicle on a level surface.
engine should be switched off for
approximately five minutes if the engine is
at normal operating temperature.
Rif the engine is not at normal operating
temperature, e.g. if the engine was only
started briefly: wait about 30 minutes
before carrying out the measurement.
Rthe
X
Reach into the gap, pull bonnet catch handle ; up and lift the bonnet.
If you lift the bonnet by approximately
40 cm, the bonnet is opened and held open
automatically by the gas-filled strut.
Closing the bonnet
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as you close the bonnet.
Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Open it again and close
it with a little more force.
X
Z
Maintenance and care
Vehicles with a diesel engine: do not cover
the radiator. Do not use thermal mats, insect
protection covers or anything similar. Doing
so can cause the Onboard Diagnostics System to display inaccurate values. Some of
these values are legally required and must
always be correct.
Engine compartment
298
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
Maintenance and care
! Only use engine oils and oil filters that
have been approved for vehicles with a
service system. You can obtain a list of the
engine oils and oil filters tested and
approved in accordance with the
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service
Products at any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Damage to the engine or exhaust system is
caused by the following:
Example: vehicles with a petrol engine
Rusing
engine oils and oil filters that have
not been specifically approved for the
service system
Rchanging the engine oil and oil filter after
missing the change interval required by
the service system
Rusing engine oil additives
! Do not add too much oil. Topping up with
too much engine oil can result in damage
to the engine or to the catalytic converter.
Have excess engine oil siphoned off.
Example: vehicles with a diesel engine
Pull oil dipstick : out of the oil dipstick
tube.
X Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide
tube to the stop, and take it out again.
If the level is between MIN mark = and
MAX mark ;, the oil level is correct.
X If the oil level has dropped to MIN mark
= or below, add 1.0 litre of engine oil.
X
Adding engine oil
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot
engine parts, it may ignite and you could burn
yourself. Do not spill any engine oil on hot
engine parts.
Example: engine oil filler cap
X
X
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
Top up the engine oil.
If the oil level is at or below the MIN mark
on the oil dipstick, add 1.0 litre of engine
oil.
Engine compartment
For further information on engine oil, see
(Y page 363).
Other service products
Checking the coolant level
G WARNING
The cooling system is pressurised. Therefore,
only unscrew the cap once the engine has
cooled down. The coolant temperature gauge
must display less than 70 † . Otherwise, you
could be scalded if hot coolant escapes.
Slowly turn cap : half a turn anti-clockwise to allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap : further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar
= in the filler neck when cold, there is
enough coolant in coolant expansion
tank ;.
If the coolant level is approximately
1.5 cm above marker bar = in the filler
neck when warm, there is enough coolant
in coolant expansion tank ;.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
X
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 365).
Topping up the windscreen washer system/headlamp cleaning system
G WARNING
Windscreen washer fluid/antifreeze is highly
flammable. Avoid spilling windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze on hot engine components as
it can ignite and burn. Severe burns could be
the result.
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Only check the coolant level if the vehicle
is on a level surface and the engine has
cooled down.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock (Y page 141).
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button twice (Y page 141).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
70 †.
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 141) in
the ignition lock.
X
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
X
Z
Maintenance and care
Replace cap : on the filler neck and turn
clockwise.
Make sure that the cap locks securely into
place.
X Check the oil level again with the oil dipstick (Y page 298).
X
299
300
Service
The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the
windscreen washer system and the headlamp
cleaning system.
Further information on windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 366).
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
X
Note down the service due date displayed
in the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
Service
X
Maintenance and care
ASSYST PLUS
Service messages
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
Information on the type of service and service
intervals (see separate Service Booklet).
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not show any information on the
engine oil level. Observe the notes on the
engine oil level (Y page 297).
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.:
Next service A in .. days
Service A due
Service A overdue by ... days
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter. This figure indicates
any necessary additional maintenance work
to be performed.
If you notify a qualified specialist workshop of
this display, you will receive a statement on
the associated costs.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
After reconnecting the battery, subtract
the battery disconnection periods from the
service date shown on the display.
Hiding a service message
X
Press the % or a button on the steering wheel.
Displaying service messages
Switch the ignition on.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm with
a.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Information about Service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service interval display
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval display has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Have service work carried out as described
in the Service Booklet. This may otherwise
lead to increased wear and damage to the
major assemblies or the vehicle.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after
the service work has been carried out. You
can also obtain further information on maintenance work, for example.
Care
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. The
Service Hotline's current telephone numbers
for use when you are abroad are to be found
in the "Mercedes-Benz Service24h" section
of the Service Booklet.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Washing the vehicle and cleaning the
paintwork
Automatic car wash
G WARNING
Care
Braking efficiency is reduced after washing
the vehicle. This could cause an accident. For
this reason, following a car wash, drive with
particular care until the brakes are dry.
General notes
G WARNING
H Environmental note
The vehicle is braked when the HOLD function
or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Therefore,
deactivate the HOLD function and DISTRONIC
PLUS before the vehicle is washed in an automatic car wash.
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
Rabrasive cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
! Make sure that:
Rthe side windows and sliding sunroof are
closed completely.
blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off (OFF button is depressed).
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position 0.
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Rthe
! In car washes with a towing mechanism,
make sure that the automatic transmission
is in transmission position N, otherwise the
vehicle could be damaged.
Z
Maintenance and care
Special service requirements
Arduous operating conditions or increased
loads on the vehicle will require some service
work to be performed more often than for a
vehicle in normal use. Such arduous conditions include regular city driving with frequent
intermediate stops and use in mountainous
terrain or on poor road surfaces.
For example, if the vehicle is used under arduous operating conditions, have air filters,
engine oil and oil filters changed frequently
and check the wheels often. Further information can be obtained at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
301
302
Care
Maintenance and care
RVehicles
with a key:
do not remove the key from the ignition
lock. Do not open the driver's door or
front-passenger door when the engine is
switched off. Otherwise, the automatic
transmission selects park position P
automatically and locks the wheels. You
can prevent this by shifting the automatic transmission to N beforehand.
RVehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
do not open the driver's door or frontpassenger door when the engine is
switched off. Otherwise, the automatic
transmission selects park position P
automatically and locks the wheels.
Observe the following to make sure that the
automatic transmission stays in position N:
X Make sure the vehicle is stationary and the
ignition is switched off.
X Turn the key to position 2(Y page 141) in
the ignition lock.
Use the key instead of the Start/Stop button on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
Wash off excess dirt before cleaning the vehicle in an automatic car wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windscreen and the wiper
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
wiping noises caused by residue on the windscreen.
Washing by hand
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at specially equipped washing bays.
Observe the legal requirements for each individual country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a
gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards
the air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the
sponge frequently.
X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the
paintwork.
When using the vehicle in winter, remove all
traces of road salt deposits carefully and as
soon as possible.
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G WARNING
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) to clean your
vehicle, in particular the tyres. You could otherwise damage the tyres and cause an accident.
! Always maintain a distance of at least
30 cm between the vehicle and the highpressure cleaner nozzle. Information about
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Relectrical
Care
Rtrim
elements
Rventilation slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Cleaning the paintwork
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork
shiny.
! The following may cause the paint to
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
RVigorous
rubbing with unsuitable materials.
RFrequent use of car washes.
RWashing the vehicle in direct sunlight.
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matt finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs performed
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a
clear matt finish. This will help you to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
treatment.
These notes also apply to light-alloy wheels
with a clear matt finish.
i The vehicle should preferably be washed
by hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo
and plenty of water.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of recommended and
approved Mercedes-Benz care products.
Cleaning vehicle parts
Cleaning the wheels
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Z
Maintenance and care
Rseals
303
Care
304
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
Maintenance and care
Switch off the windscreen wipers and remove
the key from the ignition lock before cleaning
the windscreen or the wiper blades. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop
button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster have gone off. The
windscreen wipers could otherwise move and
injure you.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows.
Do not touch the insides of the windows
with hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or
ring. There is otherwise a risk of damaging
the windows.
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Carefully clean the wiper blades with a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
X
Cleaning the exterior lighting
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the exterior lighting.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
X
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G WARNING
Switch off the windscreen wipers and remove
the key from the ignition lock before cleaning
the windscreen or the wiper blades. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop
button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster have gone off. The
windscreen wipers could otherwise move and
injure you.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
Mirror turn signal
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the mirror turn signals.
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn
signals in the exterior mirror housing using
a wet sponge and mild cleaning agent, e.g.
Mercedes-Benz car shampoo or cleaning
cloths.
Cleaning the sensors
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pressure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
Care
305
pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in winter and after washing.
X Clean the exhaust pipe with a chrome care
product tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
Interior care
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Rabrasive
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the reversing camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a highpressure cleaner.
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfibre cloth and TFT/
LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre cloth.
X
Cleaning Night View Assist Plus
! Never clean the camera lens. When cleanX
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens :.
ing the field of vision of the driving systems,
make sure that you do not spray glass
cleaner on the camera lens. If the camera
lens is dirty, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
! Do not clean the exhaust pipe with alka-
line-based cleaning agents, such as wheel
cleaner.
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
Z
Maintenance and care
Cleaning the display
Care
306
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.
Maintenance and care
X
X
Fold down the camera cover by recess :.
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
X
Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use
leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning wooden trim and trim elements
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
X
Use a soft cloth to clean the windscreen in
front of camera ;.
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
When cleaning the steering wheel boss and
dashboard, do not use cockpit sprays or
cleaning agents containing solvents. Cleaning
agents containing solvents cause the surface
to become porous, and as a result plastic
parts may break away and be thrown around
the interior when an airbag is deployed, which
may result in severe injuries.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented
oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come in contact with the
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
Wipe the wooden trim and trim elements
with a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Cleaning the seat covers
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Rclean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth. Make sure that
the leather does not become soaked. It
may otherwise become rough and
cracked. Only use leather care agents
that have been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. You can obtain these
from a qualified specialist workshop.
Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing
1 % detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Care
307
Rclean cloth covers with a microfibre cloth
Maintenance and care
moistened with a solution containing
1 % detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Rub carefully, and always wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines. Leave the seat to dry afterwards.
Cleaning results depend on the type of
dirt and how long it has been there.
Rclean DINAMICA covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure that you wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines.
! Do not use microfibre cloths to clean gen-
uine leather, artificial leather or DINAMICA
covers. If used often, these can damage the
cover.
i Note that regular care is essential to
make sure that the appearance and comfort of the covers are retained over time.
Cleaning the seat belts
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts
at temperatures above 80 † or in direct
sunlight.
X
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
Cleaning the roof lining and carpets
Roof lining: if it is very dirty, use a soft
brush or dry shampoo.
X Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Z
308
309
310
310
312
316
319
320
324
Breakdown assistance
Useful information ............................
Where will I find...? ...........................
Flat tyre .............................................
Battery (vehicle) ................................
Jump-starting ....................................
Towing and tow-starting ..................
Electrical fuses .................................
Where will I find...?
310
Useful information
Setting up the warning triangle
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Breakdown assistance
ist workshops: (Y page 23).
: Press-stud
; Reflectors
Where will I find...?
Warning triangle
Removing the warning triangle
= Feet
X
X
Fold feet = down and out to the side.
Pull side reflectors ; upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
upper press-stud :.
First-aid kit
X
X
Open the boot lid.
Turn catch 90° in the direction of the arrow
and remove warning triangle :.
Open the boot lid.
Slide the stowage net down.
X Open the stowage compartment.
X Loosen tensioning strap :.
X Remove first-aid kit ;.
X
X
i Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit
at least once a year. Replace the contents
if necessary, and replace any missing
items.
Where will I find...?
Necessary wheel-changing tools can
include, for example:
Fire extinguisher
! Keep the stowage compartment closed
Rjack
while the vehicle is in motion. It may otherwise be damaged.
Pull handle : upward and fold cover ;
forward.
X Remove the fire extinguisher from the
stowage compartment.
Rwheel
Rwheel
chock
wrench
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit
X
i Have fire extinguisher ; refilled after
each use and checked every one to two
years. It may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements for each
individual country.
: Towing eye
; Tyre sealant filler bottle
= Tyre inflation compressor
? Fuse allocation chart
X
X
Open the boot lid.
Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 278).
Vehicles with a "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
Vehicle tool kit
General notes
The vehicle tool kit can be found in the stowage well under the boot floor.
i Apart from certain country-specific varia-
tions, vehicles are not equipped with a tyrechange tool kit. Some tools for changing a
wheel are specific to the vehicle. For more
information on which tools are required to
perform a wheel change on your vehicle,
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
: Vehicle tool kit tray
; Stowage tray
= "Minispare" emergency spare wheel
Open the boot lid.
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 278).
X
Breakdown assistance
The fire extinguisher is located in the stowage
compartment underneath the driver's seat.
311
Flat tyre
312
The vehicle tool kit contains:
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
RFoldable
RMOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat char-
RFuse
wheel chock
allocation chart
RJack
RCentring
pin
pair of gloves
RWheel wrench
RTowing eye
ROne
Breakdown assistance
Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel (AMG vehicles)
: Towing eye
; One pair of gloves
= Jack
? Folding wheel chock
A Centring pin
B Sheet for faulty wheel
C Tyre inflation compressor
D Wheel wrench
E Fuse allocation chart
X
X
Open the boot lid.
Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 278).
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Information on changing a wheel/fitting
(Y page 336).
Vehicle preparation is not necessary on vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
acteristics) (Y page 313)
TIREFIT kit (Y page 313)
Ran emergency spare wheel (only for certain
countries) (Y page 351)
X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible
from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Bring the front wheels into the straightahead position.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Vehicles with AIRMATIC: make sure that
"normal" level is selected (Y page 181).
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics have status 0,
which is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 141).
X All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area while a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle a suitable distance away (Y page 310). Observe legal
requirements.
Ra
Flat tyre
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving manoeuvres, and driving over obstacles (kerbs, potholes, off-road). This applies in particular to a
laden vehicle.
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Ryou
hear banging noises.
Rthe vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
workshop with regard to their further use. The
faulty tyre must be replaced.
Rthere
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an active tyre pressure loss
warning system or with an active tyre pressure monitor.
The maximum driving distance is approximately 80 km when the vehicle is partially
laden, and approximately 30 km when the
vehicle is fully laden.
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible depends upon:
Rspeed
Rroad
condition
temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/manoeuvres, or it can be increased
through a moderate style of driving.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
the moment the tyre pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
i When replacing one or all tyres, make
sure that you only use tyres marked
"MOExtended". Make sure that you only
use the size of tyre specified for the vehicle.
TIREFIT kit
Using the TIREFIT kit
TIREFIT is a tyre sealant.
You can use TIREFIT to seal punctures of up
to 4 mm, particularly those in the tyre tread.
You can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures
down to Ò20 †.
G WARNING
In the following situations, the tyre sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance, as it is unable to seal the tyre properly:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
larger than those mentioned above.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
There is a risk of accident.
Do not drive any further. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
G WARNING
The tyre sealant is harmful and causes irritation. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing or be swallowed. Do not
inhale TIREFIT fumes. Keep tyre sealant away
from children. There is a risk of injury.
Routside
Z
Breakdown assistance
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
313
Flat tyre
314
If you come into contact with the tyre sealant,
observe the following:
Breakdown assistance
RRinse
off the tyre sealant from your skin
immediately with water.
RIf the tyre sealant comes into contact with
your eyes, immediately rinse them thoroughly with clean water.
RIf tyre sealant is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly and drink
plenty of water. Do not induce vomiting,
and seek medical attention immediately.
RImmediately change out of clothing which
has come into contact with tyre sealant.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, seek medical
attention immediately.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
Pull plug ? with the cable and hose A out
of the housing.
X Screw hose A onto flange B of tyre sealant bottle :.
X Place tyre sealant bottle : head downwards into recess ; of the tyre inflation
compressor.
X
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto valve C.
X
TIREFIT sticker, 2-part
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying TIREFIT sticker and the tyre inflation compressor from the stowage well
underneath the boot floor (Y page 311).
X Affix part : of the TIREFIT sticker within
the driver's field of vision.
X Affix part ; of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
Insert connector ? into a 12 V socket
(Y page 283) in your vehicle.
Observe the notes on sockets
(Y page 283).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 141).
X Press on/off switch = on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
i First, tyre sealant is pumped into the tyre.
The pressure can briefly rise to approximately 500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
X
Flat tyre
X
Let the tyre inflation compressor run for
five minutes. The tyre should then have
attained a pressure of at least 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi).
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi) has been attained after five minutes:
(Y page 315).
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi) has not been attained after five
minutes: (Y page 315).
Tyre pressure reached
G WARNING
A tyre temporarily sealed with tyre sealant
impairs the driving characteristics and is not
suitable for higher speeds. There is a risk of
accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
accordingly and drive carefully. Do not exceed
the specified maximum speed with a tyre that
has been repaired using tyre sealant.
! After use, excess tyre sealant may run out
of the filler hose. This could cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
i If the tyre sealant leaks out, allow it to dry.
It can then be removed like a layer of film.
If you get tyre sealant on your clothing,
have it cleaned as soon as possible with
perchloroethylene.
Tyre pressure not reached
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
not been achieved after five minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Very slowly drive forwards or reverse
approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
After a maximum of five minutes the tyre
pressure must be at least 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi).
X
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tyre is too badly
damaged. The tyre sealant cannot repair the
tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres and a tyre
pressure that is too low can significantly
impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a qualified specialist
workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has been attained after five minutes:
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Pull away immediately.
The maximum speed for a tyre sealed with
tyre sealant is 80 km/h. The upper part of
the TIREFIT sticker must be affixed to the
instrument cluster in the driver's field of
vision.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the tyre inflation compressor.
The tyre pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
X
X
G WARNING
If the required tyre pressure is not reached
after driving for a short period, the tyre is too
badly damaged. The tyre sealant cannot
repair the tyre in this instance. Damaged tyres
and a tyre pressure that is too low can signifZ
Breakdown assistance
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
315
Battery (vehicle)
316
icantly impair the vehicle's braking and driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
Do not continue driving. Contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi) (see the fuel filler
flap for values).
X To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
Breakdown assistance
X
i In your vehicle, you will find a sticker with
the Mercedes-Benz Service24h telephone
number, e.g. on the B-pillar on the driver's
side.
Battery (vehicle)
Important safety notes
Work on the battery, e.g. removing or installing, requires specialist knowledge and the
use of special tools. Therefore, always have
work on the battery carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop.
G WARNING
X
To reduce the tyre pressure: depress
pressure release button E next to pressure gauge F.
If the tyre pressure is correct, unscrew the
filler hose from the valve of the repaired
tyre.
X Screw the valve cap onto the valve of the
repaired tyre.
X Pull the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre
inflation compressor.
The filler hose stays on the tyre sealant
bottle.
X Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Drive to the nearest qualified specialist
workshop and have the tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced as
soon as possible at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
can, for example, lead to a short circuit and
damage your vehicle's electronic system. This
can disrupt driving safety systems such as
ABS (anti-lock braking system) or ESP® (Electronic Stability Program).
RIf ABS malfunctions, the wheels can lock
during braking. This limits the steerability
of the vehicle when braking and the braking
distance may increase. There is a risk of
accident.
RIf ESP® malfunctions, the vehicle will not be
stabilised if it starts to skid or a wheel starts
to spin. There is a risk of accident.
You should therefore have all work involving
the battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
Risk of explosion
Fire, naked flames and
smoking are prohibited
when handling the battery.
Avoid creating sparks.
Battery (vehicle)
Keep children away.
Observe this Owner's Manual.
G WARNING
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid burns
should the battery be damaged in the event
of an accident.
To prevent acid burns, observe the following
safety notes when handling batteries:
Rdo not lean over the battery.
Rdo not place any metal objects on a battery.
Otherwise, you could cause a short circuit
and the battery's gas mixture could ignite.
Rmake sure that you do not create an electrostatic charge, e.g. by wearing synthetic
clothing or as a result of friction on fabrics.
Therefore, you should not pull or slide the
battery over carpets or other synthetic
materials.
Rnever
touch the battery first. To discharge
a possible electrostatic charge, step out of
the vehicle first and touch the bodywork.
Rdo not wipe the battery using a cloth. The
battery may explode as a result of electrostatic charge or due to flying sparks.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is illegal to dispose of them
with the household rubbish.
They must be collected separately and disposed of in an
environmentally responsible
recycling system.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or to a collection point for used batteries.
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Service
Booklet or contact a qualified specialist
workshop for more information.
! You should have all work involving the
battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. In the exceptional case that it is
necessary for you to disconnect the battery
yourself, make sure that:
Ryou switch off the engine and remove the
key. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO,
ensure that the ignition is switched off.
Check that all the indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster are off. Otherwise,
electronic components, such as the
alternator, may be damaged.
Ryou first remove the negative terminal
clamp and then the positive terminal
clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Battery acid is caustic.
Avoid contact with the skin,
eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective
clothing, in particular
gloves, an apron and a face
mask.
Immediately rinse acid
splashes off with clean
water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
Wear eye protection.
317
318
Battery (vehicle)
Breakdown assistance
Otherwise, the vehicle's electronic system may be damaged.
Rin vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle is secured against rolling away. You
can then no longer move the vehicle.
The battery and the cover of the positive
terminal clamp must be fitted securely during operation.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
The vehicle battery, like other batteries, can
discharge over time if you do not use the
vehicle. In such cases, have the battery disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can also charge the battery with a
charger recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
For more information, please contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period. Consult a qualified specialist
workshop if you wish to leave your vehicle
parked up for a long period of time.
i When you park the vehicle, remove the
key if you do not require any electrical consumers. The vehicle will then use very little
energy, thus conserving battery power.
i After an interruption of the power supply,
e.g. the battery was discharged, you have
to:
Rset
the clock. Information on setting the
clock can be found in the separate operating instructions.
On vehicles with COMAND Online and a
navigation system, the clock is set automatically.
Rreset the function for folding the exterior
mirrors in/out automatically, by folding
the mirrors out once (Y page 106).
Charging the battery
G WARNING
Only charge the battery in a well-ventilated
area. As the battery is being charged, gases
can escape and generate minor explosions.
This could injure you and other persons or
cause damage to the paintwork or acid corrosion on the vehicle.
You can obtain information on battery chargers which allow the battery to be charged
while still installed from a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
There is a risk of acid burns during the charging process due to the gases which escape
from the battery. Do not lean over the battery
during the charging process.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the
skin, eyes or clothing.
! Only charge the installed battery with a
battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. These battery
chargers allow the battery to be charged
while still installed in the vehicle.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstart connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 319).
Read the battery charger's operating instructions before charging the battery.
X Open the bonnet (Y page 296).
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure
(Y page 319).
Jump-starting
319
Jump-starting
G WARNING
There is a risk of acid burns when jump-starting a vehicle due to the gases which escape from
the battery. Do not lean over the battery while the engine is being jump-started.
G WARNING
G WARNING
Non-combusted fuel can collect in the exhaust system and ignite. There is a risk of fire. Avoid
repeated and lengthy starting attempts.
! Vehicles with a petrol engine: avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise,
the non-combusted fuel may damage the catalytic converter.
Do not use a rapid charging device to start the vehicle. If your vehicle's battery is discharged,
the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle or from a second battery using jump
leads. Observe the following points:
RThe
battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
Rvehicles with a petrol engine: only jump-start the vehicle when the engine and exhaust
system are cold.
Rdo not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
Rjump-starting may only be performed from batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
Ronly use jump leads that have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
Rif the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
Rmake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Make sure that:
RThe
jump leads are not damaged.
RNon-insulated parts of the terminal clamps do not come into contact with other metal parts
while the jump leads are connected to the battery.
jump leads cannot come into contact with parts such as the V-belt pulley or the fan.
These parts move when the engine is started and while it is running.
X Firmly depress the parking brake.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g. radio, blower, etc.).
X Open the bonnet (Y page 296).
Rthe
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Gases escaping from the battery during jump-starting may cause minor explosions. Avoid creating sparks. Keep naked flames away from the battery, and do not smoke.
Comply with the important safety precautions when handling batteries. You will find these under
"Battery (vehicle) - important safety notes" in the index.
Towing and tow-starting
Breakdown assistance
320
Slide cover : of positive terminal ; in the direction of the arrow.
Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B
using the jump lead. Always begin with positive terminal ; on your own vehicle first.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using
the jump lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X Before disconnecting the jump leads, let the engines run for several minutes.
X
X
First, remove the jump leads from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive terminal ; and positive terminal =, each time beginning at the contacts on your own
vehicle first.
X Close cover : of positive terminal ; after removing the jump leads.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
i Jump-starting is not considered to be a normal operating condition.
i Jump-starting cables and further information regarding jump starting can be obtained at
any qualified specialist workshop.
Towing and tow-starting
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you tow the vehicle, you must use a rigid
towing bar if:
Rthe
engine is not running.
is a brake system malfunction.
Rthere is a malfunction in the power supply
or the vehicle's electrical system.
The power assistance for the steering and the
brake force booster do not work when the
engine is not running. You will need more
force to steer and brake, you may have to
depress the brake pedal with maximum force.
Rthere
Towing and tow-starting
G WARNING
The vehicle is braked when the HOLD function
or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Therefore,
deactivate HOLD and DISTRONIC PLUS if the
vehicle is to be towed.
! Only secure the tow rope or towing bar to
the towing eyes. The vehicle may otherwise
be damaged.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
Rsecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
tow rope must not be longer than is
legally permitted. It should be marked in
the middle, e.g. with a white cloth
(30 x 30 cm) so that other road users are
aware that a vehicle is being towed.
Rthe tow rope may only be attached to the
towing eyes.
Robserve the brake lamps of the towing
vehicle while driving. Always maintain a
distance so that the tow rope does not
sag.
Rdo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. The vehicle could be damaged.
Rthe
! Do not use the towing eye for recovery,
this could damage the vehicle. If in doubt,
recover the vehicle with a crane.
! When towing, pull away slowly and
smoothly. If the tractive power is too high,
the vehicles could be damaged.
! To tow vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use
the key instead of the Start/Stop button.
The automatic transmission may otherwise
switch to position P when you open the
driver's or front-passenger door which
could damage the transmission.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum
of 50km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must
not be exceeded.
For towing distances over 50 km, the entire
vehicle must be lifted up and transported.
! If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
Information on your vehicle's gross vehicle
weight rating can be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 359).
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
If the vehicle has suffered transmission damage, have it transported on a transporter or
trailer.
The automatic transmission must be in position N when the vehicle is being towed.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot
turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2
Rcannot shift the automatic transmission to
position N
i Deactivate the automatic locking feature
(Y page 84). You could otherwise be locked
out when pushing or towing the vehicle.
Deactivate tow-away protection
(Y page 71) before the vehicle is towed.
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe may be hot. You could
burn yourself if you touch the tail pipe. Be
Z
Breakdown assistance
Before towing away, make sure that the steering can be moved and is not locked.
If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
321
322
Towing and tow-starting
particularly careful when removing the rear
cover.
Press the mark on cover ; inwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X Take cover ; off the opening.
X Screw the towing eye in clockwise to the
stop and tighten it.
X
Removing the towing eye
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Position the top of cover : in the bumper
and press it in at the bottom until it
engages.
X Attach cover ; to the bumper and press
until it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit.
X
Breakdown assistance
X
Example: towing eye covers
Towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
Only possible on vehicles without
4MATIC.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 114).
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X When leaving the vehicle, take the key or
the KEYLESS-GO key with you.
Towing eye covers (AMG vehicles)
The mountings for the removable towing eyes
are located in the bumpers. They are at the
front and at the rear, under the covers.
X Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
tool kit (Y page 311).
X Pull cover : out of the bumper in the
direction of the arrow by inserting your fingers into the recess.
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 320).
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
G WARNING
The power assistance for the steering and the
brake force booster do not work when the
engine is not running. You will then need
Towing and tow-starting
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 320).
The automatic transmission automatically
shifts to position P when you open the driver's
or front-passenger door or when you remove
the key from the ignition lock. In order to
ensure that the automatic transmission stays
in position N when towing the vehicle, you
must observe the following points:
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the key
instead of the Start/Stop button
(Y page 141).
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 114).
X Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
i When towing with the hazard warning
lamps switched on, use the combination
switch as usual to signal a change of direction. In this case, only the turn signals for
the desired direction flash. When the combination switch is reset, the hazard warning
lamps start flashing again.
X
Transporting the vehicle
! Only lash the vehicle down by the wheels
or wheel rims, not by parts of the vehicle
such as axle or steering components. Otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged.
The towing eye can be used to pull the vehicle
onto a trailer or transporter for transporting
purposes.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the parking brake.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position P.
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
Notes for 4MATIC vehicles
! Vehicles with 4MATIC must not be towed
with the front or rear axle raised; otherwise,
the transmission may be damaged.
If the vehicle has transmission damage or
damage to the front or rear axle, have it transported on a transporter or trailer.
In the event of damage to the electrical
system
If the battery is defective, the automatic
transmission will be locked in position P. To
shift the automatic transmission to position
N, you must provide power to the vehicle's
electrical system in the same way as when
jump-starting (Y page 319).
Have the vehicle transported on a transporter
or trailer.
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
! Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be tow-started. The transmission
may otherwise be damaged.
Z
Breakdown assistance
much more effort to brake and steer the vehicle. Adapt your style of driving accordingly.
323
Electrical fuses
324
You can find information on "Jump-starting"
at (Y page 319).
X
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it (Y page 141).
or
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
Breakdown assistance
G WARNING
Only use fuses that have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which have the
correct fuse rating for the systems concerned. Do not attempt to repair or bridge
faulty fuses. Using fuses which have not been
approved or attempting to repair or bridge
faulty fuses could cause the fuse to be overloaded and result in a fire. Have the cause
traced and rectified at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, make sure
the ignition is switched off (Y page 141).
All indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
must be off.
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
Rfuse box in the boot on the right-hand side
of the vehicle, when viewed in the direction
of travel
the fuse allocation chart is located in the vehicle tool kit in the stowage compartment
under the boot floor (Y page 311).
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.
The fuses in your vehicle serve to close down
faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions stop
operating.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and fuse rating. The fuse ratings
are listed in the fuse allocation chart.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Before replacing a fuse
Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 159).
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X
Fuse box in the engine compartment
G WARNING
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
turned off and the key is pulled out of the ignition lock before you open the cover of the fuse
box. Otherwise, the windscreen wipers and
the wiper rods above the cover could be set
in motion. This could lead to you or others
being injured by the wiper rods.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
X Open the bonnet.
X
Electrical fuses
To open: release cover : at the top right
and left-hand sides with a flat object.
X Open cover : downwards in the direction
of the arrow.
X
To close: check whether the rubber seal is
lying correctly in the cover.
X Insert the cover at the rear of the fuse box
into the retainer.
X Fold down cover and close clamps :.
X Secure lines ; in the guides.
X Close the bonnet.
X
Fuse box in the boot
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
X
Open the boot lid.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X To open: take lines ; from the guides.
X Move aside lines ;. Route the lines behind
connection = to do this.
X Open clamps :.
X Remove the fuse box cover forwards.
X
325
326
327
328
328
328
330
331
336
341
351
Wheels and tyres
Useful information ............................
Important safety notes ....................
Operation ...........................................
Winter operation ...............................
Tyre pressure ....................................
Changing a wheel .............................
Wheel and tyre combinations ..........
Emergency spare wheel ...................
328
Operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 23).
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and enquire about:
Rsuitability
Rlegal
stipulations
recommendations
Information on the dimensions and types of
wheels and tyres for your vehicle can be
found under "Wheel/tyre combinations"
(Y page 341).
Information on air pressure for the tyres on
your vehicle can be found:
Rfactory
Ron
Important safety notes
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
If wheels and tyres of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Always replace wheels and tyres with those
that fulfil the specifications of the original part
(designation, manufacturer, model).
G WARNING
A flat tyre severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tyres without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tyre.
Rimmediately replace the flat tyre with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyres with run-flat characteristics:
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tyres (tyres
with run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being
used correctly can impair the operating
safety.
the tyre pressure label on the fuel filler
flap (Y page 157)
Runder "Tyre pressure" (Y page 331)
Rin the "Tyre pressure" section
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted. The use of wheel
spacers or brake dust shields is not permitted. This invalidates the general operating
permit for the vehicle.
i Further information on wheels and tyres
can be obtained at any qualified specialist
workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
Check the tyre pressures when the vehicle is
heavily laden and, if necessary, adjust.
While driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics,
e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that
the wheels or tyres are damaged. If you suspect that a tyre is defective, reduce your
speed immediately. Stop the vehicle as soon
as possible to check the wheels and tyres for
damage. Hidden tyre damage could also be
causing the unusual handling characteristics.
If you find no signs of damage, have the tyres
and wheels checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
When parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tyres do not get deformed by the kerb or
Operation
Regular checking of wheels and tyres
G WARNING
Damaged tyres can cause tyre inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control
of your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tyres regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tyres immediately.
Regularly check the wheels and tyres of your
vehicle for damage at least once a month, as
well as after driving off-road or on rough
roads. Damaged wheels can cause a loss of
tyre pressure. Pay particular attention to
damage such as:
Rcuts
in the tyres
Rpunctures
Rtears
in the tyres
Rbulges on tyres
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on wheels
Regularly check the tyre tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width
of the tyre (Y page 329). If necessary, turn
the front wheels to full lock in order to inspect
the inner side of the tyre surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not fit
anything onto the valve other than the standard valve cap or other valve caps approved by
Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle. Do not fit any
other valve caps or systems, e.g. tyre pressure monitoring systems.
Regularly check the pressure of all the tyres,
particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tyre
pressure as necessary (Y page 331).
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 351).
The service life of tyres depends on various
factors, including the following:
Rdriving
style
pressure
Rtyre mileage
Rtyre
Tyre tread
G WARNING
Insufficient tyre tread will reduce tyre traction. The tyre is no longer able to dissipate
water. This means that on wet road surfaces,
the risk of aquaplaning increases, in particular
where speed is not adapted to suit the driving
conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tyre pressure is too high or too low, tyres
may exhibit different levels of wear at different locations on the tyre tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tyres.
Minimum tyre tread depth for:
Rsummer
tyres: 3 mm
tyres: 4 mm
For safety reasons, replace the tyres before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tyre tread depth is reached..
RM+S
Selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
ROnly
fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RRun in new tyres at moderate speeds for
the first 100 km. They only reach their full
performance after this distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth. This otherwise significantly
reduces the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear.
Z
Wheels and tyres
other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive over
kerbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try
to do so slowly and at an obtuse angle. Otherwise, the tyres, particularly the sidewalls,
may be damaged.
329
330
Winter operation
Observe the notes on the emergency spare
wheel (Y page 351).
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
Wheels and tyres
With MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics), you can continue to drive
your vehicle even if there is a total loss of
pressure in one or more tyres.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with an active tyre pressure loss
warning system or with an active tyre pressure monitor and on wheels specifically tested by Mercedes-Benz.
Notes on driving with MOExtended tyres with
a flat tyre (Y page 313).
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 336).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres
lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power. Change the tyres on your vehicle to M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very
cold temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility
for this type of damage.
M+S tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tyre tread depth of less than
4 mm are not suitable for use in winter as they
do not provide sufficient traction. There is a
risk of accident.
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced.
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres
or all-season tyres. Both types of tyre are
identified by the M+S marking.
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions.
Only these tyres will allow driving safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to function optimally in winter. These tyres have been developed specifically for driving in snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread
on all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have
fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres that have a lower maximum permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix a corresponding warning label in the
driver's field of vision. This can be obtained
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum speed of the vehicle
using permanent SPEEDTRONIC so that it
does not exceed the maximum permissible
speed for the M+S tyres (Y page 170).
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 331).
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 333).
X Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 335).
X
X
For more information on driving with an emergency spare wheel, see (Y page 351).
Tyre pressure
Snow chains
Tyre pressure
G WARNING
Tyre pressure specifications
G WARNING
Tyres with too low or too high tyre pressure
contain the following hazards:
Rthey can burst, in particular if the vehicle is
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specially approved for your vehicle
by Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding standard of quality.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
heavily laden or when driven at high
speeds.
Rthe tyres can wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which can severely impair tyre
traction.
Rthe driving, steering and braking characteristics may be severely impaired.
There is a risk of accident.
Follow recommended tyre inflation pressures
and check the pressure of all the tyres including the spare wheel:
Rsnow
Rat
Rnever
Rfit
fit snow chains on the front wheels
snow chains to the rear wheels in pairs.
chains cannot be fitted to all wheeltyre combinations. Permissible wheel-tyre
combinations (Y page 341).
Ronly use snow chains when the road surface is completely snow-covered. Remove
the snow chains as soon as possible when
you come to a road that is not snow-covered.
Rlocal regulations may restrict the use of
snow chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if you wish to fit snow chains.
Rdo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
Ron vehicles with AIRMATIC, you must drive
at raised vehicle level if snow chains have
been fitted (Y page 181).
i You may wish to deactivate ESP® when
pulling away with snow chains fitted
(Y page 66). This way you can allow the
wheels to spin in a controlled manner, achieving an increased driving force (cutting
action).
For more information on driving with an emergency spare wheel, see (Y page 351).
least every two weeks
the load changes
Rbefore beginning a long journey
Rfor changed operating conditions, e.g. offroad driving
If necessary, correct the tyre pressure.
Rif
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tyre
valves, the tyre valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tyre pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors keep the tyre valve open. This
can also result in tyre pressure loss. There is
a risk of accident.
Only screw standard valve caps or valve caps
specifically provided by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tyre valve.
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tyre may be damaged. Tyre
pressure that is too low may result in a tyre
blow-out. There is a risk of accident.
Z
Wheels and tyres
If you have fitted snow chains to the front
wheels, they may scrape against the vehicle
body or chassis components. This could
cause damage to the vehicle or the tyres.
There is a risk of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
331
332
Tyre pressure
RCheck
the tyre for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
H Environmental note
Wheels and tyres
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
You will find a table of tyre pressures for various operating conditions on the inside of
your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
Operation with the emergency spare
wheel(Y page 351).
The table inside the fuel filler flap may state
tyre pressures for different load conditions.
These are defined in the table as different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary;
for more information, please refer to the vehicle's registration documents.
If tyre sizes are not specified, the tyre pressures stated on the tyre pressure information
label apply for all tyres approved for this vehicle.
pressure can be checked using the on-board
computer.
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when
the tyres are cold.
The tyres are cold:
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tyres
out of direct sunlight for at least three
hours and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further
than 1.6 km
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
speed at which you are driving and the load
on the tyres, the tyre temperature and thus
the tyre pressure change by approximately
10 kPa per 10 † (0.1 bar/1.5 psi). Take this
into account when checking the pressure of
warm tyres. Only correct the tyre pressure if
it is too low for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus the driving safety (e.g.
aquaplaning)
Rcause
i The tyre pressure values given for low
loads are minimum values which offer you
good ride comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the
following tyre pressure information is only
valid for that tyre size.
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the
tyre pressure. The outer appearance of a tyre
does not permit any reliable conclusion about
the tyre pressure. On vehicles fitted with the
electronic tyre pressure monitor, the tyre
Tyre pressure loss warning system
Important safety notes
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of
a loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
Tyre pressure
Rsnow
chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres.
Rroad conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration).
Ryou are driving with a heavy load (in the
vehicle or on the roof).
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
Rchanged
the tyre pressure
the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, make sure that the tyre
pressures are set properly on all four tyres
for the respective operating conditions.
The recommended tyre pressures can be
found in the table on the fuel filler flap. The
tyre pressure loss warning system can only
give reliable warnings if you have set the
Rchanged
correct tyre pressure. If an incorrect tyre
pressure is set, these incorrect values will
be monitored.
X Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 331).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2(Y page 141) in the ignition lock.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press button a.
The Tyre press. now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Yes.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press button %.
or
When the Tyre press. now OK? message
appears, press the 9 or : button to
select Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Z
Wheels and tyres
message will appear in the multifunction display.
The tyre pressure warning system does not
warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure.
Observe the notes on the recommended tyre
pressure (Y page 331).
The tyre pressure loss warning system does
not replace the need to regularly check your
vehicle's tyre pressures, since an even loss of
pressure on several tyres at the same time
cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss
warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
333
334
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure monitor
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tyre
pressure to the recommended cold tyre pressure suitable for the operating situation
(Y page 331). Note that the correct tyre pressure for the current operating situation must
first be taught-in to the tyre pressure monitor.
If there is a substantial loss of pressure, the
warning threshold for the warning message is
aligned to the reference values taught-in.
Restart the tyre pressure monitor after
adjusting to the cold tyre pressure
(Y page 335). The current pressures are
saved as new reference values. This will
ensure that a warning message will only
appear if the tyre pressure drops significantly.
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. Observe
the notes on the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 331).
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
abrupt steering manoeuvres.
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that
monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor warns you if the
pressure drops in one or more of the tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor only functions if
the corresponding sensors are fitted to all
wheels.
Information on tyre pressures is displayed in
the multifunction display. After a few minutes
of driving, the current tyre pressure of each
tyre is shown in the multifunction display.
The tyre pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those measured at a filling station using a pressure
gauge. The tyre pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tyre pressure
values indicated by a pressure gauge are
higher than those shown by the on-board
computer. In this case, do not reduce the tyre
pressures.
The operation of the tyre pressure monitor
can be affected by interference from radio
transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones, two-way radios) that may be being
operated in or near the vehicle.
Checking tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position
2(Y page 141) in the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel
will be displayed in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle was parked for longer than
20 minutes the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message is shown.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
monitor automatically recognises new
wheels or new sensors. If a clear allocation of
the tyre pressure values to the individual
wheels is not possible, the Tyre pressure
monitor active message is shown instead
of the tyre pressure display. The tyre pressures are already being monitored.
i If an emergency spare wheel is fitted, the
system may continue to show the tyre pressure of the wheel that has been removed
for a few minutes. If this occurs, note that
the value displayed for the position where
the spare wheel is fitted is not the same as
the current tyre pressure of the emergency
spare wheel.
Tyre pressure
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a significant pressure loss on one or more tyres, a
warning message is shown in the multifunction display. A warning tone also sounds and
the tyre pressure warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
Each tyre that is affected by a significant loss
of pressure is highlighted in the pressure display.
X If the Please correct tyre pressure
message appears in the multifunction display, check the tyre pressure on all four
wheels and correct it if necessary.
i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are
interchanged, the tyre pressures may be
displayed for the wrong positions for a
short time. This is rectified after a few
minutes of driving, and the tyre pressures
are displayed for the correct positions.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current tyre pressure for each tyre or the
Tyre pressures will be displayed
after a few minutes of driving message.
X Press the : button.
The multifunction display shows the Use
current pressure values as new ref‐
erence values message.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tyre pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tyre pressure. However,
you can also define reference values manually as described here. The tyre pressure
monitor then monitors the new tyre pressure
values.
X Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap to ensure that the tyre pressure is set
correctly in all four tyres for the current
operating conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 331).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre
pressures are within the specified range.
The new tyre pressures are then accepted
as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
In certain countries, a radio type approval for
the tyre pressure monitor may be required.
The radio type approval number for the tyre
pressure monitor can be found online at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Warning messages of the tyre pressure
monitor
335
Wheels and tyres
336
Changing a wheel
Country
Radio type approval number
Brazil
1489-10-4415
Dubai
TRA, Registered NO
0016161/08
TRA, Registered NO
0016162/08
Morocco
MR5527 ANRT 2010/ 27. April
2010
MR5526 ANRT 2010/ 27. April
2010
Philippines
ESD-1105558C
Singapore
Compliance with IDA Standard
N0140-09
South
Africa
TA-2008/1068
TA-2008/1069
Changing a wheel
Flat tyre
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tyre in the "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 312). You will also find
information on driving with MOExtended
tyres in the event of a flat tyre.
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tyre in the "Breakdown assistance" section (Y page 312). You will also find
information on driving with MOExtended
tyres in the event of a flat tyre.
Interchanging the wheels
G WARNING
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tyres have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Interchange front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tyres are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure
monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in
the area of the valve, as this could damage
the electronic components.
Only have tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Interchanging the front and rear wheels of
differing dimensions can render the general
operating permit invalid.
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the "Fitting a wheel" section (Y page 337).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ, depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5000km to 10,000 km depending on
the degree of tyre wear. Maintain the direction of tyre rotation.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and,
if necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
Changing a wheel
Store wheels that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the
tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Cleaning the wheels
G WARNING
The water jet of circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) can cause damage not visible from the
outside to tyres or chassis components. Components damaged in this way can unexpectedly fail. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged tyres or chassis components replaced
immediately.
If included in the vehicle equipment,
remove the tyre-change tool kit from the
vehicle.
X Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
X
i Apart from certain country-specific varia-
tions, the vehicles are not equipped with a
tyre-change tool kit. Some tools for changing a wheel are specific to the vehicle. For
more information on which tools are
required to perform a wheel change on your
vehicle, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Necessary wheel-changing tools can
include, for example:
Rjack
Rwheel
Rwheel
Fitting a wheel
Preparing the vehicle
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Bring the front wheels into the straightahead position.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Vehicles with AIRMATIC: make sure that
"normal" level is selected (Y page 181).
X Switch off the engine.
X Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics have status 0,
which is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 141).
chock
wrench
Wheels and tyres
Storing wheels
337
Securing the vehicle against rolling
away
X
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the tyre-change tool kit
(Y page 311).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
X Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
Z
Changing a wheel
338
The following must be observed when raising
the vehicle:
Rto
Securing the vehicle on level ground
Wheels and tyres
X
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
X
On light downhill gradients: place
chocks or other suitable items in front of
the wheels of the front and rear axle.
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
raise the vehicle, only use the vehiclespecific jack that has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. If the jack is
used incorrectly, it could tip over while the
vehicle is raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold
the vehicle for a short time while a wheel
is being changed. It is not suited for performing maintenance work under the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and
downhill slopes.
Rbefore raising the vehicle, secure it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake
and inserting wheel chocks. Never disengage the parking brake while the vehicle is
raised.
Rthe jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a
large, load-bearing underlay must be used.
On a slippery surface, a non-slip underlay
must be used, e.g. rubber mats.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar
objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the
jack will not be able to achieve its loadbearing capacity due to the restricted
height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tyres and the ground does
not exceed 3 cm.
Rnever place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rnever lie under the raised vehicle.
Rnever start the engine when the vehicle is
raised.
Rnever open or close a door or the boot lid
when the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in
the vehicle when the vehicle is raised.
Changing a wheel
Using wheel wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
Example
X
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned vertically under the jacking point.
Turn crank ? clockwise until jack = sits
completely on jacking point ; and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn crank ? until the tyre is raised a maximum of 3 cm off the ground.
X
Removing a wheel
! AMG vehicles: during removal and repositioning of the wheel, the wheel rim can
strike the ceramic-brake disc and damage
it. Therefore, take precautions and get a
second person to assist you. Alternatively,
you can use a second centring pin.
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt.
The threads of the wheel bolts and wheel
hubs could otherwise be damaged when
the bolts are tightened.
X
Position jack = at jacking point ;.
Z
Wheels and tyres
X
339
Changing a wheel
340
Unscrew the uppermost wheel bolt completely.
X Screw centring pin : into the thread
instead of the wheel bolt.
X Unscrew the remaining wheel bolts fully.
X Remove the wheel.
X
Fitting a new wheel
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event
of damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
G WARNING
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notices in "Changing a wheel"
(Y page 336).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel.
! AMG vehicle with ceramic brake
discs: during removal and repositioning of
the wheel, the wheel rim can strike the
ceramic-brake disc and damage it. Therefore, take precautions and have a second
person assist you. Alternatively, you can
use a second centring pin.
Positioning a wheel (example: vehicle with emergency spare wheel)
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
X Slide the wheel to be mounted onto the
centring pin and push it on.
X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
X Unscrew the centring pin.
X Tighten the last wheel bolt until it is fingertight.
X Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel (Y page 352).
Only then lower the vehicle.
X
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
! Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: Inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel using the tyre inflation
compressor before lowering the vehicle.
The rim could otherwise be damaged.
Wheel and tyre combinations
341
These are specially adapted to the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP® and are
marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres featuring run-flat characteristics)
Tightening wheel bolts (example: vehicle with
emergency spare wheel)
Turn the crank of the jack anti-clockwise
until the vehicle is once again standing
firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated
(: to A). The tightening torque must be
130 Nm.
X Turn the jack back to its initial position.
X Stow the jack and the rest of the vehicle
tools in the boot again.
X Check the air pressure of the newly fitted
wheel and adjust accordingly.
Observe the recommended tyre pressure
(Y page 331).
X
i Vehicles with tire pressure control system: all fitted wheels must be equipped
with functioning sensors.
Wheel and tyre combinations
General notes
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
tain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tyre dimension variations could cause the tyres to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tyres or the vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tyres,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Further information about wheels, tyres
and approved combinations can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not
fit used tyres if you have no information
about their previous usage.
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort and suspension comfort are reduced
and the risk of damage to the wheels and
tyres as a result of driving over obstacles
increases.
Z
Wheels and tyres
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer-
342
Wheel and tyre combinations
Overview of abbreviations used in the following tyre tables:
RBA:
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
You will find a table with recommended tyre
pressures for various operating conditions on
the inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap. For
further information on tyre pressure, see
(Y page 331). Check tyre pressures regularly
and only when the tyres are cold.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always fit
the vehicle:
RFA:
Wheels and tyres
Rwith
tyres of the same size on a given axle
(left/right)
Rwith the same type of tyres at a given time
(summer tyres, winter tyres, MOExtended
tyres)
Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory. It
is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit if you
fit tyres that do not feature run-flat characteristics, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit can
be obtained from a qualified specialist workshop.
i Not all wheel/tyre combinations can be
mounted at the factory in all countries.
Wheel and tyre combinations
343
Tyres
CLS 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL
BA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 30
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL MOExtended2
BA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 30
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL MOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL
FA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y MOExtended2, 3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
R 18
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S3, 4
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an active tyre pressure
loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
3 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
4 Observe the notes on "large wheels" in "Wheel/tyre combinations" under "General notes".
2
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
344
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+Si
BA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 30
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.0 J x 17 H2 ET 30
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Wheels and tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R19 99 V XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL MOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL
FA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y MOExtended2, 3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an active tyre pressure
loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
3 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
2
Wheel and tyre combinations
345
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S3, 4
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Wheels and tyres
Winter tyres
R 17
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R19 99 V XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 350 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
MOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Observe the notes on "large wheels" in "Wheel/tyre combinations" under "General notes".
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
2 MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an active tyre pressure
loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
4
3
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
346
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL
FA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y MOExtended2, 3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S3, 4
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R19 99 V XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an active tyre pressure
loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
4 Observe the notes on "large wheels" in "Wheel/tyre combinations" under "General notes".
3
2
Wheel and tyre combinations
347
CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY
Summer tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 Y XL MOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL
FA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y MOExtended2, 3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
R 18
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
XL4
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S3, 4
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an active tyre pressure
loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
3 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
4 Observe the notes on "large wheels" in "Wheel/tyre combinations" under "General notes".
2
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
348
Winter tyres
R 17
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 245/45 R17 99 H XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 245/45 R17 99 V XL M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R19 99 V XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
Wheels and tyres
CLS 500 BlueEFFICIENCY
Summer tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL
FA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y MOExtended2, 3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
XL4
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an active tyre pressure
loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
3 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
4 Observe the notes on "large wheels" in "Wheel/tyre combinations" under "General notes".
2
Wheel and tyre combinations
349
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S3, 4
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R19 99 V XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
CLS 500 4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2, 3
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL
FA: 285/35 R18 97 Y3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
FA: 255/40 R18 99 Y XL MOExtended2
RA: 285/35 R18 97 Y MOExtended2, 3
FA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Wheels and tyres
Summer tyres
R 18
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 Y XL4
RA: 285/30 R19 98 Y XL3, 4
FA: 8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
Observe the notes on "large wheels" in "Wheel/tyre combinations" under "General notes".
2 MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an active tyre pressure
loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
3
4
Z
Wheel and tyre combinations
350
All-weather tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/40 R18 99 H XL M+S
RA: 285/35 R18 97 H XL M+S3, 4
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 9.5 J x 18 H2 ET 48
Winter tyres
R 18
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
BA: 255/40 R19 99 V XL M+Si
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
BA: 255/40 R18 99 V M+SiMOExtended2
BA: 8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
Wheels and tyres
CLS 63 AMG
Summer tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 ZR19 (96 Y) XL4
RA: 285/30 ZR19 (98 Y) XL3, 4
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
Winter tyres
R 19
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+Si4
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 52
RA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+Si4
FA: 255/35 R19 96 V XL M+Si4
BA: 285/30 R19 98 V XL
M+Si3, 4
FA: 9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
RA: 10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes under "Snow chains".
Observe the notes on "large wheels" in "Wheel/tyre combinations" under "General notes".
2 MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an active tyre pressure
loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
3
4
Important safety notes
Replace the tyres after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear. This also applies to the
emergency spare wheel.
G WARNING
i When you are driving with the collapsible
Emergency spare wheel
The wheel/tyre dimensions and the tyre type
of the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
and the wheel to be replaced may differ. Fitting a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
may severely impair the driving characteristics. There is a risk of accident.
To prevent hazardous situations:
RAdapt
your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
RNever fit more than one spare wheel/emergency spare wheel if the dimesions are different to those of the wheel being replaced.
ROnly use a spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel briefly if the dimesions are different
to those of the wheel being replaced.
not switch off ESP®.
RHave the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel in question replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop. Make sure
that the wheel/tyre dimensions and tyre
type are correct.
RDo
emergency spare wheel fitted, the tyre
pressure loss warning system or the tyre
pressure monitor cannot function reliably.
Only restart the tyre pressure loss warning
system/tyre pressure monitor when the
defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor:
after mounting an emergency spare wheel,
the system may still display the tyre pressure of the removed wheel for a few
minutes. The value displayed for the mounted emergency spare wheel is not the same
as the current tyre pressure of the emergency spare wheel.
Removing the "Minispare" emergency spare wheel/collapsible emergency spare wheel
Removing the "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
When using an emergency spare wheel or
spare wheel of a different size, you must not
exceed the maximum speed of 80 km/h.
Snow chains must not be fitted to emergency
spare wheels.
General notes
You should regularly check the pressure of all
your tyres, including the emergency spare
wheel, particularly prior to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary (Y page 331).
The applicable value is found on the wheel or
under "Technical data" (Y page 354).
An emergency spare wheel may also be fitted
against the direction of rotation. Observe the
time restriction on use as well as the speed
limitation specified on the emergency spare
wheel.
The emergency spare wheel can be found in
the stowage well under the boot floor.
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 278).
X Turn stowage tray ; anti-clockwise and
remove together with vehicle tool kit
tray :.
X Remove "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel =.
Z
351
Wheels and tyres
Emergency spare wheel
Emergency spare wheel
352
Removing the collapsible emergency
spare wheel (AMG vehicles)
Screw the valve cap back on.
X Remove the protective film from the vehicle
tool kit and put it over the collapsible emergency spare wheel.
X Stow the collapsible emergency spare
wheel in the emergency spare wheel well
under the boot.
X
Inflating the collapsible emergency
spare wheel
Wheels and tyres
! Inflate the collapsible emergency spare
The emergency spare wheel can be found in
the stowage well under the boot floor.
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 278).
X Reach into cutout : in the tool holder and
lift it up.
X Remove collapsible emergency spare
wheel ;.
wheel using the tyre inflation compressor
before lowering the vehicle. The wheel rim
could otherwise be damaged.
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
For further information on changing and fitting a wheel, see (Y page 337).
Stowing a used collapsible emergency spare wheel
! Only place the collapsible emergency
spare wheel in the vehicle when it is dry.
Otherwise, moisture may get into the vehicle.
Take the following steps to stow a used collapsible emergency spare wheel. It will not
otherwise fit into the spare wheel well.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
this work performed at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
X Unscrew the valve cap from the valve.
X Use the back of the valve cap to unscrew
the valve insert from the valve and release
the air.
i Fully deflating the tyre may take a few
minutes.
X
Screw the valve insert back into the valve.
Mount the collapsible emergency spare
wheel as described (Y page 336).
The collapsible emergency spare wheel
must be mounted before it is inflated.
X Pull connector ? and the air hose out of
the housing.
X Remove the cap from the valve on the collapsible emergency spare wheel.
X Screw union nut : on the air hose onto the
valve.
X Make sure on/off switch A of the tyre
inflation compressor is set to 0.
X
Emergency spare wheel
Insert connector ? into the cigarette
lighter socket or into a 12 V socket in your
vehicle.
Observe the notes on the cigarette lighter
(Y page 283). Observe the notes on sockets (Y page 283).
X Turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock (Y page 141).
X Press on/off switch A on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated. The tyre pressure is
shown on pressure gauge =.
X Pump the tyre to the specified tyre pressure.
The specified tyre pressure is printed on
the yellow label of the emergency spare
wheel.
X When the specified tyre pressure has been
reached, press on/off switch A on the
electric air pump to 0.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
off.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock.
X If the tyre pressure is higher than the specified pressure, press pressure release button ; until the correct tyre pressure has
been reached.
X Unscrew union nut : on the air hose from
the valve.
X Screw the valve cap onto the collapsible
emergency spare wheel valve again.
X Stow plug ? and the air hose in the lower
section of the blower housing.
X Stow the tyre inflation compressor in the
vehicle.
353
Wheels and tyres
X
Z
354
Emergency spare wheel
Technical data
All vehicles (except AMG vehicles)
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
T 155/60 R18 107 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
4.5B x 18 H2 ET 36
AMG vehicles
Wheels and tyres
Collapsible emergency spare wheel
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
175/50 – 19 97 P
Tyre pressure: 350 kPa (3.5 bar/51 psi)
6.5 B x 19 H2 ET 14
355
356
356
356
357
359
359
366
368
Technical data
Useful information ............................
Information on technical data .........
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Vehicle electronics ...........................
Identification plates .........................
Service products and capacities .....
Vehicle data ......................................
24 GHz radar sensor system (country overview) .....................................
356
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all mod-
els, series and optional equipment for your
vehicle that were available at the time of
going to press. National variations are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all of the functions described. This is also the case for systems and
functions relevant to safety.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 23).
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well
as control units and sensors for these
restraint systems, may be installed in the
following areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor
pillars
sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas. Do not carry out
repairs or welding. You could impair the
operating efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have accessories retrofitted at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Rdoor
Information on technical data
You can find current technical data on the
Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com
Technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EC Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. The data may therefore differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
G WARNING
Driving safety may be impaired if nonapproved parts, tyres and wheels or safetyrelevant accessories are used.
This could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. This
could cause you to lose control of your vehicle
and cause an accident.
For this reason, Mercedes-Benz recommends
that you use genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or
parts of equal quality. Only use tyres, wheels
and accessories that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories that have been
specifically approved for your vehicle for their
reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to assess other parts. Mercedes-Benz
accepts no responsibility for the use of parts
that have been independently or officially
approved.
In Germany, certain parts are only officially
approved for installation or modification if
they comply with legal requirements. This
also applies to some other countries. All genuine Mercedes-Benz parts meet the approval
requirements. The use of non-approved parts
may invalidate the vehicle's general operating
permit.
Vehicle electronics
This is the case:
G WARNING
Rif
Incorrect retrofitting of RF transmitters can
lead to increased electromagnetic radiation in
the vehicle interior. Using an exterior aerial
takes into account current scientific discussions relating to the possible health hazards
that may result from electromagnetic fields.
Have aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment installed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
G WARNING
Always have work on the engine electronics
and related components carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Otherwise, the vehicle's operating safety could be affected.
! The operating permit may be invalidated
if the instructions for installation and use of
RF transmitters are not observed.
In particular, the following conditions must
be complied with:
Ronly
approved wavebands may be used.
maximum permissible output in
these wavebands must be complied with.
Rthe approved aerial positions must be
complied with.
Rthe
Technical data
they cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted
Rif other road users could be endangered
Rif the emission or noise levels are adversely
affected.
Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) (Y page 359) and the engine number (Y page 359) when ordering genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts.
! Only have work carried out on the engine
electronics and its associated parts, such
as control units, sensors and connector
leads, at a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle components may otherwise wear
more quickly and the vehicle's operating
permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
Approved aerial positions
: Front roof area
G WARNING
; Rear roof area
Incorrect retrofitting of RF transmitters can
cause the vehicle electronics to malfunction.
The vehicle's operating safety and thus your
own safety are impaired.
Have aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment installed at a qualified specialist workshop.
357
= Rear wing
? Boot lid
Z
358
Vehicle electronics
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at
the base of the aerial must not exceed the
following values:
Waveband
approved aerial positions
: Front roof area
; Rear roof area
= Rear wing
? Boot lid
Technical data
i When fitting an aerial on the front roof
area of vehicles with a sliding sunroof,
observe the sweeping range of the roof.
On the rear wing, it is recommended to
position the aerial on the side of the vehicle
closest to the centre of the road.
Use the Technical Specification ISO/TS
21609 (Road Vehicles – "EMC guidelines for
fitting aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment") when retrofitting RF (radio
frequency) transmitters. Comply with the
legal requirements for add-on parts.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial
connections intended for use with the basic
wiring. Be sure to observe the manufacturer's
additional instructions when installing.
Deviations with respect to wavebands, maximum transmission outputs or aerial positions
must be approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Maximum
transmission
output (PEAK)
Short wave (f < 54 MHz)
100 W
4 m waveband
30 W
2 m waveband
50 W
trunked radio/Tetra
35 W
70 cm waveband
35 W
GSM/DCS/PCS
850/900/1800/1900
10 W
UMTS/LTE
10 W
The following can be used in the vehicle without restrictions:
RRF
transmitters with a maximum transmission output of up to 100 mW
Rmobile phones (GSM/DCS/PCS/UMTS/
LTE)
There are no restrictions when positioning the
aerial on the outside of the vehicle for the following wavebands:
Rtrunked
radio/Tetra
cm waveband
RGSM/DCS/PCS
RUMTS/LTE
R70
Service products and capacities
Identification plates
359
VIN
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold floor covering : upwards.
You will see VIN ;.
X
X
Open the front right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 359).
The engine number is stamped onto the
crankcase. You can obtain further information from any qualified specialist workshop.
Example: vehicle identification plate
: Vehicle identification plate
; Vehicle manufacturer (Daimler AG)
= EU type approval number (only for certain
?
A
B
C
D
countries)
VIN
Maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight (kg)
Maximum permissible front axle load (kg)
Maximum permissible rear axle load (kg)
Paint code
i The data shown on the vehicle identification plate is example data. This data is different for every vehicle, and can deviate
from the data shown here. You can find the
data applicable to your vehicle on the vehicle's identification plate.
Service products and capacities
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When handling, storing and disposing of any
service products, please observe the relevant
regulations, as you could otherwise endanger
yourself and others.
Keep service products away from children.
To protect your health, do not allow service
products to come into contact with your eyes
or open wounds. See a doctor immediately if
any service product is swallowed.
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Z
Technical data
Engine number
360
Service products and capacities
Service products include the following:
Tank capacity
Rfuels
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment.
(e.g. petrol, diesel)
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake fluid
Rwindscreen washer fluid
Rclimate control system refrigerant
Components and service products must be
matched. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use products tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. They are listed in this
Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on the container:
RMB-Freigabe
(e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet Number (e.g.
MB 229.5). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Further information can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on the
Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Technical data
RMB
Fuel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames
and smoking are therefore prohibited when
handling fuels.
Switch off the engine and the auxiliary heating
before refuelling.
G WARNING
Avoid contact with fuels.
It is hazardous to your health if your skin
comes into direct contact with fuels or you
breathe in fuel vapours.
Model
Total capacity
CLS 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
59.0 l
or
80.0 l
All other models (except
CLS 63 AMG)
80.0 l
CLS 63 AMG
66.0 l
or
80.0 l
Model
Of which
reserve:
Models with 59.0 l total
capacity
Approximately 8.0 l
Models with 80.0 l total
capacity
Approximately 9.0 l
CLS 63 AMG
Approx.
14.0 l
Petrol (EN 228, E DIN 51626-1)
Fuel grade
! Do not use diesel to refuel vehicles with a
petrol engine. Even a small quantity of diesel will damage the fuel injection system.
! Only refuel using unleaded petrol with at
least 95 RON/85 MON that conforms to
European standard EN 228 or E DIN
51626-1 or an equivalent specification.
Fuel with this specification may contain up
to 10 % ethanol.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85 % ethanol)
(100 % ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15 % methanol)
RE100
Service products and capacities
(petrol with 85 % methanol)
(100 % methanol)
RPetrol with metallic additives
RDiesel
Do not mix these fuels with petrol, and do
not use any additives. This can otherwise
lead to engine damage. This does not
include cleaning additives for the removal
and prevention of residue build-up. Only
cleaning additives recommended by
Mercedes-Benz should be added to petrol,
see "Additives". You can obtain further
information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
RM100
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10 % bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You can refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
i If the recommended fuel is not available,
but only as a temporary measure, you may
also use unleaded petrol with an octane
rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON. This may
reduce engine performance and increase
fuel consumption. Avoid driving at full
throttle.
Information on refuelling (Y page 157).
AMG vehicles
! Only refuel using super unleaded petrol
with at least 98 RON/88 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an
equivalent specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
! Premium-grade unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 95 RON/85 MON may be
used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available. This may
reduce engine performance and increase
fuel consumption. As much as possible,
avoid driving at full throttle.
! Regular unleaded petrol with an octane
rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON may also be
used as a temporary measure if the recommended fuel is not available.
Doing so results in noticeably higher fuel
consumption, and the engine power output
is noticeably reduced. Avoid driving at full
throttle.
If only regular unleaded petrol with an
octane rating of 91 RON/82.5 MON or
lower is available, you must have the vehicle adapted to this fuel at a qualified specialist workshop.
i E10 fuel contains up to 10 % bioethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10
fuel. You can refuel your vehicle using E10
fuel.
CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
! Only refuel using premium-grade sulphurfree unleaded petrol with at least 95 RON/
85 MON that conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent specification.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the emission control system.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Additives
! Do not refuel with low grade fuel and do
not use fuel additives that have not been
tested and approved for Mercedes-Benz
vehicles. Otherwise the fuel system could
malfunction or be damaged.
One of the major problems with low-grade
fuel is the creation of carbon deposits during
the process of burning fuel. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use fuel brands that
have additives.
If you use fuels without these additives for a
longer period of time, there may be a build-up
Z
Technical data
RM85
361
362
Service products and capacities
of carbon deposits. These will form especially
on the inlet valves and in the combustion
chamber.
This could lead to engine running problems,
e.g.:
Technical data
Rlonger
engine warm-up phase
Runeven idle
Rengine noise
Rmisfiring
Rloss of power
In areas where petrol with the required additives is not available, carbon deposits can
build up. In this case, Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of additives that have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles; see
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
The quality of the fuel available in some countries may not be sufficient. Residue could
build up as a result. In such cases, and in
consultation with a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre, the petrol may be mixed with the
additive recommended by Mercedes-Benz
(part no. A000989254510). You must
observe the notes and mixing ratios specified
on the container.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre to
view a list of approved products. Observe the
instructions for use in the product description.
Do not mix other fuel additives with fuel. This
causes unnecessary costs and could damage
the engine.
Diesel (EN 590)
Fuel grade
G WARNING
Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a diesel engine. Do not mix diesel with petrol. This
would result in damage to the fuel system and
engine, which could lead to a vehicle fire.
! When refuelling, only use diesel fuel that
conforms to the European standard EN 590
or is of equivalent quality. Fuel that does
not conform to EN 590 can lead to
increased wear as well as damage to the
engine and exhaust system.
! Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
oil
Rbio-diesel
Rvegetable oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not mix such fuels with diesel fuel and
do not use any special additives. This can
otherwise lead to engine damage. This
does not include flow improver additives.
For further information, see "Flow improvers".
Rheating
! Vehicles with a diesel particle filter: in
countries outside the EU, only refuel with
low-sulphur Euro diesel with a sulphur content under 50 ppm; otherwise the emission
control system could be damaged.
! Vehicles without a diesel particle fil-
ter: in countries where only diesel fuel with
a high sulphur content is available, you will
need to carry out your vehicle's oil change
at shorter intervals. More information
about the interval for oil change can be
obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
Usually you will find information about the
fuel grade on the pump. If you cannot find the
label on the petrol pump, ask the filling station staff.
Information on refuelling (Y page 157).
Low outside temperatures
In winter months, diesel fuel with an improved
cold flow quality is available. In Europe, the
EN 590 standard defines various climatedependent temperature categories. Malfunctions can be avoided by refuelling with diesel
fuel that corresponds to the climatic specifications outlined in EN 590. At unusually low
Service products and capacities
i Further information on country-specific
fuel properties can be obtained from oil
companies, e.g. at filling stations.
Flow improvers
To improve the low-temperature resistance of
diesel fuel, a flow improver can be attached.
The effectiveness of a flow improver is not
guaranteed for every fuel.
Only use flow improvers tested and approved
by Mercedes-Benz. During use, please
observe the information on operation.
Correct dosage and sufficient mixing are decisive in improving low-temperature resistance
with the flow improver. Overdosage can
potentially even decrease low-temperature
resistance and must therefore be avoided.
Follow the manufacturer's guidelines on dosage.
Mix the additive into the diesel in good time,
before the flow characteristics of the diesel
become insufficient. Otherwise, malfunctions
can arise through heating the fuel system,
e.g. through parking in a heated garage.
More information about recommended flow
improvers can be obtained from any qualified
specialist workshop.
Fuel consumption information
H Environmental note
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for
global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your
vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related to
fuel consumption and therefore depend on:
Refficient use of the fuel by the engine
Rdriving style
Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences or road conditions
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in
the following situations:
Rat
very low outside temperatures
urban traffic
Ron short journeys
Rin mountainous terrain
Rin
i Only for certain countries: you can find
the current consumption and emission values of your vehicle in the COC documents
(EU CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY). These
documents are delivered with your vehicle.
The consumption figures were in each case
based on the currently applicable version:
Rfor vehicles that comply with standards
up to and including the EURO 4 standard,
in accordance with EU Directive
80/1268/EEC
Rfor vehicles that comply with or exceed
the EURO 5 standard, in accordance with
Regulation (EC) No. 715/2007
Deviations from these values may occur
under normal operating conditions.
Engine oil
General notes
The quality of the engine oil is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils that correspond to the current
technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the oil
change carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. Mercedes-Benz approval is indicaZ
Technical data
outside temperatures, it is possible that the
flow characteristics of the diesel fuel could be
insufficient. Accordingly, diesel fuel from
warmer areas may not be suitable for operation in colder climatic conditions.
363
364
Service products and capacities
Technical data
ted on the oil container by the inscription "MB
Approval" and the corresponding designation, e.g. MB Approval 229.51.
You can call up an overview of approved
engine oils on the Internet at:
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering the designation, e.g. 229.5.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
Petrol engines
MB Approval
CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
229.3, 229.5
CLS 500 BlueEFFICIENCY
CLS 500 4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY
CLS 63 AMG
229.5
Diesel engines with
diesel particle filter
MB Approval
CLS 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
CLS 350 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC
BlueEFFICIENCY
228.51,
229.31, 229.51
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change
including the oil filter.
Model
Replacement
amount
CLS 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
6.5 l
CLS 350 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
CLS 350 CDI
4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY
CLS 500 BlueEFFICIENCY
CLS 500 4MATIC
BlueEFFICIENCY
8.0 l
CLS 63 AMG
8.5 l
Additives
! Do not use any additives with the engine
oil. This could damage the engine.
Engine oil viscosity
Use only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine oils
for AMG vehicles.
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may add the following engine
oils until the next oil change:
Rvehicles
with a petrol engine: MB
Approval 229.1 229.3 or ACEA A3
Rdiesel engines: MB Approval 229.1,
229.3, 229.5 or ACEA C3
Use only SAE 0W-40 or SAE 5W-40 engine
oils for AMG vehicles.
This may only be topped up once, and the
quantity must not be greater than 1.0 l.
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity
rating, it flows slowly; the lower the viscosity,
the faster it flows.
Engine oil selection is based on the respective
outside temperatures and in accordance with
the SAE classification (viscosity). The table
Service products and capacities
Brake fluid
G WARNING
Over a period of time, the brake fluid absorbs
moisture from the air; This lowers its boiling
point.
If the boiling point of the brake fluid is too low,
vapour pockets may form in the brake system
when the brakes are applied hard (e.g. when
driving downhill). This impairs braking efficiency.
You should have the brake fluid renewed at
regular intervals. The brake fluid change intervals can be found in the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB Approval 331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
i Have the brake fluid renewed regularly at
a qualified specialist workshop.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be
found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications
for Service Products, MB Specifications for
Service Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Or contact a qualified specialist workshop.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
! The engine cooling system is filled with
coolant, which must be renewed after
15 years or after 250,000 kilometres at the
latest.
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It performs the
following tasks:
Ranti-corrosion
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant during operation will be approximately 130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Rantifreeze
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
Coolant
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Antifreeze is highly flammable. Fire, naked
flames and smoking are prohibited when handling antifreeze.
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot
engine parts, it may ignite and you could burn
yourself. Do not spill any antifreeze on hot
engine parts.
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -45 †). Heat will otherwise not be
dissipated as effectively.
If the vehicle has lost coolant, top it up with
equal amounts of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentrate in accordance with MB Specifications for Service Products 310.1.
Z
Technical data
shows you which SAE classifications are to be
used. The low-temperature properties of
engine oils can be significantly impaired during operation due to, for example, ageing or
soot and fuel accretion. It is therefore
strongly recommended to observe regular oil
changes using an approved engine oil with the
appropriate SAE classification.
365
Vehicle data
366
The coolant is checked at every maintenance
interval at a qualified specialist workshop.
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
At temperatures below freezing:
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
Adapt the mixing ratio to the outside temperature.
X
RDown
Windscreen and headlamp cleaning
system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Windscreen washer fluid/antifreeze is highly
flammable. Avoid spilling windscreen washer
fluid/antifreeze on hot engine components as
it can ignite and burn. Severe burns could be
the result.
Technical data
! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or
MB WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid
could damage the plastic lenses of the
headlamps.
! Do not use distilled or de-ionised water in
the washer fluid reservoir. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
! Only the washer fluids SummerFit and
WinterFit can be mixed. Otherwise, the
spraying nozzles could become blocked.
At temperatures above freezing:
X
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB SummerFit.
Mix 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.
to Ò10 †: mix 1 part MB WinterFit
with 2 parts water.
RDown to Ò20 †: mix 1 part MB WinterFit
with 1 part water.
RDown to Ò29 †: mix 2 parts MB WinterFit
with 1 part water.
i Add washer fluid concentrate, e.g. MB
SummerFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer
fluid all year round.
Vehicle data
General notes
Please note that for the specified vehicle
data:
Rthe
heights specified may vary as a result
of:
- tyres
- load
- condition of the suspension
- optional equipment
Ritems of optional equipment increase the
unladen weight and reduce the maximum
payload. The unladen weight is specified in
accordance with EC directive and includes:
- driver (68 kg)
- luggage (7 kg)
- all fluids (fuel tank 90% full)
Rvehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 359).
Ronly for certain countries: you can find vehicle-specific vehicle data in the COC documents (CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY).
These documents are delivered with your
vehicle.
Vehicle data
Dimensions and weights
367
CLS 500 4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle height
1404 mm
Unladen weight
1940 kg
CLS 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
1416 mm
Unladen weight
1785 kg
:Opening height
(all models)
1772 mm –
1788 mm
(all models)
CLS 350 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle height
1416 mm
Unladen weight
1815 kg
Vehicle length (ECE)
4940 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2075 mm
CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1881 mm
Vehicle height
1416 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Unladen weight
1875 kg
Maximum roof load
100 kg
CLS 63 AMG
Maximum boot load
100 kg
Vehicle length (ECE)
4987 mm
Vehicle width including
exterior mirrors
2075 mm
Vehicle width excluding
exterior mirrors
1881 mm
Vehicle height
1411 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle height
1416 mm
Unladen weight
1735 kg
CLS 500 BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle height
1404 mm
Unladen weight
1870 kg
Unladen weight
1890 kg
Maximum roof load
100 kg
Maximum boot load
100 kg
Z
Technical data
Model
Vehicle height
368
24 GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
24 GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
The 24 GHz radar sensor system requires separate approval for each country. If you are driving
in a country in which the radar sensor system is not approved, you must deactivate the system
using the on-board computer (Y page 225).
The current country overview can be obtained from a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or on
the Internet at: http://www.mercedes-benz.de/betriebsanleitung.
Vehicles with a navigation system: the radar sensor system is deactivated automatically
near radio telescope facilities. A display message appears in the multifunction display to tell
you that the radar sensor system is being switched off (Y page 245).
The currently active systems are automatically deactivated:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 170)
Spot Assist (Y page 197)
RActive Blind Spot Assist (Y page 201)
RBAS PLUS (Y page 64)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 68)
If deactivation does not occur automatically, you must deactivate the radar sensor system
using the on-board computer (Y page 225).
Vehicles without navigation and vehicles for Australia: you must deactivate the radar
sensor system using the on-board computer when you are near a radio telescope facility
(Y page 225).
Technical data
RBlind